Provided by: qemu-system-common_6.2+dfsg-2ubuntu6.24_amd64
NAME
qemu-qmp-ref - QEMU QMP Reference Manual Contents • QEMU QMP Reference Manual • Introduction • This document describes all commands currently supported by QMP. • Stability Considerations • The current QMP command set (described in this file) may be useful for a number of use cases, however it's limited and several commands have bad defined semantics, specially with regard to command completion. • QMP errors • QapiErrorClass (Enum) • Common data types • IoOperationType (Enum) • OnOffAuto (Enum) • OnOffSplit (Enum) • String (Object) • StrOrNull (Alternate) • OffAutoPCIBAR (Enum) • PCIELinkSpeed (Enum) • PCIELinkWidth (Enum) • HostMemPolicy (Enum) • NetFilterDirection (Enum) • GrabToggleKeys (Enum) • HumanReadableText (Object) • Socket data types • NetworkAddressFamily (Enum) • InetSocketAddressBase (Object) • InetSocketAddress (Object) • UnixSocketAddress (Object) • VsockSocketAddress (Object) • InetSocketAddressWrapper (Object) • UnixSocketAddressWrapper (Object) • VsockSocketAddressWrapper (Object) • StringWrapper (Object) • SocketAddressLegacy (Object) • SocketAddressType (Enum) • SocketAddress (Object) • VM run state • RunState (Enum) • ShutdownCause (Enum) • StatusInfo (Object) • query-status (Command) • SHUTDOWN (Event) • POWERDOWN (Event) • RESET (Event) • STOP (Event) • RESUME (Event) • SUSPEND (Event) • SUSPEND_DISK (Event) • WAKEUP (Event) • WATCHDOG (Event) • WatchdogAction (Enum) • RebootAction (Enum) • ShutdownAction (Enum) • PanicAction (Enum) • watchdog-set-action (Command) • set-action (Command) • GUEST_PANICKED (Event) • GUEST_CRASHLOADED (Event) • GuestPanicAction (Enum) • GuestPanicInformationType (Enum) • GuestPanicInformation (Object) • GuestPanicInformationHyperV (Object) • S390CrashReason (Enum) • GuestPanicInformationS390 (Object) • MEMORY_FAILURE (Event) • MemoryFailureRecipient (Enum) • MemoryFailureAction (Enum) • MemoryFailureFlags (Object) • Cryptography • QCryptoTLSCredsEndpoint (Enum) • QCryptoSecretFormat (Enum) • QCryptoHashAlgorithm (Enum) • QCryptoCipherAlgorithm (Enum) • QCryptoCipherMode (Enum) • QCryptoIVGenAlgorithm (Enum) • QCryptoBlockFormat (Enum) • QCryptoBlockOptionsBase (Object) • QCryptoBlockOptionsQCow (Object) • QCryptoBlockOptionsLUKS (Object) • QCryptoBlockCreateOptionsLUKS (Object) • QCryptoBlockOpenOptions (Object) • QCryptoBlockCreateOptions (Object) • QCryptoBlockInfoBase (Object) • QCryptoBlockInfoLUKSSlot (Object) • QCryptoBlockInfoLUKS (Object) • QCryptoBlockInfo (Object) • QCryptoBlockLUKSKeyslotState (Enum) • QCryptoBlockAmendOptionsLUKS (Object) • QCryptoBlockAmendOptions (Object) • SecretCommonProperties (Object) • SecretProperties (Object) • SecretKeyringProperties (Object) • TlsCredsProperties (Object) • TlsCredsAnonProperties (Object) • TlsCredsPskProperties (Object) • TlsCredsX509Properties (Object) • Block devices • Block core (VM unrelated) • Background jobs • Additional block stuff (VM related) • Block device exports • Character devices • ChardevInfo (Object) • query-chardev (Command) • ChardevBackendInfo (Object) • query-chardev-backends (Command) • DataFormat (Enum) • ringbuf-write (Command) • ringbuf-read (Command) • ChardevCommon (Object) • ChardevFile (Object) • ChardevHostdev (Object) • ChardevSocket (Object) • ChardevUdp (Object) • ChardevMux (Object) • ChardevStdio (Object) • ChardevSpiceChannel (Object) • ChardevSpicePort (Object) • ChardevVC (Object) • ChardevRingbuf (Object) • ChardevQemuVDAgent (Object) • ChardevBackendKind (Enum) • ChardevFileWrapper (Object) • ChardevHostdevWrapper (Object) • ChardevSocketWrapper (Object) • ChardevUdpWrapper (Object) • ChardevCommonWrapper (Object) • ChardevMuxWrapper (Object) • ChardevStdioWrapper (Object) • ChardevSpiceChannelWrapper (Object) • ChardevSpicePortWrapper (Object) • ChardevQemuVDAgentWrapper (Object) • ChardevVCWrapper (Object) • ChardevRingbufWrapper (Object) • ChardevBackend (Object) • ChardevReturn (Object) • chardev-add (Command) • chardev-change (Command) • chardev-remove (Command) • chardev-send-break (Command) • VSERPORT_CHANGE (Event) • Dump guest memory • DumpGuestMemoryFormat (Enum) • dump-guest-memory (Command) • DumpStatus (Enum) • DumpQueryResult (Object) • query-dump (Command) • DUMP_COMPLETED (Event) • DumpGuestMemoryCapability (Object) • query-dump-guest-memory-capability (Command) • Net devices • set_link (Command) • netdev_add (Command) • netdev_del (Command) • NetLegacyNicOptions (Object) • NetdevUserOptions (Object) • NetdevTapOptions (Object) • NetdevSocketOptions (Object) • NetdevL2TPv3Options (Object) • NetdevVdeOptions (Object) • NetdevBridgeOptions (Object) • NetdevHubPortOptions (Object) • NetdevNetmapOptions (Object) • NetdevVhostUserOptions (Object) • NetdevVhostVDPAOptions (Object) • NetClientDriver (Enum) • Netdev (Object) • RxState (Enum) • RxFilterInfo (Object) • query-rx-filter (Command) • NIC_RX_FILTER_CHANGED (Event) • AnnounceParameters (Object) • announce-self (Command) • FAILOVER_NEGOTIATED (Event) • RDMA device • RDMA_GID_STATUS_CHANGED (Event) • Rocker switch device • RockerSwitch (Object) • query-rocker (Command) • RockerPortDuplex (Enum) • RockerPortAutoneg (Enum) • RockerPort (Object) • query-rocker-ports (Command) • RockerOfDpaFlowKey (Object) • RockerOfDpaFlowMask (Object) • RockerOfDpaFlowAction (Object) • RockerOfDpaFlow (Object) • query-rocker-of-dpa-flows (Command) • RockerOfDpaGroup (Object) • query-rocker-of-dpa-groups (Command) • TPM (trusted platform module) devices • TpmModel (Enum) • query-tpm-models (Command) • TpmType (Enum) • query-tpm-types (Command) • TPMPassthroughOptions (Object) • TPMEmulatorOptions (Object) • TPMPassthroughOptionsWrapper (Object) • TPMEmulatorOptionsWrapper (Object) • TpmTypeOptions (Object) • TPMInfo (Object) • query-tpm (Command) • Remote desktop • set_password (Command) • expire_password (Command) • screendump (Command) • Spice • VNC • Input • MouseInfo (Object) • query-mice (Command) • QKeyCode (Enum) • KeyValueKind (Enum) • IntWrapper (Object) • QKeyCodeWrapper (Object) • KeyValue (Object) • send-key (Command) • InputButton (Enum) • InputAxis (Enum) • InputKeyEvent (Object) • InputBtnEvent (Object) • InputMoveEvent (Object) • InputEventKind (Enum) • InputKeyEventWrapper (Object) • InputBtnEventWrapper (Object) • InputMoveEventWrapper (Object) • InputEvent (Object) • input-send-event (Command) • DisplayGTK (Object) • DisplayEGLHeadless (Object) • DisplayGLMode (Enum) • DisplayCurses (Object) • DisplayType (Enum) • DisplayOptions (Object) • query-display-options (Command) • DisplayReloadType (Enum) • DisplayReloadOptionsVNC (Object) • DisplayReloadOptions (Object) • display-reload (Command) • User authorization • QAuthZListPolicy (Enum) • QAuthZListFormat (Enum) • QAuthZListRule (Object) • AuthZListProperties (Object) • AuthZListFileProperties (Object) • AuthZPAMProperties (Object) • AuthZSimpleProperties (Object) • Migration • MigrationStats (Object) • XBZRLECacheStats (Object) • CompressionStats (Object) • MigrationStatus (Enum) • VfioStats (Object) • MigrationInfo (Object) • query-migrate (Command) • MigrationCapability (Enum) • MigrationCapabilityStatus (Object) • migrate-set-capabilities (Command) • query-migrate-capabilities (Command) • MultiFDCompression (Enum) • BitmapMigrationBitmapAliasTransform (Object) • BitmapMigrationBitmapAlias (Object) • BitmapMigrationNodeAlias (Object) • MigrationParameter (Enum) • MigrateSetParameters (Object) • migrate-set-parameters (Command) • MigrationParameters (Object) • query-migrate-parameters (Command) • client_migrate_info (Command) • migrate-start-postcopy (Command) • MIGRATION (Event) • MIGRATION_PASS (Event) • COLOMessage (Enum) • COLOMode (Enum) • FailoverStatus (Enum) • COLO_EXIT (Event) • COLOExitReason (Enum) • x-colo-lost-heartbeat (Command) • migrate_cancel (Command) • migrate-continue (Command) • migrate (Command) • migrate-incoming (Command) • xen-save-devices-state (Command) • xen-set-global-dirty-log (Command) • xen-load-devices-state (Command) • xen-set-replication (Command) • ReplicationStatus (Object) • query-xen-replication-status (Command) • xen-colo-do-checkpoint (Command) • COLOStatus (Object) • query-colo-status (Command) • migrate-recover (Command) • migrate-pause (Command) • UNPLUG_PRIMARY (Event) • DirtyRateVcpu (Object) • DirtyRateStatus (Enum) • DirtyRateMeasureMode (Enum) • DirtyRateInfo (Object) • calc-dirty-rate (Command) • query-dirty-rate (Command) • snapshot-save (Command) • snapshot-load (Command) • snapshot-delete (Command) • Transactions • Abort (Object) • ActionCompletionMode (Enum) • TransactionActionKind (Enum) • AbortWrapper (Object) • BlockDirtyBitmapAddWrapper (Object) • BlockDirtyBitmapWrapper (Object) • BlockDirtyBitmapMergeWrapper (Object) • BlockdevBackupWrapper (Object) • BlockdevSnapshotWrapper (Object) • BlockdevSnapshotInternalWrapper (Object) • BlockdevSnapshotSyncWrapper (Object) • DriveBackupWrapper (Object) • TransactionAction (Object) • TransactionProperties (Object) • transaction (Command) • Tracing • TraceEventState (Enum) • TraceEventInfo (Object) • trace-event-get-state (Command) • trace-event-set-state (Command) • Compatibility policy • CompatPolicyInput (Enum) • CompatPolicyOutput (Enum) • CompatPolicy (Object) • QMP monitor control • qmp_capabilities (Command) • QMPCapability (Enum) • VersionTriple (Object) • VersionInfo (Object) • query-version (Command) • CommandInfo (Object) • query-commands (Command) • quit (Command) • MonitorMode (Enum) • MonitorOptions (Object) • QMP introspection • query-qmp-schema (Command) • SchemaMetaType (Enum) • SchemaInfo (Object) • SchemaInfoBuiltin (Object) • JSONType (Enum) • SchemaInfoEnum (Object) • SchemaInfoEnumMember (Object) • SchemaInfoArray (Object) • SchemaInfoObject (Object) • SchemaInfoObjectMember (Object) • SchemaInfoObjectVariant (Object) • SchemaInfoAlternate (Object) • SchemaInfoAlternateMember (Object) • SchemaInfoCommand (Object) • SchemaInfoEvent (Object) • QEMU Object Model (QOM) • ObjectPropertyInfo (Object) • qom-list (Command) • qom-get (Command) • qom-set (Command) • ObjectTypeInfo (Object) • qom-list-types (Command) • qom-list-properties (Command) • CanHostSocketcanProperties (Object) • ColoCompareProperties (Object) • CryptodevBackendProperties (Object) • CryptodevVhostUserProperties (Object) • DBusVMStateProperties (Object) • NetfilterInsert (Enum) • NetfilterProperties (Object) • FilterBufferProperties (Object) • FilterDumpProperties (Object) • FilterMirrorProperties (Object) • FilterRedirectorProperties (Object) • FilterRewriterProperties (Object) • InputBarrierProperties (Object) • InputLinuxProperties (Object) • IothreadProperties (Object) • MemoryBackendProperties (Object) • MemoryBackendFileProperties (Object) • MemoryBackendMemfdProperties (Object) • MemoryBackendEpcProperties (Object) • PrManagerHelperProperties (Object) • QtestProperties (Object) • RemoteObjectProperties (Object) • RngProperties (Object) • RngEgdProperties (Object) • RngRandomProperties (Object) • SevGuestProperties (Object) • ObjectType (Enum) • ObjectOptions (Object) • object-add (Command) • object-del (Command) • Device infrastructure (qdev) • device-list-properties (Command) • device_add (Command) • device_del (Command) • DEVICE_DELETED (Event) • DEVICE_UNPLUG_GUEST_ERROR (Event) • Machines • SysEmuTarget (Enum) • CpuS390State (Enum) • CpuInfoS390 (Object) • CpuInfoFast (Object) • query-cpus-fast (Command) • MachineInfo (Object) • query-machines (Command) • CurrentMachineParams (Object) • query-current-machine (Command) • TargetInfo (Object) • query-target (Command) • UuidInfo (Object) • query-uuid (Command) • GuidInfo (Object) • query-vm-generation-id (Command) • system_reset (Command) • system_powerdown (Command) • system_wakeup (Command) • LostTickPolicy (Enum) • inject-nmi (Command) • KvmInfo (Object) • query-kvm (Command) • NumaOptionsType (Enum) • NumaOptions (Object) • NumaNodeOptions (Object) • NumaDistOptions (Object) • X86CPURegister32 (Enum) • X86CPUFeatureWordInfo (Object) • DummyForceArrays (Object) • NumaCpuOptions (Object) • HmatLBMemoryHierarchy (Enum) • HmatLBDataType (Enum) • NumaHmatLBOptions (Object) • HmatCacheAssociativity (Enum) • HmatCacheWritePolicy (Enum) • NumaHmatCacheOptions (Object) • memsave (Command) • pmemsave (Command) • Memdev (Object) • query-memdev (Command) • CpuInstanceProperties (Object) • HotpluggableCPU (Object) • query-hotpluggable-cpus (Command) • set-numa-node (Command) • balloon (Command) • BalloonInfo (Object) • query-balloon (Command) • BALLOON_CHANGE (Event) • MemoryInfo (Object) • query-memory-size-summary (Command) • PCDIMMDeviceInfo (Object) • VirtioPMEMDeviceInfo (Object) • VirtioMEMDeviceInfo (Object) • SgxEPCDeviceInfo (Object) • MemoryDeviceInfoKind (Enum) • PCDIMMDeviceInfoWrapper (Object) • VirtioPMEMDeviceInfoWrapper (Object) • VirtioMEMDeviceInfoWrapper (Object) • SgxEPCDeviceInfoWrapper (Object) • MemoryDeviceInfo (Object) • SgxEPC (Object) • SgxEPCProperties (Object) • query-memory-devices (Command) • MEMORY_DEVICE_SIZE_CHANGE (Event) • MEM_UNPLUG_ERROR (Event) • SMPConfiguration (Object) • x-query-irq (Command) • x-query-jit (Command) • x-query-numa (Command) • x-query-opcount (Command) • x-query-profile (Command) • x-query-ramblock (Command) • x-query-rdma (Command) • x-query-roms (Command) • x-query-usb (Command) • CpuModelInfo (Object) • CpuModelExpansionType (Enum) • CpuModelCompareResult (Enum) • CpuModelBaselineInfo (Object) • CpuModelCompareInfo (Object) • query-cpu-model-comparison (Command) • query-cpu-model-baseline (Command) • CpuModelExpansionInfo (Object) • query-cpu-model-expansion (Command) • CpuDefinitionInfo (Object) • query-cpu-definitions (Command) • Record/replay • ReplayMode (Enum) • ReplayInfo (Object) • query-replay (Command) • replay-break (Command) • replay-delete-break (Command) • replay-seek (Command) • Yank feature • YankInstanceType (Enum) • YankInstanceBlockNode (Object) • YankInstanceChardev (Object) • YankInstance (Object) • yank (Command) • query-yank (Command) • Miscellanea • add_client (Command) • NameInfo (Object) • query-name (Command) • IOThreadInfo (Object) • query-iothreads (Command) • stop (Command) • cont (Command) • x-exit-preconfig (Command) • human-monitor-command (Command) • getfd (Command) • closefd (Command) • AddfdInfo (Object) • add-fd (Command) • remove-fd (Command) • FdsetFdInfo (Object) • FdsetInfo (Object) • query-fdsets (Command) • CommandLineParameterType (Enum) • CommandLineParameterInfo (Object) • CommandLineOptionInfo (Object) • query-command-line-options (Command) • RTC_CHANGE (Event) • rtc-reset-reinjection (Command) • SevState (Enum) • SevInfo (Object) • query-sev (Command) • SevLaunchMeasureInfo (Object) • query-sev-launch-measure (Command) • SevCapability (Object) • query-sev-capabilities (Command) • sev-inject-launch-secret (Command) • SevAttestationReport (Object) • query-sev-attestation-report (Command) • dump-skeys (Command) • GICCapability (Object) • query-gic-capabilities (Command) • SGXInfo (Object) • query-sgx (Command) • query-sgx-capabilities (Command) • Audio • AudiodevPerDirectionOptions (Object) • AudiodevGenericOptions (Object) • AudiodevAlsaPerDirectionOptions (Object) • AudiodevAlsaOptions (Object) • AudiodevCoreaudioPerDirectionOptions (Object) • AudiodevCoreaudioOptions (Object) • AudiodevDsoundOptions (Object) • AudiodevJackPerDirectionOptions (Object) • AudiodevJackOptions (Object) • AudiodevOssPerDirectionOptions (Object) • AudiodevOssOptions (Object) • AudiodevPaPerDirectionOptions (Object) • AudiodevPaOptions (Object) • AudiodevSdlPerDirectionOptions (Object) • AudiodevSdlOptions (Object) • AudiodevWavOptions (Object) • AudioFormat (Enum) • AudiodevDriver (Enum) • Audiodev (Object) • ACPI • AcpiTableOptions (Object) • ACPISlotType (Enum) • ACPIOSTInfo (Object) • query-acpi-ospm-status (Command) • ACPI_DEVICE_OST (Event) • PCI • PciMemoryRange (Object) • PciMemoryRegion (Object) • PciBusInfo (Object) • PciBridgeInfo (Object) • PciDeviceClass (Object) • PciDeviceId (Object) • PciDeviceInfo (Object) • PciInfo (Object) • query-pci (Command)
INTRODUCTION
This document describes all commands currently supported by QMP. Most of the time their usage is exactly the same as in the user Monitor, this means that any other document which also describe commands (the manpage, QEMU's manual, etc) can and should be consulted. QMP has two types of commands: regular and query commands. Regular commands usually change the Virtual Machine's state someway, while query commands just return information. The sections below are divided accordingly. It's important to observe that all communication examples are formatted in a reader-friendly way, so that they're easier to understand. However, in real protocol usage, they're emitted as a single line. Also, the following notation is used to denote data flow: Example: -> data issued by the Client <- Server data response Please, refer to the QMP specification (docs/interop/qmp-spec.txt) for detailed information on the Server command and response formats.
STABILITY CONSIDERATIONS
The current QMP command set (described in this file) may be useful for a number of use cases, however it's limited and several commands have bad defined semantics, specially with regard to command completion. These problems are going to be solved incrementally in the next QEMU releases and we're going to establish a deprecation policy for badly defined commands. If you're planning to adopt QMP, please observe the following: 1. The deprecation policy will take effect and be documented soon, please check the documentation of each used command as soon as a new release of QEMU is available 2. DO NOT rely on anything which is not explicit documented 3. Errors, in special, are not documented. Applications should NOT check for specific errors classes or data (it's strongly recommended to only check for the "error" key)
QMP ERRORS
QapiErrorClass (Enum) QEMU error classes Values GenericError this is used for errors that don't require a specific error class. This should be the default case for most errors CommandNotFound the requested command has not been found DeviceNotActive a device has failed to be become active DeviceNotFound the requested device has not been found KVMMissingCap the requested operation can't be fulfilled because a required KVM capability is missing Since 1.2
COMMON DATA TYPES
IoOperationType (Enum) An enumeration of the I/O operation types Values read read operation write write operation Since 2.1 OnOffAuto (Enum) An enumeration of three options: on, off, and auto Values auto QEMU selects the value between on and off on Enabled off Disabled Since 2.2 OnOffSplit (Enum) An enumeration of three values: on, off, and split Values on Enabled off Disabled split Mixed Since 2.6 String (Object) A fat type wrapping 'str', to be embedded in lists. Members str: string Not documented Since 1.2 StrOrNull (Alternate) This is a string value or the explicit lack of a string (null pointer in C). Intended for cases when 'optional absent' already has a different meaning. Members s: string the string value n: null no string value Since 2.10 OffAutoPCIBAR (Enum) An enumeration of options for specifying a PCI BAR Values off The specified feature is disabled auto The PCI BAR for the feature is automatically selected bar0 PCI BAR0 is used for the feature bar1 PCI BAR1 is used for the feature bar2 PCI BAR2 is used for the feature bar3 PCI BAR3 is used for the feature bar4 PCI BAR4 is used for the feature bar5 PCI BAR5 is used for the feature Since 2.12 PCIELinkSpeed (Enum) An enumeration of PCIe link speeds in units of GT/s Values 2_5 2.5GT/s 5 5.0GT/s 8 8.0GT/s 16 16.0GT/s Since 4.0 PCIELinkWidth (Enum) An enumeration of PCIe link width Values 1 x1 2 x2 4 x4 8 x8 12 x12 16 x16 32 x32 Since 4.0 HostMemPolicy (Enum) Host memory policy types Values default restore default policy, remove any nondefault policy preferred set the preferred host nodes for allocation bind a strict policy that restricts memory allocation to the host nodes specified interleave memory allocations are interleaved across the set of host nodes specified Since 2.1 NetFilterDirection (Enum) Indicates whether a netfilter is attached to a netdev's transmit queue or receive queue or both. Values all the filter is attached both to the receive and the transmit queue of the netdev (default). rx the filter is attached to the receive queue of the netdev, where it will receive packets sent to the netdev. tx the filter is attached to the transmit queue of the netdev, where it will receive packets sent by the netdev. Since 2.5 GrabToggleKeys (Enum) Keys to toggle input-linux between host and guest. Values ctrl-ctrl Not documented alt-alt Not documented shift-shift Not documented meta-meta Not documented scrolllock Not documented ctrl-scrolllock Not documented Since 4.0 HumanReadableText (Object) Members human-readable-text: string Formatted output intended for humans. Since 6.2
SOCKET DATA TYPES
NetworkAddressFamily (Enum) The network address family Values ipv4 IPV4 family ipv6 IPV6 family unix unix socket vsock vsock family (since 2.8) unknown otherwise Since 2.1 InetSocketAddressBase (Object) Members host: string host part of the address port: string port part of the address InetSocketAddress (Object) Captures a socket address or address range in the Internet namespace. Members numeric: boolean (optional) true if the host/port are guaranteed to be numeric, false if name resolution should be attempted. Defaults to false. (Since 2.9) to: int (optional) If present, this is range of possible addresses, with port between port and to. ipv4: boolean (optional) whether to accept IPv4 addresses, default try both IPv4 and IPv6 ipv6: boolean (optional) whether to accept IPv6 addresses, default try both IPv4 and IPv6 keep-alive: boolean (optional) enable keep-alive when connecting to this socket. Not supported for passive sockets. (Since 4.2) mptcp: boolean (optional) (If: HAVE_IPPROTO_MPTCP) enable multi-path TCP. (Since 6.1) The members of InetSocketAddressBase Since 1.3 UnixSocketAddress (Object) Captures a socket address in the local ("Unix socket") namespace. Members path: string filesystem path to use abstract: boolean (optional) (If: CONFIG_LINUX) if true, this is a Linux abstract socket address. path will be prefixed by a null byte, and optionally padded with null bytes. Defaults to false. (Since 5.1) tight: boolean (optional) (If: CONFIG_LINUX) if false, pad an abstract socket address with enough null bytes to make it fill struct sockaddr_un member sun_path. Defaults to true. (Since 5.1) Since 1.3 VsockSocketAddress (Object) Captures a socket address in the vsock namespace. Members cid: string unique host identifier port: string port Note string types are used to allow for possible future hostname or service resolution support. Since 2.8 InetSocketAddressWrapper (Object) Members data: InetSocketAddress Not documented Since 1.3 UnixSocketAddressWrapper (Object) Members data: UnixSocketAddress Not documented Since 1.3 VsockSocketAddressWrapper (Object) Members data: VsockSocketAddress Not documented Since 2.8 StringWrapper (Object) Members data: String Not documented Since 1.3 SocketAddressLegacy (Object) Captures the address of a socket, which could also be a named file descriptor Members type: SocketAddressType Not documented The members of InetSocketAddressWrapper when type is "inet" The members of UnixSocketAddressWrapper when type is "unix" The members of VsockSocketAddressWrapper when type is "vsock" The members of StringWrapper when type is "fd" Note This type is deprecated in favor of SocketAddress. The difference between SocketAddressLegacy and SocketAddress is that the latter is has fewer {} on the wire. Since 1.3 SocketAddressType (Enum) Available SocketAddress types Values inet Internet address unix Unix domain socket vsock VMCI address fd decimal is for file descriptor number, otherwise a file descriptor name. Named file descriptors are permitted in monitor commands, in combination with the 'getfd' command. Decimal file descriptors are permitted at startup or other contexts where no monitor context is active. Since 2.9 SocketAddress (Object) Captures the address of a socket, which could also be a named file descriptor Members type: SocketAddressType Transport type The members of InetSocketAddress when type is "inet" The members of UnixSocketAddress when type is "unix" The members of VsockSocketAddress when type is "vsock" The members of String when type is "fd" Since 2.9
VM RUN STATE
RunState (Enum) An enumeration of VM run states. Values debug QEMU is running on a debugger finish-migrate guest is paused to finish the migration process inmigrate guest is paused waiting for an incoming migration. Note that this state does not tell whether the machine will start at the end of the migration. This depends on the command-line -S option and any invocation of 'stop' or 'cont' that has happened since QEMU was started. internal-error An internal error that prevents further guest execution has occurred io-error the last IOP has failed and the device is configured to pause on I/O errors paused guest has been paused via the 'stop' command postmigrate guest is paused following a successful 'migrate' prelaunch QEMU was started with -S and guest has not started restore-vm guest is paused to restore VM state running guest is actively running save-vm guest is paused to save the VM state shutdown guest is shut down (and -no-shutdown is in use) suspended guest is suspended (ACPI S3) watchdog the watchdog action is configured to pause and has been triggered guest-panicked guest has been panicked as a result of guest OS panic colo guest is paused to save/restore VM state under colo checkpoint, VM can not get into this state unless colo capability is enabled for migration. (since 2.8) ShutdownCause (Enum) An enumeration of reasons for a Shutdown. Values none No shutdown request pending host-error An error prevents further use of guest host-qmp-quit Reaction to the QMP command 'quit' host-qmp-system-reset Reaction to the QMP command 'system_reset' host-signal Reaction to a signal, such as SIGINT host-ui Reaction to a UI event, like window close guest-shutdown Guest shutdown/suspend request, via ACPI or other hardware-specific means guest-reset Guest reset request, and command line turns that into a shutdown guest-panic Guest panicked, and command line turns that into a shutdown subsystem-reset Partial guest reset that does not trigger QMP events and ignores --no-reboot. This is useful for sanitizing hypercalls on s390 that are used during kexec/kdump/boot StatusInfo (Object) Information about VCPU run state Members running: boolean true if all VCPUs are runnable, false if not runnable singlestep: boolean true if VCPUs are in single-step mode status: RunState the virtual machine RunState Since 0.14 Notes singlestep is enabled through the GDB stub query-status (Command) Query the run status of all VCPUs Returns StatusInfo reflecting all VCPUs Since 0.14 Example -> { "execute": "query-status" } <- { "return": { "running": true, "singlestep": false, "status": "running" } } SHUTDOWN (Event) Emitted when the virtual machine has shut down, indicating that qemu is about to exit. Arguments guest: boolean If true, the shutdown was triggered by a guest request (such as a guest-initiated ACPI shutdown request or other hardware-specific action) rather than a host request (such as sending qemu a SIGINT). (since 2.10) reason: ShutdownCause The ShutdownCause which resulted in the SHUTDOWN. (since 4.0) Note If the command-line option "-no-shutdown" has been specified, qemu will not exit, and a STOP event will eventually follow the SHUTDOWN event Since 0.12 Example <- { "event": "SHUTDOWN", "data": { "guest": true }, "timestamp": { "seconds": 1267040730, "microseconds": 682951 } } POWERDOWN (Event) Emitted when the virtual machine is powered down through the power control system, such as via ACPI. Since 0.12 Example <- { "event": "POWERDOWN", "timestamp": { "seconds": 1267040730, "microseconds": 682951 } } RESET (Event) Emitted when the virtual machine is reset Arguments guest: boolean If true, the reset was triggered by a guest request (such as a guest-initiated ACPI reboot request or other hardware-specific action) rather than a host request (such as the QMP command system_reset). (since 2.10) reason: ShutdownCause The ShutdownCause of the RESET. (since 4.0) Since 0.12 Example <- { "event": "RESET", "data": { "guest": false }, "timestamp": { "seconds": 1267041653, "microseconds": 9518 } } STOP (Event) Emitted when the virtual machine is stopped Since 0.12 Example <- { "event": "STOP", "timestamp": { "seconds": 1267041730, "microseconds": 281295 } } RESUME (Event) Emitted when the virtual machine resumes execution Since 0.12 Example <- { "event": "RESUME", "timestamp": { "seconds": 1271770767, "microseconds": 582542 } } SUSPEND (Event) Emitted when guest enters a hardware suspension state, for example, S3 state, which is sometimes called standby state Since 1.1 Example <- { "event": "SUSPEND", "timestamp": { "seconds": 1344456160, "microseconds": 309119 } } SUSPEND_DISK (Event) Emitted when guest enters a hardware suspension state with data saved on disk, for example, S4 state, which is sometimes called hibernate state Note QEMU shuts down (similar to event SHUTDOWN) when entering this state Since 1.2 Example <- { "event": "SUSPEND_DISK", "timestamp": { "seconds": 1344456160, "microseconds": 309119 } } WAKEUP (Event) Emitted when the guest has woken up from suspend state and is running Since 1.1 Example <- { "event": "WAKEUP", "timestamp": { "seconds": 1344522075, "microseconds": 745528 } } WATCHDOG (Event) Emitted when the watchdog device's timer is expired Arguments action: WatchdogAction action that has been taken Note If action is "reset", "shutdown", or "pause" the WATCHDOG event is followed respectively by the RESET, SHUTDOWN, or STOP events Note This event is rate-limited. Since 0.13 Example <- { "event": "WATCHDOG", "data": { "action": "reset" }, "timestamp": { "seconds": 1267061043, "microseconds": 959568 } } WatchdogAction (Enum) An enumeration of the actions taken when the watchdog device's timer is expired Values reset system resets shutdown system shutdown, note that it is similar to powerdown, which tries to set to system status and notify guest poweroff system poweroff, the emulator program exits pause system pauses, similar to stop debug system enters debug state none nothing is done inject-nmi a non-maskable interrupt is injected into the first VCPU (all VCPUS on x86) (since 2.4) Since 2.1 RebootAction (Enum) Possible QEMU actions upon guest reboot Values reset Reset the VM shutdown Shutdown the VM and exit, according to the shutdown action Since 6.0 ShutdownAction (Enum) Possible QEMU actions upon guest shutdown Values poweroff Shutdown the VM and exit pause pause the VM# Since 6.0 PanicAction (Enum) Values none Continue VM execution pause Pause the VM shutdown Shutdown the VM and exit, according to the shutdown action Since 6.0 watchdog-set-action (Command) Set watchdog action Arguments action: WatchdogAction Not documented Since 2.11 set-action (Command) Set the actions that will be taken by the emulator in response to guest events. Arguments reboot: RebootAction (optional) RebootAction action taken on guest reboot. shutdown: ShutdownAction (optional) ShutdownAction action taken on guest shutdown. panic: PanicAction (optional) PanicAction action taken on guest panic. watchdog: WatchdogAction (optional) WatchdogAction action taken when watchdog timer expires . Returns Nothing on success. Since 6.0 Example -> { "execute": "set-action", "arguments": { "reboot": "shutdown", "shutdown" : "pause", "panic": "pause", "watchdog": "inject-nmi" } } <- { "return": {} } GUEST_PANICKED (Event) Emitted when guest OS panic is detected Arguments action: GuestPanicAction action that has been taken, currently always "pause" info: GuestPanicInformation (optional) information about a panic (since 2.9) Since 1.5 Example <- { "event": "GUEST_PANICKED", "data": { "action": "pause" } } GUEST_CRASHLOADED (Event) Emitted when guest OS crash loaded is detected Arguments action: GuestPanicAction action that has been taken, currently always "run" info: GuestPanicInformation (optional) information about a panic Since 5.0 Example <- { "event": "GUEST_CRASHLOADED", "data": { "action": "run" } } GuestPanicAction (Enum) An enumeration of the actions taken when guest OS panic is detected Values pause system pauses poweroff Not documented run Not documented Since 2.1 (poweroff since 2.8, run since 5.0) GuestPanicInformationType (Enum) An enumeration of the guest panic information types Values hyper-v hyper-v guest panic information type s390 s390 guest panic information type (Since: 2.12) Since 2.9 GuestPanicInformation (Object) Information about a guest panic Members type: GuestPanicInformationType Crash type that defines the hypervisor specific information The members of GuestPanicInformationHyperV when type is "hyper-v" The members of GuestPanicInformationS390 when type is "s390" Since 2.9 GuestPanicInformationHyperV (Object) Hyper-V specific guest panic information (HV crash MSRs) Members arg1: int Not documented arg2: int Not documented arg3: int Not documented arg4: int Not documented arg5: int Not documented Since 2.9 S390CrashReason (Enum) Reason why the CPU is in a crashed state. Values unknown no crash reason was set disabled-wait the CPU has entered a disabled wait state extint-loop clock comparator or cpu timer interrupt with new PSW enabled for external interrupts pgmint-loop program interrupt with BAD new PSW opint-loop operation exception interrupt with invalid code at the program interrupt new PSW Since 2.12 GuestPanicInformationS390 (Object) S390 specific guest panic information (PSW) Members core: int core id of the CPU that crashed psw-mask: int control fields of guest PSW psw-addr: int guest instruction address reason: S390CrashReason guest crash reason Since 2.12 MEMORY_FAILURE (Event) Emitted when a memory failure occurs on host side. Arguments recipient: MemoryFailureRecipient recipient is defined as MemoryFailureRecipient. action: MemoryFailureAction action that has been taken. action is defined as MemoryFailureAction. flags: MemoryFailureFlags flags for MemoryFailureAction. action is defined as MemoryFailureFlags. Since 5.2 Example <- { "event": "MEMORY_FAILURE", "data": { "recipient": "hypervisor", "action": "fatal", "flags": { 'action-required': false } } MemoryFailureRecipient (Enum) Hardware memory failure occurs, handled by recipient. Values hypervisor memory failure at QEMU process address space. (none guest memory, but used by QEMU itself). guest memory failure at guest memory, Since 5.2 MemoryFailureAction (Enum) Actions taken by QEMU in response to a hardware memory failure. Values ignore the memory failure could be ignored. This will only be the case for action-optional failures. inject memory failure occurred in guest memory, the guest enabled MCE handling mechanism, and QEMU could inject the MCE into the guest successfully. fatal the failure is unrecoverable. This occurs for action-required failures if the recipient is the hypervisor; QEMU will exit. reset the failure is unrecoverable but confined to the guest. This occurs if the recipient is a guest guest which is not ready to handle memory failures. Since 5.2 MemoryFailureFlags (Object) Additional information on memory failures. Members action-required: boolean whether a memory failure event is action-required or action-optional (e.g. a failure during memory scrub). recursive: boolean whether the failure occurred while the previous failure was still in progress. Since 5.2
CRYPTOGRAPHY
QCryptoTLSCredsEndpoint (Enum) The type of network endpoint that will be using the credentials. Most types of credential require different setup / structures depending on whether they will be used in a server versus a client. Values client the network endpoint is acting as the client server the network endpoint is acting as the server Since 2.5 QCryptoSecretFormat (Enum) The data format that the secret is provided in Values raw raw bytes. When encoded in JSON only valid UTF-8 sequences can be used base64 arbitrary base64 encoded binary data Since 2.6 QCryptoHashAlgorithm (Enum) The supported algorithms for computing content digests Values md5 MD5. Should not be used in any new code, legacy compat only sha1 SHA-1. Should not be used in any new code, legacy compat only sha224 SHA-224. (since 2.7) sha256 SHA-256. Current recommended strong hash. sha384 SHA-384. (since 2.7) sha512 SHA-512. (since 2.7) ripemd160 RIPEMD-160. (since 2.7) Since 2.6 QCryptoCipherAlgorithm (Enum) The supported algorithms for content encryption ciphers Values aes-128 AES with 128 bit / 16 byte keys aes-192 AES with 192 bit / 24 byte keys aes-256 AES with 256 bit / 32 byte keys des DES with 56 bit / 8 byte keys. Do not use except in VNC. (since 6.1) 3des 3DES(EDE) with 192 bit / 24 byte keys (since 2.9) cast5-128 Cast5 with 128 bit / 16 byte keys serpent-128 Serpent with 128 bit / 16 byte keys serpent-192 Serpent with 192 bit / 24 byte keys serpent-256 Serpent with 256 bit / 32 byte keys twofish-128 Twofish with 128 bit / 16 byte keys twofish-192 Twofish with 192 bit / 24 byte keys twofish-256 Twofish with 256 bit / 32 byte keys Since 2.6 QCryptoCipherMode (Enum) The supported modes for content encryption ciphers Values ecb Electronic Code Book cbc Cipher Block Chaining xts XEX with tweaked code book and ciphertext stealing ctr Counter (Since 2.8) Since 2.6 QCryptoIVGenAlgorithm (Enum) The supported algorithms for generating initialization vectors for full disk encryption. The 'plain' generator should not be used for disks with sector numbers larger than 2^32, except where compatibility with pre-existing Linux dm-crypt volumes is required. Values plain 64-bit sector number truncated to 32-bits plain64 64-bit sector number essiv 64-bit sector number encrypted with a hash of the encryption key Since 2.6 QCryptoBlockFormat (Enum) The supported full disk encryption formats Values qcow QCow/QCow2 built-in AES-CBC encryption. Use only for liberating data from old images. luks LUKS encryption format. Recommended for new images Since 2.6 QCryptoBlockOptionsBase (Object) The common options that apply to all full disk encryption formats Members format: QCryptoBlockFormat the encryption format Since 2.6 QCryptoBlockOptionsQCow (Object) The options that apply to QCow/QCow2 AES-CBC encryption format Members key-secret: string (optional) the ID of a QCryptoSecret object providing the decryption key. Mandatory except when probing image for metadata only. Since 2.6 QCryptoBlockOptionsLUKS (Object) The options that apply to LUKS encryption format Members key-secret: string (optional) the ID of a QCryptoSecret object providing the decryption key. Mandatory except when probing image for metadata only. Since 2.6 QCryptoBlockCreateOptionsLUKS (Object) The options that apply to LUKS encryption format initialization Members cipher-alg: QCryptoCipherAlgorithm (optional) the cipher algorithm for data encryption Currently defaults to 'aes-256'. cipher-mode: QCryptoCipherMode (optional) the cipher mode for data encryption Currently defaults to 'xts' ivgen-alg: QCryptoIVGenAlgorithm (optional) the initialization vector generator Currently defaults to 'plain64' ivgen-hash-alg: QCryptoHashAlgorithm (optional) the initialization vector generator hash Currently defaults to 'sha256' hash-alg: QCryptoHashAlgorithm (optional) the master key hash algorithm Currently defaults to 'sha256' iter-time: int (optional) number of milliseconds to spend in PBKDF passphrase processing. Currently defaults to 2000. (since 2.8) The members of QCryptoBlockOptionsLUKS Since 2.6 QCryptoBlockOpenOptions (Object) The options that are available for all encryption formats when opening an existing volume Members The members of QCryptoBlockOptionsBase The members of QCryptoBlockOptionsQCow when format is "qcow" The members of QCryptoBlockOptionsLUKS when format is "luks" Since 2.6 QCryptoBlockCreateOptions (Object) The options that are available for all encryption formats when initializing a new volume Members The members of QCryptoBlockOptionsBase The members of QCryptoBlockOptionsQCow when format is "qcow" The members of QCryptoBlockCreateOptionsLUKS when format is "luks" Since 2.6 QCryptoBlockInfoBase (Object) The common information that applies to all full disk encryption formats Members format: QCryptoBlockFormat the encryption format Since 2.7 QCryptoBlockInfoLUKSSlot (Object) Information about the LUKS block encryption key slot options Members active: boolean whether the key slot is currently in use key-offset: int offset to the key material in bytes iters: int (optional) number of PBKDF2 iterations for key material stripes: int (optional) number of stripes for splitting key material Since 2.7 QCryptoBlockInfoLUKS (Object) Information about the LUKS block encryption options Members cipher-alg: QCryptoCipherAlgorithm the cipher algorithm for data encryption cipher-mode: QCryptoCipherMode the cipher mode for data encryption ivgen-alg: QCryptoIVGenAlgorithm the initialization vector generator ivgen-hash-alg: QCryptoHashAlgorithm (optional) the initialization vector generator hash hash-alg: QCryptoHashAlgorithm the master key hash algorithm payload-offset: int offset to the payload data in bytes master-key-iters: int number of PBKDF2 iterations for key material uuid: string unique identifier for the volume slots: array of QCryptoBlockInfoLUKSSlot information about each key slot Since 2.7 QCryptoBlockInfo (Object) Information about the block encryption options Members The members of QCryptoBlockInfoBase The members of QCryptoBlockInfoLUKS when format is "luks" Since 2.7 QCryptoBlockLUKSKeyslotState (Enum) Defines state of keyslots that are affected by the update Values active The slots contain the given password and marked as active inactive The slots are erased (contain garbage) and marked as inactive Since 5.1 QCryptoBlockAmendOptionsLUKS (Object) This struct defines the update parameters that activate/de-activate set of keyslots Members state: QCryptoBlockLUKSKeyslotState the desired state of the keyslots new-secret: string (optional) The ID of a QCryptoSecret object providing the password to be written into added active keyslots old-secret: string (optional) Optional (for deactivation only) If given will deactivate all keyslots that match password located in QCryptoSecret with this ID iter-time: int (optional) Optional (for activation only) Number of milliseconds to spend in PBKDF passphrase processing for the newly activated keyslot. Currently defaults to 2000. keyslot: int (optional) Optional. ID of the keyslot to activate/deactivate. For keyslot activation, keyslot should not be active already (this is unsafe to update an active keyslot), but possible if 'force' parameter is given. If keyslot is not given, first free keyslot will be written. For keyslot deactivation, this parameter specifies the exact keyslot to deactivate secret: string (optional) Optional. The ID of a QCryptoSecret object providing the password to use to retrieve current master key. Defaults to the same secret that was used to open the image Since 5.1 QCryptoBlockAmendOptions (Object) The options that are available for all encryption formats when amending encryption settings Members The members of QCryptoBlockOptionsBase The members of QCryptoBlockAmendOptionsLUKS when format is "luks" Since 5.1 SecretCommonProperties (Object) Properties for objects of classes derived from secret-common. Members loaded: boolean (optional) if true, the secret is loaded immediately when applying this option and will probably fail when processing the next option. Don't use; only provided for compatibility. (default: false) format: QCryptoSecretFormat (optional) the data format that the secret is provided in (default: raw) keyid: string (optional) the name of another secret that should be used to decrypt the provided data. If not present, the data is assumed to be unencrypted. iv: string (optional) the random initialization vector used for encryption of this particular secret. Should be a base64 encrypted string of the 16-byte IV. Mandatory if keyid is given. Ignored if keyid is absent. Features deprecated Member loaded is deprecated. Setting true doesn't make sense, and false is already the default. Since 2.6 SecretProperties (Object) Properties for secret objects. Either data or file must be provided, but not both. Members data: string (optional) the associated with the secret from file: string (optional) the filename to load the data associated with the secret from The members of SecretCommonProperties Since 2.6 SecretKeyringProperties (Object) Properties for secret_keyring objects. Members serial: int serial number that identifies a key to get from the kernel The members of SecretCommonProperties Since 5.1 TlsCredsProperties (Object) Properties for objects of classes derived from tls-creds. Members verify-peer: boolean (optional) if true the peer credentials will be verified once the handshake is completed. This is a no-op for anonymous credentials. (default: true) dir: string (optional) the path of the directory that contains the credential files endpoint: QCryptoTLSCredsEndpoint (optional) whether the QEMU network backend that uses the credentials will be acting as a client or as a server (default: client) priority: string (optional) a gnutls priority string as described at https://gnutls.org/manual/html_node/Priority-Strings.html Since 2.5 TlsCredsAnonProperties (Object) Properties for tls-creds-anon objects. Members loaded: boolean (optional) if true, the credentials are loaded immediately when applying this option and will ignore options that are processed later. Don't use; only provided for compatibility. (default: false) The members of TlsCredsProperties Features deprecated Member loaded is deprecated. Setting true doesn't make sense, and false is already the default. Since 2.5 TlsCredsPskProperties (Object) Properties for tls-creds-psk objects. Members loaded: boolean (optional) if true, the credentials are loaded immediately when applying this option and will ignore options that are processed later. Don't use; only provided for compatibility. (default: false) username: string (optional) the username which will be sent to the server. For clients only. If absent, "qemu" is sent and the property will read back as an empty string. The members of TlsCredsProperties Features deprecated Member loaded is deprecated. Setting true doesn't make sense, and false is already the default. Since 3.0 TlsCredsX509Properties (Object) Properties for tls-creds-x509 objects. Members loaded: boolean (optional) if true, the credentials are loaded immediately when applying this option and will ignore options that are processed later. Don't use; only provided for compatibility. (default: false) sanity-check: boolean (optional) if true, perform some sanity checks before using the credentials (default: true) passwordid: string (optional) For the server-key.pem and client-key.pem files which contain sensitive private keys, it is possible to use an encrypted version by providing the passwordid parameter. This provides the ID of a previously created secret object containing the password for decryption. The members of TlsCredsProperties Features deprecated Member loaded is deprecated. Setting true doesn't make sense, and false is already the default. Since 2.5
BLOCK DEVICES
Block core (VM unrelated) Background jobs JobType (Enum) Type of a background job. Values commit block commit job type, see "block-commit" stream block stream job type, see "block-stream" mirror drive mirror job type, see "drive-mirror" backup drive backup job type, see "drive-backup" create image creation job type, see "blockdev-create" (since 3.0) amend image options amend job type, see "x-blockdev-amend" (since 5.1) snapshot-load snapshot load job type, see "snapshot-load" (since 6.0) snapshot-save snapshot save job type, see "snapshot-save" (since 6.0) snapshot-delete snapshot delete job type, see "snapshot-delete" (since 6.0) Since 1.7 JobStatus (Enum) Indicates the present state of a given job in its lifetime. Values undefined Erroneous, default state. Should not ever be visible. created The job has been created, but not yet started. running The job is currently running. paused The job is running, but paused. The pause may be requested by either the QMP user or by internal processes. ready The job is running, but is ready for the user to signal completion. This is used for long-running jobs like mirror that are designed to run indefinitely. standby The job is ready, but paused. This is nearly identical to paused. The job may return to ready or otherwise be canceled. waiting The job is waiting for other jobs in the transaction to converge to the waiting state. This status will likely not be visible for the last job in a transaction. pending The job has finished its work, but has finalization steps that it needs to make prior to completing. These changes will require manual intervention via job-finalize if auto-finalize was set to false. These pending changes may still fail. aborting The job is in the process of being aborted, and will finish with an error. The job will afterwards report that it is concluded. This status may not be visible to the management process. concluded The job has finished all work. If auto-dismiss was set to false, the job will remain in the query list until it is dismissed via job-dismiss. null The job is in the process of being dismantled. This state should not ever be visible externally. Since 2.12 JobVerb (Enum) Represents command verbs that can be applied to a job. Values cancel see job-cancel pause see job-pause resume see job-resume set-speed see block-job-set-speed complete see job-complete dismiss see job-dismiss finalize see job-finalize Since 2.12 JOB_STATUS_CHANGE (Event) Emitted when a job transitions to a different status. Arguments id: string The job identifier status: JobStatus The new job status Since 3.0 job-pause (Command) Pause an active job. This command returns immediately after marking the active job for pausing. Pausing an already paused job is an error. The job will pause as soon as possible, which means transitioning into the PAUSED state if it was RUNNING, or into STANDBY if it was READY. The corresponding JOB_STATUS_CHANGE event will be emitted. Cancelling a paused job automatically resumes it. Arguments id: string The job identifier. Since 3.0 job-resume (Command) Resume a paused job. This command returns immediately after resuming a paused job. Resuming an already running job is an error. id : The job identifier. Arguments id: string Not documented Since 3.0 job-cancel (Command) Instruct an active background job to cancel at the next opportunity. This command returns immediately after marking the active job for cancellation. The job will cancel as soon as possible and then emit a JOB_STATUS_CHANGE event. Usually, the status will change to ABORTING, but it is possible that a job successfully completes (e.g. because it was almost done and there was no opportunity to cancel earlier than completing the job) and transitions to PENDING instead. Arguments id: string The job identifier. Since 3.0 job-complete (Command) Manually trigger completion of an active job in the READY state. Arguments id: string The job identifier. Since 3.0 job-dismiss (Command) Deletes a job that is in the CONCLUDED state. This command only needs to be run explicitly for jobs that don't have automatic dismiss enabled. This command will refuse to operate on any job that has not yet reached its terminal state, JOB_STATUS_CONCLUDED. For jobs that make use of JOB_READY event, job-cancel or job-complete will still need to be used as appropriate. Arguments id: string The job identifier. Since 3.0 job-finalize (Command) Instructs all jobs in a transaction (or a single job if it is not part of any transaction) to finalize any graph changes and do any necessary cleanup. This command requires that all involved jobs are in the PENDING state. For jobs in a transaction, instructing one job to finalize will force ALL jobs in the transaction to finalize, so it is only necessary to instruct a single member job to finalize. Arguments id: string The identifier of any job in the transaction, or of a job that is not part of any transaction. Since 3.0 JobInfo (Object) Information about a job. Members id: string The job identifier type: JobType The kind of job that is being performed status: JobStatus Current job state/status current-progress: int Progress made until now. The unit is arbitrary and the value can only meaningfully be used for the ratio of current-progress to total-progress. The value is monotonically increasing. total-progress: int Estimated current-progress value at the completion of the job. This value can arbitrarily change while the job is running, in both directions. error: string (optional) If this field is present, the job failed; if it is still missing in the CONCLUDED state, this indicates successful completion. The value is a human-readable error message to describe the reason for the job failure. It should not be parsed by applications. Since 3.0 query-jobs (Command) Return information about jobs. Returns a list with a JobInfo for each active job Since 3.0 SnapshotInfo (Object) Members id: string unique snapshot id name: string user chosen name vm-state-size: int size of the VM state date-sec: int UTC date of the snapshot in seconds date-nsec: int fractional part in nano seconds to be used with date-sec vm-clock-sec: int VM clock relative to boot in seconds vm-clock-nsec: int fractional part in nano seconds to be used with vm-clock-sec icount: int (optional) Current instruction count. Appears when execution record/replay is enabled. Used for "time-traveling" to match the moment in the recorded execution with the snapshots. This counter may be obtained through query-replay command (since 5.2) Since 1.3 ImageInfoSpecificQCow2EncryptionBase (Object) Members format: BlockdevQcow2EncryptionFormat The encryption format Since 2.10 ImageInfoSpecificQCow2Encryption (Object) Members The members of ImageInfoSpecificQCow2EncryptionBase The members of QCryptoBlockInfoLUKS when format is "luks" Since 2.10 ImageInfoSpecificQCow2 (Object) Members compat: string compatibility level data-file: string (optional) the filename of the external data file that is stored in the image and used as a default for opening the image (since: 4.0) data-file-raw: boolean (optional) True if the external data file must stay valid as a standalone (read-only) raw image without looking at qcow2 metadata (since: 4.0) extended-l2: boolean (optional) true if the image has extended L2 entries; only valid for compat >= 1.1 (since 5.2) lazy-refcounts: boolean (optional) on or off; only valid for compat >= 1.1 corrupt: boolean (optional) true if the image has been marked corrupt; only valid for compat >= 1.1 (since 2.2) refcount-bits: int width of a refcount entry in bits (since 2.3) encrypt: ImageInfoSpecificQCow2Encryption (optional) details about encryption parameters; only set if image is encrypted (since 2.10) bitmaps: array of Qcow2BitmapInfo (optional) A list of qcow2 bitmap details (since 4.0) compression-type: Qcow2CompressionType the image cluster compression method (since 5.1) Since 1.7 ImageInfoSpecificVmdk (Object) Members create-type: string The create type of VMDK image cid: int Content id of image parent-cid: int Parent VMDK image's cid extents: array of ImageInfo List of extent files Since 1.7 ImageInfoSpecificRbd (Object) Members encryption-format: RbdImageEncryptionFormat (optional) Image encryption format Since 6.1 ImageInfoSpecificKind (Enum) Values luks Since 2.7 rbd Since 6.1 qcow2 Not documented vmdk Not documented Since 1.7 ImageInfoSpecificQCow2Wrapper (Object) Members data: ImageInfoSpecificQCow2 Not documented Since 1.7 ImageInfoSpecificVmdkWrapper (Object) Members data: ImageInfoSpecificVmdk Not documented Since 6.1 ImageInfoSpecificLUKSWrapper (Object) Members data: QCryptoBlockInfoLUKS Not documented Since 2.7 ImageInfoSpecificRbdWrapper (Object) Members data: ImageInfoSpecificRbd Not documented Since 6.1 ImageInfoSpecific (Object) A discriminated record of image format specific information structures. Members type: ImageInfoSpecificKind Not documented The members of ImageInfoSpecificQCow2Wrapper when type is "qcow2" The members of ImageInfoSpecificVmdkWrapper when type is "vmdk" The members of ImageInfoSpecificLUKSWrapper when type is "luks" The members of ImageInfoSpecificRbdWrapper when type is "rbd" Since 1.7 ImageInfo (Object) Information about a QEMU image file Members filename: string name of the image file format: string format of the image file virtual-size: int maximum capacity in bytes of the image actual-size: int (optional) actual size on disk in bytes of the image dirty-flag: boolean (optional) true if image is not cleanly closed cluster-size: int (optional) size of a cluster in bytes encrypted: boolean (optional) true if the image is encrypted compressed: boolean (optional) true if the image is compressed (Since 1.7) backing-filename: string (optional) name of the backing file full-backing-filename: string (optional) full path of the backing file backing-filename-format: string (optional) the format of the backing file snapshots: array of SnapshotInfo (optional) list of VM snapshots backing-image: ImageInfo (optional) info of the backing image (since 1.6) format-specific: ImageInfoSpecific (optional) structure supplying additional format-specific information (since 1.7) Since 1.3 ImageCheck (Object) Information about a QEMU image file check Members filename: string name of the image file checked format: string format of the image file checked check-errors: int number of unexpected errors occurred during check image-end-offset: int (optional) offset (in bytes) where the image ends, this field is present if the driver for the image format supports it corruptions: int (optional) number of corruptions found during the check if any leaks: int (optional) number of leaks found during the check if any corruptions-fixed: int (optional) number of corruptions fixed during the check if any leaks-fixed: int (optional) number of leaks fixed during the check if any total-clusters: int (optional) total number of clusters, this field is present if the driver for the image format supports it allocated-clusters: int (optional) total number of allocated clusters, this field is present if the driver for the image format supports it fragmented-clusters: int (optional) total number of fragmented clusters, this field is present if the driver for the image format supports it compressed-clusters: int (optional) total number of compressed clusters, this field is present if the driver for the image format supports it Since 1.4 MapEntry (Object) Mapping information from a virtual block range to a host file range Members start: int virtual (guest) offset of the first byte described by this entry length: int the number of bytes of the mapped virtual range data: boolean reading the image will actually read data from a file (in particular, if offset is present this means that the sectors are not simply preallocated, but contain actual data in raw format) zero: boolean whether the virtual blocks read as zeroes depth: int number of layers (0 = top image, 1 = top image's backing file, ..., n - 1 = bottom image (where n is the number of images in the chain)) before reaching one for which the range is allocated present: boolean true if this layer provides the data, false if adding a backing layer could impact this region (since 6.1) offset: int (optional) if present, the image file stores the data for this range in raw format at the given (host) offset filename: string (optional) filename that is referred to by offset Since 2.6 BlockdevCacheInfo (Object) Cache mode information for a block device Members writeback: boolean true if writeback mode is enabled direct: boolean true if the host page cache is bypassed (O_DIRECT) no-flush: boolean true if flush requests are ignored for the device Since 2.3 BlockDeviceInfo (Object) Information about the backing device for a block device. Members file: string the filename of the backing device node-name: string (optional) the name of the block driver node (Since 2.0) ro: boolean true if the backing device was open read-only drv: string the name of the block format used to open the backing device. As of 0.14 this can be: 'blkdebug', 'bochs', 'cloop', 'cow', 'dmg', 'file', 'file', 'ftp', 'ftps', 'host_cdrom', 'host_device', 'http', 'https', 'luks', 'nbd', 'parallels', 'qcow', 'qcow2', 'raw', 'vdi', 'vmdk', 'vpc', 'vvfat' 2.2: 'archipelago' added, 'cow' dropped 2.3: 'host_floppy' deprecated 2.5: 'host_floppy' dropped 2.6: 'luks' added 2.8: 'replication' added, 'tftp' dropped 2.9: 'archipelago' dropped backing_file: string (optional) the name of the backing file (for copy-on-write) backing_file_depth: int number of files in the backing file chain (since: 1.2) encrypted: boolean true if the backing device is encrypted detect_zeroes: BlockdevDetectZeroesOptions detect and optimize zero writes (Since 2.1) bps: int total throughput limit in bytes per second is specified bps_rd: int read throughput limit in bytes per second is specified bps_wr: int write throughput limit in bytes per second is specified iops: int total I/O operations per second is specified iops_rd: int read I/O operations per second is specified iops_wr: int write I/O operations per second is specified image: ImageInfo the info of image used (since: 1.6) bps_max: int (optional) total throughput limit during bursts, in bytes (Since 1.7) bps_rd_max: int (optional) read throughput limit during bursts, in bytes (Since 1.7) bps_wr_max: int (optional) write throughput limit during bursts, in bytes (Since 1.7) iops_max: int (optional) total I/O operations per second during bursts, in bytes (Since 1.7) iops_rd_max: int (optional) read I/O operations per second during bursts, in bytes (Since 1.7) iops_wr_max: int (optional) write I/O operations per second during bursts, in bytes (Since 1.7) bps_max_length: int (optional) maximum length of the bps_max burst period, in seconds. (Since 2.6) bps_rd_max_length: int (optional) maximum length of the bps_rd_max burst period, in seconds. (Since 2.6) bps_wr_max_length: int (optional) maximum length of the bps_wr_max burst period, in seconds. (Since 2.6) iops_max_length: int (optional) maximum length of the iops burst period, in seconds. (Since 2.6) iops_rd_max_length: int (optional) maximum length of the iops_rd_max burst period, in seconds. (Since 2.6) iops_wr_max_length: int (optional) maximum length of the iops_wr_max burst period, in seconds. (Since 2.6) iops_size: int (optional) an I/O size in bytes (Since 1.7) group: string (optional) throttle group name (Since 2.4) cache: BlockdevCacheInfo the cache mode used for the block device (since: 2.3) write_threshold: int configured write threshold for the device. 0 if disabled. (Since 2.3) dirty-bitmaps: array of BlockDirtyInfo (optional) dirty bitmaps information (only present if node has one or more dirty bitmaps) (Since 4.2) Since 0.14 BlockDeviceIoStatus (Enum) An enumeration of block device I/O status. Values ok The last I/O operation has succeeded failed The last I/O operation has failed nospace The last I/O operation has failed due to a no-space condition Since 1.0 BlockDirtyInfo (Object) Block dirty bitmap information. Members name: string (optional) the name of the dirty bitmap (Since 2.4) count: int number of dirty bytes according to the dirty bitmap granularity: int granularity of the dirty bitmap in bytes (since 1.4) recording: boolean true if the bitmap is recording new writes from the guest. Replaces active and disabled statuses. (since 4.0) busy: boolean true if the bitmap is in-use by some operation (NBD or jobs) and cannot be modified via QMP or used by another operation. Replaces locked and frozen statuses. (since 4.0) persistent: boolean true if the bitmap was stored on disk, is scheduled to be stored on disk, or both. (since 4.0) inconsistent: boolean (optional) true if this is a persistent bitmap that was improperly stored. Implies persistent to be true; recording and busy to be false. This bitmap cannot be used. To remove it, use block-dirty-bitmap-remove. (Since 4.0) Since 1.3 Qcow2BitmapInfoFlags (Enum) An enumeration of flags that a bitmap can report to the user. Values in-use This flag is set by any process actively modifying the qcow2 file, and cleared when the updated bitmap is flushed to the qcow2 image. The presence of this flag in an offline image means that the bitmap was not saved correctly after its last usage, and may contain inconsistent data. auto The bitmap must reflect all changes of the virtual disk by any application that would write to this qcow2 file. Since 4.0 Qcow2BitmapInfo (Object) Qcow2 bitmap information. Members name: string the name of the bitmap granularity: int granularity of the bitmap in bytes flags: array of Qcow2BitmapInfoFlags flags of the bitmap Since 4.0 BlockLatencyHistogramInfo (Object) Block latency histogram. Members boundaries: array of int list of interval boundary values in nanoseconds, all greater than zero and in ascending order. For example, the list [10, 50, 100] produces the following histogram intervals: [0, 10), [10, 50), [50, 100), [100, +inf). bins: array of int list of io request counts corresponding to histogram intervals. len(bins) = len(boundaries) + 1 For the example above, bins may be something like [3, 1, 5, 2], and corresponding histogram looks like: 5| * 4| * 3| * * 2| * * * 1| * * * * +------------------ 10 50 100 Since 4.0 BlockInfo (Object) Block device information. This structure describes a virtual device and the backing device associated with it. Members device: string The device name associated with the virtual device. qdev: string (optional) The qdev ID, or if no ID is assigned, the QOM path of the block device. (since 2.10) type: string This field is returned only for compatibility reasons, it should not be used (always returns 'unknown') removable: boolean True if the device supports removable media. locked: boolean True if the guest has locked this device from having its media removed tray_open: boolean (optional) True if the device's tray is open (only present if it has a tray) io-status: BlockDeviceIoStatus (optional) BlockDeviceIoStatus. Only present if the device supports it and the VM is configured to stop on errors (supported device models: virtio-blk, IDE, SCSI except scsi-generic) inserted: BlockDeviceInfo (optional) BlockDeviceInfo describing the device if media is present Since 0.14 BlockMeasureInfo (Object) Image file size calculation information. This structure describes the size requirements for creating a new image file. The size requirements depend on the new image file format. File size always equals virtual disk size for the 'raw' format, even for sparse POSIX files. Compact formats such as 'qcow2' represent unallocated and zero regions efficiently so file size may be smaller than virtual disk size. The values are upper bounds that are guaranteed to fit the new image file. Subsequent modification, such as internal snapshot or further bitmap creation, may require additional space and is not covered here. Members required: int Size required for a new image file, in bytes, when copying just allocated guest-visible contents. fully-allocated: int Image file size, in bytes, once data has been written to all sectors, when copying just guest-visible contents. bitmaps: int (optional) Additional size required if all the top-level bitmap metadata in the source image were to be copied to the destination, present only when source and destination both support persistent bitmaps. (since 5.1) Since 2.10 query-block (Command) Get a list of BlockInfo for all virtual block devices. Returns a list of BlockInfo describing each virtual block device. Filter nodes that were created implicitly are skipped over. Since 0.14 Example -> { "execute": "query-block" } <- { "return":[ { "io-status": "ok", "device":"ide0-hd0", "locked":false, "removable":false, "inserted":{ "ro":false, "drv":"qcow2", "encrypted":false, "file":"disks/test.qcow2", "backing_file_depth":1, "bps":1000000, "bps_rd":0, "bps_wr":0, "iops":1000000, "iops_rd":0, "iops_wr":0, "bps_max": 8000000, "bps_rd_max": 0, "bps_wr_max": 0, "iops_max": 0, "iops_rd_max": 0, "iops_wr_max": 0, "iops_size": 0, "detect_zeroes": "on", "write_threshold": 0, "image":{ "filename":"disks/test.qcow2", "format":"qcow2", "virtual-size":2048000, "backing_file":"base.qcow2", "full-backing-filename":"disks/base.qcow2", "backing-filename-format":"qcow2", "snapshots":[ { "id": "1", "name": "snapshot1", "vm-state-size": 0, "date-sec": 10000200, "date-nsec": 12, "vm-clock-sec": 206, "vm-clock-nsec": 30 } ], "backing-image":{ "filename":"disks/base.qcow2", "format":"qcow2", "virtual-size":2048000 } } }, "qdev": "ide_disk", "type":"unknown" }, { "io-status": "ok", "device":"ide1-cd0", "locked":false, "removable":true, "qdev": "/machine/unattached/device[23]", "tray_open": false, "type":"unknown" }, { "device":"floppy0", "locked":false, "removable":true, "qdev": "/machine/unattached/device[20]", "type":"unknown" }, { "device":"sd0", "locked":false, "removable":true, "type":"unknown" } ] } BlockDeviceTimedStats (Object) Statistics of a block device during a given interval of time. Members interval_length: int Interval used for calculating the statistics, in seconds. min_rd_latency_ns: int Minimum latency of read operations in the defined interval, in nanoseconds. min_wr_latency_ns: int Minimum latency of write operations in the defined interval, in nanoseconds. min_flush_latency_ns: int Minimum latency of flush operations in the defined interval, in nanoseconds. max_rd_latency_ns: int Maximum latency of read operations in the defined interval, in nanoseconds. max_wr_latency_ns: int Maximum latency of write operations in the defined interval, in nanoseconds. max_flush_latency_ns: int Maximum latency of flush operations in the defined interval, in nanoseconds. avg_rd_latency_ns: int Average latency of read operations in the defined interval, in nanoseconds. avg_wr_latency_ns: int Average latency of write operations in the defined interval, in nanoseconds. avg_flush_latency_ns: int Average latency of flush operations in the defined interval, in nanoseconds. avg_rd_queue_depth: number Average number of pending read operations in the defined interval. avg_wr_queue_depth: number Average number of pending write operations in the defined interval. Since 2.5 BlockDeviceStats (Object) Statistics of a virtual block device or a block backing device. Members rd_bytes: int The number of bytes read by the device. wr_bytes: int The number of bytes written by the device. unmap_bytes: int The number of bytes unmapped by the device (Since 4.2) rd_operations: int The number of read operations performed by the device. wr_operations: int The number of write operations performed by the device. flush_operations: int The number of cache flush operations performed by the device (since 0.15) unmap_operations: int The number of unmap operations performed by the device (Since 4.2) rd_total_time_ns: int Total time spent on reads in nanoseconds (since 0.15). wr_total_time_ns: int Total time spent on writes in nanoseconds (since 0.15). flush_total_time_ns: int Total time spent on cache flushes in nanoseconds (since 0.15). unmap_total_time_ns: int Total time spent on unmap operations in nanoseconds (Since 4.2) wr_highest_offset: int The offset after the greatest byte written to the device. The intended use of this information is for growable sparse files (like qcow2) that are used on top of a physical device. rd_merged: int Number of read requests that have been merged into another request (Since 2.3). wr_merged: int Number of write requests that have been merged into another request (Since 2.3). unmap_merged: int Number of unmap requests that have been merged into another request (Since 4.2) idle_time_ns: int (optional) Time since the last I/O operation, in nanoseconds. If the field is absent it means that there haven't been any operations yet (Since 2.5). failed_rd_operations: int The number of failed read operations performed by the device (Since 2.5) failed_wr_operations: int The number of failed write operations performed by the device (Since 2.5) failed_flush_operations: int The number of failed flush operations performed by the device (Since 2.5) failed_unmap_operations: int The number of failed unmap operations performed by the device (Since 4.2) invalid_rd_operations: int The number of invalid read operations performed by the device (Since 2.5) invalid_wr_operations: int The number of invalid write operations performed by the device (Since 2.5) invalid_flush_operations: int The number of invalid flush operations performed by the device (Since 2.5) invalid_unmap_operations: int The number of invalid unmap operations performed by the device (Since 4.2) account_invalid: boolean Whether invalid operations are included in the last access statistics (Since 2.5) account_failed: boolean Whether failed operations are included in the latency and last access statistics (Since 2.5) timed_stats: array of BlockDeviceTimedStats Statistics specific to the set of previously defined intervals of time (Since 2.5) rd_latency_histogram: BlockLatencyHistogramInfo (optional) BlockLatencyHistogramInfo. (Since 4.0) wr_latency_histogram: BlockLatencyHistogramInfo (optional) BlockLatencyHistogramInfo. (Since 4.0) flush_latency_histogram: BlockLatencyHistogramInfo (optional) BlockLatencyHistogramInfo. (Since 4.0) Since 0.14 BlockStatsSpecificFile (Object) File driver statistics Members discard-nb-ok: int The number of successful discard operations performed by the driver. discard-nb-failed: int The number of failed discard operations performed by the driver. discard-bytes-ok: int The number of bytes discarded by the driver. Since 4.2 BlockStatsSpecificNvme (Object) NVMe driver statistics Members completion-errors: int The number of completion errors. aligned-accesses: int The number of aligned accesses performed by the driver. unaligned-accesses: int The number of unaligned accesses performed by the driver. Since 5.2 BlockStatsSpecific (Object) Block driver specific statistics Members driver: BlockdevDriver Not documented The members of BlockStatsSpecificFile when driver is "file" The members of BlockStatsSpecificFile when driver is "host_device" (If: HAVE_HOST_BLOCK_DEVICE) The members of BlockStatsSpecificNvme when driver is "nvme" Since 4.2 BlockStats (Object) Statistics of a virtual block device or a block backing device. Members device: string (optional) If the stats are for a virtual block device, the name corresponding to the virtual block device. node-name: string (optional) The node name of the device. (Since 2.3) qdev: string (optional) The qdev ID, or if no ID is assigned, the QOM path of the block device. (since 3.0) stats: BlockDeviceStats A BlockDeviceStats for the device. driver-specific: BlockStatsSpecific (optional) Optional driver-specific stats. (Since 4.2) parent: BlockStats (optional) This describes the file block device if it has one. Contains recursively the statistics of the underlying protocol (e.g. the host file for a qcow2 image). If there is no underlying protocol, this field is omitted backing: BlockStats (optional) This describes the backing block device if it has one. (Since 2.0) Since 0.14 query-blockstats (Command) Query the BlockStats for all virtual block devices. Arguments query-nodes: boolean (optional) If true, the command will query all the block nodes that have a node name, in a list which will include "parent" information, but not "backing". If false or omitted, the behavior is as before - query all the device backends, recursively including their "parent" and "backing". Filter nodes that were created implicitly are skipped over in this mode. (Since 2.3) Returns A list of BlockStats for each virtual block devices. Since 0.14 Example -> { "execute": "query-blockstats" } <- { "return":[ { "device":"ide0-hd0", "parent":{ "stats":{ "wr_highest_offset":3686448128, "wr_bytes":9786368, "wr_operations":751, "rd_bytes":122567168, "rd_operations":36772 "wr_total_times_ns":313253456 "rd_total_times_ns":3465673657 "flush_total_times_ns":49653 "flush_operations":61, "rd_merged":0, "wr_merged":0, "idle_time_ns":2953431879, "account_invalid":true, "account_failed":false } }, "stats":{ "wr_highest_offset":2821110784, "wr_bytes":9786368, "wr_operations":692, "rd_bytes":122739200, "rd_operations":36604 "flush_operations":51, "wr_total_times_ns":313253456 "rd_total_times_ns":3465673657 "flush_total_times_ns":49653, "rd_merged":0, "wr_merged":0, "idle_time_ns":2953431879, "account_invalid":true, "account_failed":false }, "qdev": "/machine/unattached/device[23]" }, { "device":"ide1-cd0", "stats":{ "wr_highest_offset":0, "wr_bytes":0, "wr_operations":0, "rd_bytes":0, "rd_operations":0 "flush_operations":0, "wr_total_times_ns":0 "rd_total_times_ns":0 "flush_total_times_ns":0, "rd_merged":0, "wr_merged":0, "account_invalid":false, "account_failed":false }, "qdev": "/machine/unattached/device[24]" }, { "device":"floppy0", "stats":{ "wr_highest_offset":0, "wr_bytes":0, "wr_operations":0, "rd_bytes":0, "rd_operations":0 "flush_operations":0, "wr_total_times_ns":0 "rd_total_times_ns":0 "flush_total_times_ns":0, "rd_merged":0, "wr_merged":0, "account_invalid":false, "account_failed":false }, "qdev": "/machine/unattached/device[16]" }, { "device":"sd0", "stats":{ "wr_highest_offset":0, "wr_bytes":0, "wr_operations":0, "rd_bytes":0, "rd_operations":0 "flush_operations":0, "wr_total_times_ns":0 "rd_total_times_ns":0 "flush_total_times_ns":0, "rd_merged":0, "wr_merged":0, "account_invalid":false, "account_failed":false } } ] } BlockdevOnError (Enum) An enumeration of possible behaviors for errors on I/O operations. The exact meaning depends on whether the I/O was initiated by a guest or by a block job Values report for guest operations, report the error to the guest; for jobs, cancel the job ignore ignore the error, only report a QMP event (BLOCK_IO_ERROR or BLOCK_JOB_ERROR). The backup, mirror and commit block jobs retry the failing request later and may still complete successfully. The stream block job continues to stream and will complete with an error. enospc same as stop on ENOSPC, same as report otherwise. stop for guest operations, stop the virtual machine; for jobs, pause the job auto inherit the error handling policy of the backend (since: 2.7) Since 1.3 MirrorSyncMode (Enum) An enumeration of possible behaviors for the initial synchronization phase of storage mirroring. Values top copies data in the topmost image to the destination full copies data from all images to the destination none only copy data written from now on incremental only copy data described by the dirty bitmap. (since: 2.4) bitmap only copy data described by the dirty bitmap. (since: 4.2) Behavior on completion is determined by the BitmapSyncMode. Since 1.3 BitmapSyncMode (Enum) An enumeration of possible behaviors for the synchronization of a bitmap when used for data copy operations. Values on-success The bitmap is only synced when the operation is successful. This is the behavior always used for 'INCREMENTAL' backups. never The bitmap is never synchronized with the operation, and is treated solely as a read-only manifest of blocks to copy. always The bitmap is always synchronized with the operation, regardless of whether or not the operation was successful. Since 4.2 MirrorCopyMode (Enum) An enumeration whose values tell the mirror block job when to trigger writes to the target. Values background copy data in background only. write-blocking when data is written to the source, write it (synchronously) to the target as well. In addition, data is copied in background just like in background mode. Since 3.0 BlockJobInfo (Object) Information about a long-running block device operation. Members type: string the job type ('stream' for image streaming) device: string The job identifier. Originally the device name but other values are allowed since QEMU 2.7 len: int Estimated offset value at the completion of the job. This value can arbitrarily change while the job is running, in both directions. offset: int Progress made until now. The unit is arbitrary and the value can only meaningfully be used for the ratio of offset to len. The value is monotonically increasing. busy: boolean false if the job is known to be in a quiescent state, with no pending I/O. Since 1.3. paused: boolean whether the job is paused or, if busy is true, will pause itself as soon as possible. Since 1.3. speed: int the rate limit, bytes per second io-status: BlockDeviceIoStatus the status of the job (since 1.3) ready: boolean true if the job may be completed (since 2.2) status: JobStatus Current job state/status (since 2.12) auto-finalize: boolean Job will finalize itself when PENDING, moving to the CONCLUDED state. (since 2.12) auto-dismiss: boolean Job will dismiss itself when CONCLUDED, moving to the NULL state and disappearing from the query list. (since 2.12) error: string (optional) Error information if the job did not complete successfully. Not set if the job completed successfully. (since 2.12.1) Since 1.1 query-block-jobs (Command) Return information about long-running block device operations. Returns a list of BlockJobInfo for each active block job Since 1.1 block_resize (Command) Resize a block image while a guest is running. Either device or node-name must be set but not both. Arguments device: string (optional) the name of the device to get the image resized node-name: string (optional) graph node name to get the image resized (Since 2.0) size: int new image size in bytes Returns • nothing on success • If device is not a valid block device, DeviceNotFound Since 0.14 Example -> { "execute": "block_resize", "arguments": { "device": "scratch", "size": 1073741824 } } <- { "return": {} } NewImageMode (Enum) An enumeration that tells QEMU how to set the backing file path in a new image file. Values existing QEMU should look for an existing image file. absolute-paths QEMU should create a new image with absolute paths for the backing file. If there is no backing file available, the new image will not be backed either. Since 1.1 BlockdevSnapshotSync (Object) Either device or node-name must be set but not both. Members device: string (optional) the name of the device to take a snapshot of. node-name: string (optional) graph node name to generate the snapshot from (Since 2.0) snapshot-file: string the target of the new overlay image. If the file exists, or if it is a device, the overlay will be created in the existing file/device. Otherwise, a new file will be created. snapshot-node-name: string (optional) the graph node name of the new image (Since 2.0) format: string (optional) the format of the overlay image, default is 'qcow2'. mode: NewImageMode (optional) whether and how QEMU should create a new image, default is 'absolute-paths'. BlockdevSnapshot (Object) Members node: string device or node name that will have a snapshot taken. overlay: string reference to the existing block device that will become the overlay of node, as part of taking the snapshot. It must not have a current backing file (this can be achieved by passing "backing": null to blockdev-add). Since 2.5 BackupPerf (Object) Optional parameters for backup. These parameters don't affect functionality, but may significantly affect performance. Members use-copy-range: boolean (optional) Use copy offloading. Default false. max-workers: int (optional) Maximum number of parallel requests for the sustained background copying process. Doesn't influence copy-before-write operations. Default 64. max-chunk: int (optional) Maximum request length for the sustained background copying process. Doesn't influence copy-before-write operations. 0 means unlimited. If max-chunk is non-zero then it should not be less than job cluster size which is calculated as maximum of target image cluster size and 64k. Default 0. Since 6.0 BackupCommon (Object) Members job-id: string (optional) identifier for the newly-created block job. If omitted, the device name will be used. (Since 2.7) device: string the device name or node-name of a root node which should be copied. sync: MirrorSyncMode what parts of the disk image should be copied to the destination (all the disk, only the sectors allocated in the topmost image, from a dirty bitmap, or only new I/O). speed: int (optional) the maximum speed, in bytes per second. The default is 0, for unlimited. bitmap: string (optional) The name of a dirty bitmap to use. Must be present if sync is "bitmap" or "incremental". Can be present if sync is "full" or "top". Must not be present otherwise. (Since 2.4 (drive-backup), 3.1 (blockdev-backup)) bitmap-mode: BitmapSyncMode (optional) Specifies the type of data the bitmap should contain after the operation concludes. Must be present if a bitmap was provided, Must NOT be present otherwise. (Since 4.2) compress: boolean (optional) true to compress data, if the target format supports it. (default: false) (since 2.8) on-source-error: BlockdevOnError (optional) the action to take on an error on the source, default 'report'. 'stop' and 'enospc' can only be used if the block device supports io-status (see BlockInfo). on-target-error: BlockdevOnError (optional) the action to take on an error on the target, default 'report' (no limitations, since this applies to a different block device than device). auto-finalize: boolean (optional) When false, this job will wait in a PENDING state after it has finished its work, waiting for block-job-finalize before making any block graph changes. When true, this job will automatically perform its abort or commit actions. Defaults to true. (Since 2.12) auto-dismiss: boolean (optional) When false, this job will wait in a CONCLUDED state after it has completely ceased all work, and awaits block-job-dismiss. When true, this job will automatically disappear from the query list without user intervention. Defaults to true. (Since 2.12) filter-node-name: string (optional) the node name that should be assigned to the filter driver that the backup job inserts into the graph above node specified by drive. If this option is not given, a node name is autogenerated. (Since: 4.2) x-perf: BackupPerf (optional) Performance options. (Since 6.0) Features unstable Member x-perf is experimental. Note on-source-error and on-target-error only affect background I/O. If an error occurs during a guest write request, the device's rerror/werror actions will be used. Since 4.2 DriveBackup (Object) Members target: string the target of the new image. If the file exists, or if it is a device, the existing file/device will be used as the new destination. If it does not exist, a new file will be created. format: string (optional) the format of the new destination, default is to probe if mode is 'existing', else the format of the source mode: NewImageMode (optional) whether and how QEMU should create a new image, default is 'absolute-paths'. The members of BackupCommon Since 1.6 BlockdevBackup (Object) Members target: string the device name or node-name of the backup target node. The members of BackupCommon Since 2.3 blockdev-snapshot-sync (Command) Takes a synchronous snapshot of a block device. For the arguments, see the documentation of BlockdevSnapshotSync. Returns • nothing on success • If device is not a valid block device, DeviceNotFound Since 0.14 Example -> { "execute": "blockdev-snapshot-sync", "arguments": { "device": "ide-hd0", "snapshot-file": "/some/place/my-image", "format": "qcow2" } } <- { "return": {} } blockdev-snapshot (Command) Takes a snapshot of a block device. Take a snapshot, by installing 'node' as the backing image of 'overlay'. Additionally, if 'node' is associated with a block device, the block device changes to using 'overlay' as its new active image. For the arguments, see the documentation of BlockdevSnapshot. Features allow-write-only-overlay If present, the check whether this operation is safe was relaxed so that it can be used to change backing file of a destination of a blockdev-mirror. (since 5.0) Since 2.5 Example -> { "execute": "blockdev-add", "arguments": { "driver": "qcow2", "node-name": "node1534", "file": { "driver": "file", "filename": "hd1.qcow2" }, "backing": null } } <- { "return": {} } -> { "execute": "blockdev-snapshot", "arguments": { "node": "ide-hd0", "overlay": "node1534" } } <- { "return": {} } change-backing-file (Command) Change the backing file in the image file metadata. This does not cause QEMU to reopen the image file to reparse the backing filename (it may, however, perform a reopen to change permissions from r/o -> r/w -> r/o, if needed). The new backing file string is written into the image file metadata, and the QEMU internal strings are updated. Arguments image-node-name: string The name of the block driver state node of the image to modify. The "device" argument is used to verify "image-node-name" is in the chain described by "device". device: string The device name or node-name of the root node that owns image-node-name. backing-file: string The string to write as the backing file. This string is not validated, so care should be taken when specifying the string or the image chain may not be able to be reopened again. Returns • Nothing on success • If "device" does not exist or cannot be determined, DeviceNotFound Since 2.1 block-commit (Command) Live commit of data from overlay image nodes into backing nodes - i.e., writes data between 'top' and 'base' into 'base'. If top == base, that is an error. If top has no overlays on top of it, or if it is in use by a writer, the job will not be completed by itself. The user needs to complete the job with the block-job-complete command after getting the ready event. (Since 2.0) If the base image is smaller than top, then the base image will be resized to be the same size as top. If top is smaller than the base image, the base will not be truncated. If you want the base image size to match the size of the smaller top, you can safely truncate it yourself once the commit operation successfully completes. Arguments job-id: string (optional) identifier for the newly-created block job. If omitted, the device name will be used. (Since 2.7) device: string the device name or node-name of a root node base-node: string (optional) The node name of the backing image to write data into. If not specified, this is the deepest backing image. (since: 3.1) base: string (optional) Same as base-node, except that it is a file name rather than a node name. This must be the exact filename string that was used to open the node; other strings, even if addressing the same file, are not accepted top-node: string (optional) The node name of the backing image within the image chain which contains the topmost data to be committed down. If not specified, this is the active layer. (since: 3.1) top: string (optional) Same as top-node, except that it is a file name rather than a node name. This must be the exact filename string that was used to open the node; other strings, even if addressing the same file, are not accepted backing-file: string (optional) The backing file string to write into the overlay image of 'top'. If 'top' does not have an overlay image, or if 'top' is in use by a writer, specifying a backing file string is an error. This filename is not validated. If a pathname string is such that it cannot be resolved by QEMU, that means that subsequent QMP or HMP commands must use node-names for the image in question, as filename lookup methods will fail. If not specified, QEMU will automatically determine the backing file string to use, or error out if there is no obvious choice. Care should be taken when specifying the string, to specify a valid filename or protocol. (Since 2.1) speed: int (optional) the maximum speed, in bytes per second on-error: BlockdevOnError (optional) the action to take on an error. 'ignore' means that the request should be retried. (default: report; Since: 5.0) filter-node-name: string (optional) the node name that should be assigned to the filter driver that the commit job inserts into the graph above top. If this option is not given, a node name is autogenerated. (Since: 2.9) auto-finalize: boolean (optional) When false, this job will wait in a PENDING state after it has finished its work, waiting for block-job-finalize before making any block graph changes. When true, this job will automatically perform its abort or commit actions. Defaults to true. (Since 3.1) auto-dismiss: boolean (optional) When false, this job will wait in a CONCLUDED state after it has completely ceased all work, and awaits block-job-dismiss. When true, this job will automatically disappear from the query list without user intervention. Defaults to true. (Since 3.1) Features deprecated Members base and top are deprecated. Use base-node and top-node instead. Returns • Nothing on success • If device does not exist, DeviceNotFound • Any other error returns a GenericError. Since 1.3 Example -> { "execute": "block-commit", "arguments": { "device": "virtio0", "top": "/tmp/snap1.qcow2" } } <- { "return": {} } drive-backup (Command) Start a point-in-time copy of a block device to a new destination. The status of ongoing drive-backup operations can be checked with query-block-jobs where the BlockJobInfo.type field has the value 'backup'. The operation can be stopped before it has completed using the block-job-cancel command. Arguments The members of DriveBackup Features deprecated This command is deprecated. Use blockdev-backup instead. Returns • nothing on success • If device is not a valid block device, GenericError Since 1.6 Example -> { "execute": "drive-backup", "arguments": { "device": "drive0", "sync": "full", "target": "backup.img" } } <- { "return": {} } blockdev-backup (Command) Start a point-in-time copy of a block device to a new destination. The status of ongoing blockdev-backup operations can be checked with query-block-jobs where the BlockJobInfo.type field has the value 'backup'. The operation can be stopped before it has completed using the block-job-cancel command. Arguments The members of BlockdevBackup Returns • nothing on success • If device is not a valid block device, DeviceNotFound Since 2.3 Example -> { "execute": "blockdev-backup", "arguments": { "device": "src-id", "sync": "full", "target": "tgt-id" } } <- { "return": {} } query-named-block-nodes (Command) Get the named block driver list Arguments flat: boolean (optional) Omit the nested data about backing image ("backing-image" key) if true. Default is false (Since 5.0) Returns the list of BlockDeviceInfo Since 2.0 Example -> { "execute": "query-named-block-nodes" } <- { "return": [ { "ro":false, "drv":"qcow2", "encrypted":false, "file":"disks/test.qcow2", "node-name": "my-node", "backing_file_depth":1, "bps":1000000, "bps_rd":0, "bps_wr":0, "iops":1000000, "iops_rd":0, "iops_wr":0, "bps_max": 8000000, "bps_rd_max": 0, "bps_wr_max": 0, "iops_max": 0, "iops_rd_max": 0, "iops_wr_max": 0, "iops_size": 0, "write_threshold": 0, "image":{ "filename":"disks/test.qcow2", "format":"qcow2", "virtual-size":2048000, "backing_file":"base.qcow2", "full-backing-filename":"disks/base.qcow2", "backing-filename-format":"qcow2", "snapshots":[ { "id": "1", "name": "snapshot1", "vm-state-size": 0, "date-sec": 10000200, "date-nsec": 12, "vm-clock-sec": 206, "vm-clock-nsec": 30 } ], "backing-image":{ "filename":"disks/base.qcow2", "format":"qcow2", "virtual-size":2048000 } } } ] } XDbgBlockGraphNodeType (Enum) Values block-backend corresponds to BlockBackend block-job corresponds to BlockJob block-driver corresponds to BlockDriverState Since 4.0 XDbgBlockGraphNode (Object) Members id: int Block graph node identifier. This id is generated only for x-debug-query-block-graph and does not relate to any other identifiers in Qemu. type: XDbgBlockGraphNodeType Type of graph node. Can be one of block-backend, block-job or block-driver-state. name: string Human readable name of the node. Corresponds to node-name for block-driver-state nodes; is not guaranteed to be unique in the whole graph (with block-jobs and block-backends). Since 4.0 BlockPermission (Enum) Enum of base block permissions. Values consistent-read A user that has the "permission" of consistent reads is guaranteed that their view of the contents of the block device is complete and self-consistent, representing the contents of a disk at a specific point. For most block devices (including their backing files) this is true, but the property cannot be maintained in a few situations like for intermediate nodes of a commit block job. write This permission is required to change the visible disk contents. write-unchanged This permission (which is weaker than BLK_PERM_WRITE) is both enough and required for writes to the block node when the caller promises that the visible disk content doesn't change. As the BLK_PERM_WRITE permission is strictly stronger, either is sufficient to perform an unchanging write. resize This permission is required to change the size of a block node. graph-mod This permission is required to change the node that this BdrvChild points to. Since 4.0 XDbgBlockGraphEdge (Object) Block Graph edge description for x-debug-query-block-graph. Members parent: int parent id child: int child id name: string name of the relation (examples are 'file' and 'backing') perm: array of BlockPermission granted permissions for the parent operating on the child shared-perm: array of BlockPermission permissions that can still be granted to other users of the child while it is still attached to this parent Since 4.0 XDbgBlockGraph (Object) Block Graph - list of nodes and list of edges. Members nodes: array of XDbgBlockGraphNode Not documented edges: array of XDbgBlockGraphEdge Not documented Since 4.0 x-debug-query-block-graph (Command) Get the block graph. Features unstable This command is meant for debugging. Since 4.0 drive-mirror (Command) Start mirroring a block device's writes to a new destination. target specifies the target of the new image. If the file exists, or if it is a device, it will be used as the new destination for writes. If it does not exist, a new file will be created. format specifies the format of the mirror image, default is to probe if mode='existing', else the format of the source. Arguments The members of DriveMirror Returns • nothing on success • If device is not a valid block device, GenericError Since 1.3 Example -> { "execute": "drive-mirror", "arguments": { "device": "ide-hd0", "target": "/some/place/my-image", "sync": "full", "format": "qcow2" } } <- { "return": {} } DriveMirror (Object) A set of parameters describing drive mirror setup. Members job-id: string (optional) identifier for the newly-created block job. If omitted, the device name will be used. (Since 2.7) device: string the device name or node-name of a root node whose writes should be mirrored. target: string the target of the new image. If the file exists, or if it is a device, the existing file/device will be used as the new destination. If it does not exist, a new file will be created. format: string (optional) the format of the new destination, default is to probe if mode is 'existing', else the format of the source node-name: string (optional) the new block driver state node name in the graph (Since 2.1) replaces: string (optional) with sync=full graph node name to be replaced by the new image when a whole image copy is done. This can be used to repair broken Quorum files. By default, device is replaced, although implicitly created filters on it are kept. (Since 2.1) mode: NewImageMode (optional) whether and how QEMU should create a new image, default is 'absolute-paths'. speed: int (optional) the maximum speed, in bytes per second sync: MirrorSyncMode what parts of the disk image should be copied to the destination (all the disk, only the sectors allocated in the topmost image, or only new I/O). granularity: int (optional) granularity of the dirty bitmap, default is 64K if the image format doesn't have clusters, 4K if the clusters are smaller than that, else the cluster size. Must be a power of 2 between 512 and 64M (since 1.4). buf-size: int (optional) maximum amount of data in flight from source to target (since 1.4). on-source-error: BlockdevOnError (optional) the action to take on an error on the source, default 'report'. 'stop' and 'enospc' can only be used if the block device supports io-status (see BlockInfo). on-target-error: BlockdevOnError (optional) the action to take on an error on the target, default 'report' (no limitations, since this applies to a different block device than device). unmap: boolean (optional) Whether to try to unmap target sectors where source has only zero. If true, and target unallocated sectors will read as zero, target image sectors will be unmapped; otherwise, zeroes will be written. Both will result in identical contents. Default is true. (Since 2.4) copy-mode: MirrorCopyMode (optional) when to copy data to the destination; defaults to 'background' (Since: 3.0) auto-finalize: boolean (optional) When false, this job will wait in a PENDING state after it has finished its work, waiting for block-job-finalize before making any block graph changes. When true, this job will automatically perform its abort or commit actions. Defaults to true. (Since 3.1) auto-dismiss: boolean (optional) When false, this job will wait in a CONCLUDED state after it has completely ceased all work, and awaits block-job-dismiss. When true, this job will automatically disappear from the query list without user intervention. Defaults to true. (Since 3.1) Since 1.3 BlockDirtyBitmap (Object) Members node: string name of device/node which the bitmap is tracking name: string name of the dirty bitmap Since 2.4 BlockDirtyBitmapAdd (Object) Members node: string name of device/node which the bitmap is tracking name: string name of the dirty bitmap (must be less than 1024 bytes) granularity: int (optional) the bitmap granularity, default is 64k for block-dirty-bitmap-add persistent: boolean (optional) the bitmap is persistent, i.e. it will be saved to the corresponding block device image file on its close. For now only Qcow2 disks support persistent bitmaps. Default is false for block-dirty-bitmap-add. (Since: 2.10) disabled: boolean (optional) the bitmap is created in the disabled state, which means that it will not track drive changes. The bitmap may be enabled with block-dirty-bitmap-enable. Default is false. (Since: 4.0) Since 2.4 BlockDirtyBitmapMergeSource (Alternate) Members local: string name of the bitmap, attached to the same node as target bitmap. external: BlockDirtyBitmap bitmap with specified node Since 4.1 BlockDirtyBitmapMerge (Object) Members node: string name of device/node which the target bitmap is tracking target: string name of the destination dirty bitmap bitmaps: array of BlockDirtyBitmapMergeSource name(s) of the source dirty bitmap(s) at node and/or fully specified BlockDirtyBitmap elements. The latter are supported since 4.1. Since 4.0 block-dirty-bitmap-add (Command) Create a dirty bitmap with a name on the node, and start tracking the writes. Returns • nothing on success • If node is not a valid block device or node, DeviceNotFound • If name is already taken, GenericError with an explanation Since 2.4 Example -> { "execute": "block-dirty-bitmap-add", "arguments": { "node": "drive0", "name": "bitmap0" } } <- { "return": {} } block-dirty-bitmap-remove (Command) Stop write tracking and remove the dirty bitmap that was created with block-dirty-bitmap-add. If the bitmap is persistent, remove it from its storage too. Returns • nothing on success • If node is not a valid block device or node, DeviceNotFound • If name is not found, GenericError with an explanation • if name is frozen by an operation, GenericError Since 2.4 Example -> { "execute": "block-dirty-bitmap-remove", "arguments": { "node": "drive0", "name": "bitmap0" } } <- { "return": {} } block-dirty-bitmap-clear (Command) Clear (reset) a dirty bitmap on the device, so that an incremental backup from this point in time forward will only backup clusters modified after this clear operation. Returns • nothing on success • If node is not a valid block device, DeviceNotFound • If name is not found, GenericError with an explanation Since 2.4 Example -> { "execute": "block-dirty-bitmap-clear", "arguments": { "node": "drive0", "name": "bitmap0" } } <- { "return": {} } block-dirty-bitmap-enable (Command) Enables a dirty bitmap so that it will begin tracking disk changes. Returns • nothing on success • If node is not a valid block device, DeviceNotFound • If name is not found, GenericError with an explanation Since 4.0 Example -> { "execute": "block-dirty-bitmap-enable", "arguments": { "node": "drive0", "name": "bitmap0" } } <- { "return": {} } block-dirty-bitmap-disable (Command) Disables a dirty bitmap so that it will stop tracking disk changes. Returns • nothing on success • If node is not a valid block device, DeviceNotFound • If name is not found, GenericError with an explanation Since 4.0 Example -> { "execute": "block-dirty-bitmap-disable", "arguments": { "node": "drive0", "name": "bitmap0" } } <- { "return": {} } block-dirty-bitmap-merge (Command) Merge dirty bitmaps listed in bitmaps to the target dirty bitmap. Dirty bitmaps in bitmaps will be unchanged, except if it also appears as the target bitmap. Any bits already set in target will still be set after the merge, i.e., this operation does not clear the target. On error, target is unchanged. The resulting bitmap will count as dirty any clusters that were dirty in any of the source bitmaps. This can be used to achieve backup checkpoints, or in simpler usages, to copy bitmaps. Returns • nothing on success • If node is not a valid block device, DeviceNotFound • If any bitmap in bitmaps or target is not found, GenericError • If any of the bitmaps have different sizes or granularities, GenericError Since 4.0 Example -> { "execute": "block-dirty-bitmap-merge", "arguments": { "node": "drive0", "target": "bitmap0", "bitmaps": ["bitmap1"] } } <- { "return": {} } BlockDirtyBitmapSha256 (Object) SHA256 hash of dirty bitmap data Members sha256: string ASCII representation of SHA256 bitmap hash Since 2.10 x-debug-block-dirty-bitmap-sha256 (Command) Get bitmap SHA256. Features unstable This command is meant for debugging. Returns • BlockDirtyBitmapSha256 on success • If node is not a valid block device, DeviceNotFound • If name is not found or if hashing has failed, GenericError with an explanation Since 2.10 blockdev-mirror (Command) Start mirroring a block device's writes to a new destination. Arguments job-id: string (optional) identifier for the newly-created block job. If omitted, the device name will be used. (Since 2.7) device: string The device name or node-name of a root node whose writes should be mirrored. target: string the id or node-name of the block device to mirror to. This mustn't be attached to guest. replaces: string (optional) with sync=full graph node name to be replaced by the new image when a whole image copy is done. This can be used to repair broken Quorum files. By default, device is replaced, although implicitly created filters on it are kept. speed: int (optional) the maximum speed, in bytes per second sync: MirrorSyncMode what parts of the disk image should be copied to the destination (all the disk, only the sectors allocated in the topmost image, or only new I/O). granularity: int (optional) granularity of the dirty bitmap, default is 64K if the image format doesn't have clusters, 4K if the clusters are smaller than that, else the cluster size. Must be a power of 2 between 512 and 64M buf-size: int (optional) maximum amount of data in flight from source to target on-source-error: BlockdevOnError (optional) the action to take on an error on the source, default 'report'. 'stop' and 'enospc' can only be used if the block device supports io-status (see BlockInfo). on-target-error: BlockdevOnError (optional) the action to take on an error on the target, default 'report' (no limitations, since this applies to a different block device than device). filter-node-name: string (optional) the node name that should be assigned to the filter driver that the mirror job inserts into the graph above device. If this option is not given, a node name is autogenerated. (Since: 2.9) copy-mode: MirrorCopyMode (optional) when to copy data to the destination; defaults to 'background' (Since: 3.0) auto-finalize: boolean (optional) When false, this job will wait in a PENDING state after it has finished its work, waiting for block-job-finalize before making any block graph changes. When true, this job will automatically perform its abort or commit actions. Defaults to true. (Since 3.1) auto-dismiss: boolean (optional) When false, this job will wait in a CONCLUDED state after it has completely ceased all work, and awaits block-job-dismiss. When true, this job will automatically disappear from the query list without user intervention. Defaults to true. (Since 3.1) Returns nothing on success. Since 2.6 Example -> { "execute": "blockdev-mirror", "arguments": { "device": "ide-hd0", "target": "target0", "sync": "full" } } <- { "return": {} } BlockIOThrottle (Object) A set of parameters describing block throttling. Members device: string (optional) Block device name id: string (optional) The name or QOM path of the guest device (since: 2.8) bps: int total throughput limit in bytes per second bps_rd: int read throughput limit in bytes per second bps_wr: int write throughput limit in bytes per second iops: int total I/O operations per second iops_rd: int read I/O operations per second iops_wr: int write I/O operations per second bps_max: int (optional) total throughput limit during bursts, in bytes (Since 1.7) bps_rd_max: int (optional) read throughput limit during bursts, in bytes (Since 1.7) bps_wr_max: int (optional) write throughput limit during bursts, in bytes (Since 1.7) iops_max: int (optional) total I/O operations per second during bursts, in bytes (Since 1.7) iops_rd_max: int (optional) read I/O operations per second during bursts, in bytes (Since 1.7) iops_wr_max: int (optional) write I/O operations per second during bursts, in bytes (Since 1.7) bps_max_length: int (optional) maximum length of the bps_max burst period, in seconds. It must only be set if bps_max is set as well. Defaults to 1. (Since 2.6) bps_rd_max_length: int (optional) maximum length of the bps_rd_max burst period, in seconds. It must only be set if bps_rd_max is set as well. Defaults to 1. (Since 2.6) bps_wr_max_length: int (optional) maximum length of the bps_wr_max burst period, in seconds. It must only be set if bps_wr_max is set as well. Defaults to 1. (Since 2.6) iops_max_length: int (optional) maximum length of the iops burst period, in seconds. It must only be set if iops_max is set as well. Defaults to 1. (Since 2.6) iops_rd_max_length: int (optional) maximum length of the iops_rd_max burst period, in seconds. It must only be set if iops_rd_max is set as well. Defaults to 1. (Since 2.6) iops_wr_max_length: int (optional) maximum length of the iops_wr_max burst period, in seconds. It must only be set if iops_wr_max is set as well. Defaults to 1. (Since 2.6) iops_size: int (optional) an I/O size in bytes (Since 1.7) group: string (optional) throttle group name (Since 2.4) Features deprecated Member device is deprecated. Use id instead. Since 1.1 ThrottleLimits (Object) Limit parameters for throttling. Since some limit combinations are illegal, limits should always be set in one transaction. All fields are optional. When setting limits, if a field is missing the current value is not changed. Members iops-total: int (optional) limit total I/O operations per second iops-total-max: int (optional) I/O operations burst iops-total-max-length: int (optional) length of the iops-total-max burst period, in seconds It must only be set if iops-total-max is set as well. iops-read: int (optional) limit read operations per second iops-read-max: int (optional) I/O operations read burst iops-read-max-length: int (optional) length of the iops-read-max burst period, in seconds It must only be set if iops-read-max is set as well. iops-write: int (optional) limit write operations per second iops-write-max: int (optional) I/O operations write burst iops-write-max-length: int (optional) length of the iops-write-max burst period, in seconds It must only be set if iops-write-max is set as well. bps-total: int (optional) limit total bytes per second bps-total-max: int (optional) total bytes burst bps-total-max-length: int (optional) length of the bps-total-max burst period, in seconds. It must only be set if bps-total-max is set as well. bps-read: int (optional) limit read bytes per second bps-read-max: int (optional) total bytes read burst bps-read-max-length: int (optional) length of the bps-read-max burst period, in seconds It must only be set if bps-read-max is set as well. bps-write: int (optional) limit write bytes per second bps-write-max: int (optional) total bytes write burst bps-write-max-length: int (optional) length of the bps-write-max burst period, in seconds It must only be set if bps-write-max is set as well. iops-size: int (optional) when limiting by iops max size of an I/O in bytes Since 2.11 ThrottleGroupProperties (Object) Properties for throttle-group objects. Members limits: ThrottleLimits (optional) limits to apply for this throttle group x-iops-total: int (optional) Not documented x-iops-total-max: int (optional) Not documented x-iops-total-max-length: int (optional) Not documented x-iops-read: int (optional) Not documented x-iops-read-max: int (optional) Not documented x-iops-read-max-length: int (optional) Not documented x-iops-write: int (optional) Not documented x-iops-write-max: int (optional) Not documented x-iops-write-max-length: int (optional) Not documented x-bps-total: int (optional) Not documented x-bps-total-max: int (optional) Not documented x-bps-total-max-length: int (optional) Not documented x-bps-read: int (optional) Not documented x-bps-read-max: int (optional) Not documented x-bps-read-max-length: int (optional) Not documented x-bps-write: int (optional) Not documented x-bps-write-max: int (optional) Not documented x-bps-write-max-length: int (optional) Not documented x-iops-size: int (optional) Not documented Features unstable All members starting with x- are aliases for the same key without x- in the limits object. This is not a stable interface and may be removed or changed incompatibly in the future. Use limits for a supported stable interface. Since 2.11 block-stream (Command) Copy data from a backing file into a block device. The block streaming operation is performed in the background until the entire backing file has been copied. This command returns immediately once streaming has started. The status of ongoing block streaming operations can be checked with query-block-jobs. The operation can be stopped before it has completed using the block-job-cancel command. The node that receives the data is called the top image, can be located in any part of the chain (but always above the base image; see below) and can be specified using its device or node name. Earlier qemu versions only allowed 'device' to name the top level node; presence of the 'base-node' parameter during introspection can be used as a witness of the enhanced semantics of 'device'. If a base file is specified then sectors are not copied from that base file and its backing chain. This can be used to stream a subset of the backing file chain instead of flattening the entire image. When streaming completes the image file will have the base file as its backing file, unless that node was changed while the job was running. In that case, base's parent's backing (or filtered, whichever exists) child (i.e., base at the beginning of the job) will be the new backing file. On successful completion the image file is updated to drop the backing file and the BLOCK_JOB_COMPLETED event is emitted. In case device is a filter node, block-stream modifies the first non-filter overlay node below it to point to the new backing node instead of modifying device itself. Arguments job-id: string (optional) identifier for the newly-created block job. If omitted, the device name will be used. (Since 2.7) device: string the device or node name of the top image base: string (optional) the common backing file name. It cannot be set if base-node or bottom is also set. base-node: string (optional) the node name of the backing file. It cannot be set if base or bottom is also set. (Since 2.8) bottom: string (optional) the last node in the chain that should be streamed into top. It cannot be set if base or base-node is also set. It cannot be filter node. (Since 6.0) backing-file: string (optional) The backing file string to write into the top image. This filename is not validated. If a pathname string is such that it cannot be resolved by QEMU, that means that subsequent QMP or HMP commands must use node-names for the image in question, as filename lookup methods will fail. If not specified, QEMU will automatically determine the backing file string to use, or error out if there is no obvious choice. Care should be taken when specifying the string, to specify a valid filename or protocol. (Since 2.1) speed: int (optional) the maximum speed, in bytes per second on-error: BlockdevOnError (optional) the action to take on an error (default report). 'stop' and 'enospc' can only be used if the block device supports io-status (see BlockInfo). Since 1.3. filter-node-name: string (optional) the node name that should be assigned to the filter driver that the stream job inserts into the graph above device. If this option is not given, a node name is autogenerated. (Since: 6.0) auto-finalize: boolean (optional) When false, this job will wait in a PENDING state after it has finished its work, waiting for block-job-finalize before making any block graph changes. When true, this job will automatically perform its abort or commit actions. Defaults to true. (Since 3.1) auto-dismiss: boolean (optional) When false, this job will wait in a CONCLUDED state after it has completely ceased all work, and awaits block-job-dismiss. When true, this job will automatically disappear from the query list without user intervention. Defaults to true. (Since 3.1) Returns • Nothing on success. • If device does not exist, DeviceNotFound. Since 1.1 Example -> { "execute": "block-stream", "arguments": { "device": "virtio0", "base": "/tmp/master.qcow2" } } <- { "return": {} } block-job-set-speed (Command) Set maximum speed for a background block operation. This command can only be issued when there is an active block job. Throttling can be disabled by setting the speed to 0. Arguments device: string The job identifier. This used to be a device name (hence the name of the parameter), but since QEMU 2.7 it can have other values. speed: int the maximum speed, in bytes per second, or 0 for unlimited. Defaults to 0. Returns • Nothing on success • If no background operation is active on this device, DeviceNotActive Since 1.1 block-job-cancel (Command) Stop an active background block operation. This command returns immediately after marking the active background block operation for cancellation. It is an error to call this command if no operation is in progress. The operation will cancel as soon as possible and then emit the BLOCK_JOB_CANCELLED event. Before that happens the job is still visible when enumerated using query-block-jobs. Note that if you issue 'block-job-cancel' after 'drive-mirror' has indicated (via the event BLOCK_JOB_READY) that the source and destination are synchronized, then the event triggered by this command changes to BLOCK_JOB_COMPLETED, to indicate that the mirroring has ended and the destination now has a point-in-time copy tied to the time of the cancellation. For streaming, the image file retains its backing file unless the streaming operation happens to complete just as it is being cancelled. A new streaming operation can be started at a later time to finish copying all data from the backing file. Arguments device: string The job identifier. This used to be a device name (hence the name of the parameter), but since QEMU 2.7 it can have other values. force: boolean (optional) If true, and the job has already emitted the event BLOCK_JOB_READY, abandon the job immediately (even if it is paused) instead of waiting for the destination to complete its final synchronization (since 1.3) Returns • Nothing on success • If no background operation is active on this device, DeviceNotActive Since 1.1 block-job-pause (Command) Pause an active background block operation. This command returns immediately after marking the active background block operation for pausing. It is an error to call this command if no operation is in progress or if the job is already paused. The operation will pause as soon as possible. No event is emitted when the operation is actually paused. Cancelling a paused job automatically resumes it. Arguments device: string The job identifier. This used to be a device name (hence the name of the parameter), but since QEMU 2.7 it can have other values. Returns • Nothing on success • If no background operation is active on this device, DeviceNotActive Since 1.3 block-job-resume (Command) Resume an active background block operation. This command returns immediately after resuming a paused background block operation. It is an error to call this command if no operation is in progress or if the job is not paused. This command also clears the error status of the job. Arguments device: string The job identifier. This used to be a device name (hence the name of the parameter), but since QEMU 2.7 it can have other values. Returns • Nothing on success • If no background operation is active on this device, DeviceNotActive Since 1.3 block-job-complete (Command) Manually trigger completion of an active background block operation. This is supported for drive mirroring, where it also switches the device to write to the target path only. The ability to complete is signaled with a BLOCK_JOB_READY event. This command completes an active background block operation synchronously. The ordering of this command's return with the BLOCK_JOB_COMPLETED event is not defined. Note that if an I/O error occurs during the processing of this command: 1) the command itself will fail; 2) the error will be processed according to the rerror/werror arguments that were specified when starting the operation. A cancelled or paused job cannot be completed. Arguments device: string The job identifier. This used to be a device name (hence the name of the parameter), but since QEMU 2.7 it can have other values. Returns • Nothing on success • If no background operation is active on this device, DeviceNotActive Since 1.3 block-job-dismiss (Command) For jobs that have already concluded, remove them from the block-job-query list. This command only needs to be run for jobs which were started with QEMU 2.12+ job lifetime management semantics. This command will refuse to operate on any job that has not yet reached its terminal state, JOB_STATUS_CONCLUDED. For jobs that make use of the BLOCK_JOB_READY event, block-job-cancel or block-job-complete will still need to be used as appropriate. Arguments id: string The job identifier. Returns Nothing on success Since 2.12 block-job-finalize (Command) Once a job that has manual=true reaches the pending state, it can be instructed to finalize any graph changes and do any necessary cleanup via this command. For jobs in a transaction, instructing one job to finalize will force ALL jobs in the transaction to finalize, so it is only necessary to instruct a single member job to finalize. Arguments id: string The job identifier. Returns Nothing on success Since 2.12 BlockdevDiscardOptions (Enum) Determines how to handle discard requests. Values ignore Ignore the request unmap Forward as an unmap request Since 2.9 BlockdevDetectZeroesOptions (Enum) Describes the operation mode for the automatic conversion of plain zero writes by the OS to driver specific optimized zero write commands. Values off Disabled (default) on Enabled unmap Enabled and even try to unmap blocks if possible. This requires also that BlockdevDiscardOptions is set to unmap for this device. Since 2.1 BlockdevAioOptions (Enum) Selects the AIO backend to handle I/O requests Values threads Use qemu's thread pool native Use native AIO backend (only Linux and Windows) io_uring (If: CONFIG_LINUX_IO_URING) Use linux io_uring (since 5.0) Since 2.9 BlockdevCacheOptions (Object) Includes cache-related options for block devices Members direct: boolean (optional) enables use of O_DIRECT (bypass the host page cache; default: false) no-flush: boolean (optional) ignore any flush requests for the device (default: false) Since 2.9 BlockdevDriver (Enum) Drivers that are supported in block device operations. Values throttle Since 2.11 nvme Since 2.12 copy-on-read Since 3.0 blklogwrites Since 3.0 blkreplay Since 4.2 compress Since 5.0 copy-before-write Since 6.2 blkdebug Not documented blkverify Not documented bochs Not documented cloop Not documented dmg Not documented file Not documented ftp Not documented ftps Not documented gluster Not documented host_cdrom (If: HAVE_HOST_BLOCK_DEVICE) Not documented host_device (If: HAVE_HOST_BLOCK_DEVICE) Not documented http Not documented https Not documented iscsi Not documented luks Not documented nbd Not documented nfs Not documented null-aio Not documented null-co Not documented parallels Not documented preallocate Not documented qcow Not documented qcow2 Not documented qed Not documented quorum Not documented raw Not documented rbd Not documented replication (If: CONFIG_REPLICATION) Not documented ssh Not documented vdi Not documented vhdx Not documented vmdk Not documented vpc Not documented vvfat Not documented Since 2.9 BlockdevOptionsFile (Object) Driver specific block device options for the file backend. Members filename: string path to the image file pr-manager: string (optional) the id for the object that will handle persistent reservations for this device (default: none, forward the commands via SG_IO; since 2.11) aio: BlockdevAioOptions (optional) AIO backend (default: threads) (since: 2.8) aio-max-batch: int (optional) maximum number of requests to batch together into a single submission in the AIO backend. The smallest value between this and the aio-max-batch value of the IOThread object is chosen. 0 means that the AIO backend will handle it automatically. (default: 0, since 6.2) locking: OnOffAuto (optional) whether to enable file locking. If set to 'auto', only enable when Open File Descriptor (OFD) locking API is available (default: auto, since 2.10) drop-cache: boolean (optional) (If: CONFIG_LINUX) invalidate page cache during live migration. This prevents stale data on the migration destination with cache.direct=off. Currently only supported on Linux hosts. (default: on, since: 4.0) x-check-cache-dropped: boolean (optional) whether to check that page cache was dropped on live migration. May cause noticeable delays if the image file is large, do not use in production. (default: off) (since: 3.0) Features dynamic-auto-read-only If present, enabled auto-read-only means that the driver will open the image read-only at first, dynamically reopen the image file read-write when the first writer is attached to the node and reopen read-only when the last writer is detached. This allows giving QEMU write permissions only on demand when an operation actually needs write access. unstable Member x-check-cache-dropped is meant for debugging. Since 2.9 BlockdevOptionsNull (Object) Driver specific block device options for the null backend. Members size: int (optional) size of the device in bytes. latency-ns: int (optional) emulated latency (in nanoseconds) in processing requests. Default to zero which completes requests immediately. (Since 2.4) read-zeroes: boolean (optional) if true, reads from the device produce zeroes; if false, the buffer is left unchanged. (default: false; since: 4.1) Since 2.9 BlockdevOptionsNVMe (Object) Driver specific block device options for the NVMe backend. Members device: string PCI controller address of the NVMe device in format hhhh:bb:ss.f (host:bus:slot.function) namespace: int namespace number of the device, starting from 1. Note that the PCI device must have been unbound from any host kernel driver before instructing QEMU to add the blockdev. Since 2.12 BlockdevOptionsVVFAT (Object) Driver specific block device options for the vvfat protocol. Members dir: string directory to be exported as FAT image fat-type: int (optional) FAT type: 12, 16 or 32 floppy: boolean (optional) whether to export a floppy image (true) or partitioned hard disk (false; default) label: string (optional) set the volume label, limited to 11 bytes. FAT16 and FAT32 traditionally have some restrictions on labels, which are ignored by most operating systems. Defaults to "QEMU VVFAT". (since 2.4) rw: boolean (optional) whether to allow write operations (default: false) Since 2.9 BlockdevOptionsGenericFormat (Object) Driver specific block device options for image format that have no option besides their data source. Members file: BlockdevRef reference to or definition of the data source block device Since 2.9 BlockdevOptionsLUKS (Object) Driver specific block device options for LUKS. Members key-secret: string (optional) the ID of a QCryptoSecret object providing the decryption key (since 2.6). Mandatory except when doing a metadata-only probe of the image. The members of BlockdevOptionsGenericFormat Since 2.9 BlockdevOptionsGenericCOWFormat (Object) Driver specific block device options for image format that have no option besides their data source and an optional backing file. Members backing: BlockdevRefOrNull (optional) reference to or definition of the backing file block device, null disables the backing file entirely. Defaults to the backing file stored the image file. The members of BlockdevOptionsGenericFormat Since 2.9 Qcow2OverlapCheckMode (Enum) General overlap check modes. Values none Do not perform any checks constant Perform only checks which can be done in constant time and without reading anything from disk cached Perform only checks which can be done without reading anything from disk all Perform all available overlap checks Since 2.9 Qcow2OverlapCheckFlags (Object) Structure of flags for each metadata structure. Setting a field to 'true' makes qemu guard that structure against unintended overwriting. The default value is chosen according to the template given. Members template: Qcow2OverlapCheckMode (optional) Specifies a template mode which can be adjusted using the other flags, defaults to 'cached' bitmap-directory: boolean (optional) since 3.0 main-header: boolean (optional) Not documented active-l1: boolean (optional) Not documented active-l2: boolean (optional) Not documented refcount-table: boolean (optional) Not documented refcount-block: boolean (optional) Not documented snapshot-table: boolean (optional) Not documented inactive-l1: boolean (optional) Not documented inactive-l2: boolean (optional) Not documented Since 2.9 Qcow2OverlapChecks (Alternate) Specifies which metadata structures should be guarded against unintended overwriting. Members flags: Qcow2OverlapCheckFlags set of flags for separate specification of each metadata structure type mode: Qcow2OverlapCheckMode named mode which chooses a specific set of flags Since 2.9 BlockdevQcowEncryptionFormat (Enum) Values aes AES-CBC with plain64 initialization vectors Since 2.10 BlockdevQcowEncryption (Object) Members format: BlockdevQcowEncryptionFormat Not documented The members of QCryptoBlockOptionsQCow when format is "aes" Since 2.10 BlockdevOptionsQcow (Object) Driver specific block device options for qcow. Members encrypt: BlockdevQcowEncryption (optional) Image decryption options. Mandatory for encrypted images, except when doing a metadata-only probe of the image. The members of BlockdevOptionsGenericCOWFormat Since 2.10 BlockdevQcow2EncryptionFormat (Enum) Values aes AES-CBC with plain64 initialization vectors luks Not documented Since 2.10 BlockdevQcow2Encryption (Object) Members format: BlockdevQcow2EncryptionFormat Not documented The members of QCryptoBlockOptionsQCow when format is "aes" The members of QCryptoBlockOptionsLUKS when format is "luks" Since 2.10 BlockdevOptionsPreallocate (Object) Filter driver intended to be inserted between format and protocol node and do preallocation in protocol node on write. Members prealloc-align: int (optional) on preallocation, align file length to this number, default 1048576 (1M) prealloc-size: int (optional) how much to preallocate, default 134217728 (128M) The members of BlockdevOptionsGenericFormat Since 6.0 BlockdevOptionsQcow2 (Object) Driver specific block device options for qcow2. Members lazy-refcounts: boolean (optional) whether to enable the lazy refcounts feature (default is taken from the image file) pass-discard-request: boolean (optional) whether discard requests to the qcow2 device should be forwarded to the data source pass-discard-snapshot: boolean (optional) whether discard requests for the data source should be issued when a snapshot operation (e.g. deleting a snapshot) frees clusters in the qcow2 file pass-discard-other: boolean (optional) whether discard requests for the data source should be issued on other occasions where a cluster gets freed overlap-check: Qcow2OverlapChecks (optional) which overlap checks to perform for writes to the image, defaults to 'cached' (since 2.2) cache-size: int (optional) the maximum total size of the L2 table and refcount block caches in bytes (since 2.2) l2-cache-size: int (optional) the maximum size of the L2 table cache in bytes (since 2.2) l2-cache-entry-size: int (optional) the size of each entry in the L2 cache in bytes. It must be a power of two between 512 and the cluster size. The default value is the cluster size (since 2.12) refcount-cache-size: int (optional) the maximum size of the refcount block cache in bytes (since 2.2) cache-clean-interval: int (optional) clean unused entries in the L2 and refcount caches. The interval is in seconds. The default value is 600 on supporting platforms, and 0 on other platforms. 0 disables this feature. (since 2.5) encrypt: BlockdevQcow2Encryption (optional) Image decryption options. Mandatory for encrypted images, except when doing a metadata-only probe of the image. (since 2.10) data-file: BlockdevRef (optional) reference to or definition of the external data file. This may only be specified for images that require an external data file. If it is not specified for such an image, the data file name is loaded from the image file. (since 4.0) The members of BlockdevOptionsGenericCOWFormat Since 2.9 SshHostKeyCheckMode (Enum) Values none Don't check the host key at all hash Compare the host key with a given hash known_hosts Check the host key against the known_hosts file Since 2.12 SshHostKeyCheckHashType (Enum) Values md5 The given hash is an md5 hash sha1 The given hash is an sha1 hash sha256 The given hash is an sha256 hash Since 2.12 SshHostKeyHash (Object) Members type: SshHostKeyCheckHashType The hash algorithm used for the hash hash: string The expected hash value Since 2.12 SshHostKeyCheck (Object) Members mode: SshHostKeyCheckMode Not documented The members of SshHostKeyHash when mode is "hash" Since 2.12 BlockdevOptionsSsh (Object) Members server: InetSocketAddress host address path: string path to the image on the host user: string (optional) user as which to connect, defaults to current local user name host-key-check: SshHostKeyCheck (optional) Defines how and what to check the host key against (default: known_hosts) Since 2.9 BlkdebugEvent (Enum) Trigger events supported by blkdebug. Values l1_shrink_write_table write zeros to the l1 table to shrink image. (since 2.11) l1_shrink_free_l2_clusters discard the l2 tables. (since 2.11) cor_write a write due to copy-on-read (since 2.11) cluster_alloc_space an allocation of file space for a cluster (since 4.1) none triggers once at creation of the blkdebug node (since 4.1) l1_update Not documented l1_grow_alloc_table Not documented l1_grow_write_table Not documented l1_grow_activate_table Not documented l2_load Not documented l2_update Not documented l2_update_compressed Not documented l2_alloc_cow_read Not documented l2_alloc_write Not documented read_aio Not documented read_backing_aio Not documented read_compressed Not documented write_aio Not documented write_compressed Not documented vmstate_load Not documented vmstate_save Not documented cow_read Not documented cow_write Not documented reftable_load Not documented reftable_grow Not documented reftable_update Not documented refblock_load Not documented refblock_update Not documented refblock_update_part Not documented refblock_alloc Not documented refblock_alloc_hookup Not documented refblock_alloc_write Not documented refblock_alloc_write_blocks Not documented refblock_alloc_write_table Not documented refblock_alloc_switch_table Not documented cluster_alloc Not documented cluster_alloc_bytes Not documented cluster_free Not documented flush_to_os Not documented flush_to_disk Not documented pwritev_rmw_head Not documented pwritev_rmw_after_head Not documented pwritev_rmw_tail Not documented pwritev_rmw_after_tail Not documented pwritev Not documented pwritev_zero Not documented pwritev_done Not documented empty_image_prepare Not documented Since 2.9 BlkdebugIOType (Enum) Kinds of I/O that blkdebug can inject errors in. Values read .bdrv_co_preadv() write .bdrv_co_pwritev() write-zeroes .bdrv_co_pwrite_zeroes() discard .bdrv_co_pdiscard() flush .bdrv_co_flush_to_disk() block-status .bdrv_co_block_status() Since 4.1 BlkdebugInjectErrorOptions (Object) Describes a single error injection for blkdebug. Members event: BlkdebugEvent trigger event state: int (optional) the state identifier blkdebug needs to be in to actually trigger the event; defaults to "any" iotype: BlkdebugIOType (optional) the type of I/O operations on which this error should be injected; defaults to "all read, write, write-zeroes, discard, and flush operations" (since: 4.1) errno: int (optional) error identifier (errno) to be returned; defaults to EIO sector: int (optional) specifies the sector index which has to be affected in order to actually trigger the event; defaults to "any sector" once: boolean (optional) disables further events after this one has been triggered; defaults to false immediately: boolean (optional) fail immediately; defaults to false Since 2.9 BlkdebugSetStateOptions (Object) Describes a single state-change event for blkdebug. Members event: BlkdebugEvent trigger event state: int (optional) the current state identifier blkdebug needs to be in; defaults to "any" new_state: int the state identifier blkdebug is supposed to assume if this event is triggered Since 2.9 BlockdevOptionsBlkdebug (Object) Driver specific block device options for blkdebug. Members image: BlockdevRef underlying raw block device (or image file) config: string (optional) filename of the configuration file align: int (optional) required alignment for requests in bytes, must be positive power of 2, or 0 for default max-transfer: int (optional) maximum size for I/O transfers in bytes, must be positive multiple of align and of the underlying file's request alignment (but need not be a power of 2), or 0 for default (since 2.10) opt-write-zero: int (optional) preferred alignment for write zero requests in bytes, must be positive multiple of align and of the underlying file's request alignment (but need not be a power of 2), or 0 for default (since 2.10) max-write-zero: int (optional) maximum size for write zero requests in bytes, must be positive multiple of align, of opt-write-zero, and of the underlying file's request alignment (but need not be a power of 2), or 0 for default (since 2.10) opt-discard: int (optional) preferred alignment for discard requests in bytes, must be positive multiple of align and of the underlying file's request alignment (but need not be a power of 2), or 0 for default (since 2.10) max-discard: int (optional) maximum size for discard requests in bytes, must be positive multiple of align, of opt-discard, and of the underlying file's request alignment (but need not be a power of 2), or 0 for default (since 2.10) inject-error: array of BlkdebugInjectErrorOptions (optional) array of error injection descriptions set-state: array of BlkdebugSetStateOptions (optional) array of state-change descriptions take-child-perms: array of BlockPermission (optional) Permissions to take on image in addition to what is necessary anyway (which depends on how the blkdebug node is used). Defaults to none. (since 5.0) unshare-child-perms: array of BlockPermission (optional) Permissions not to share on image in addition to what cannot be shared anyway (which depends on how the blkdebug node is used). Defaults to none. (since 5.0) Since 2.9 BlockdevOptionsBlklogwrites (Object) Driver specific block device options for blklogwrites. Members file: BlockdevRef block device log: BlockdevRef block device used to log writes to file log-sector-size: int (optional) sector size used in logging writes to file, determines granularity of offsets and sizes of writes (default: 512) log-append: boolean (optional) append to an existing log (default: false) log-super-update-interval: int (optional) interval of write requests after which the log super block is updated to disk (default: 4096) Since 3.0 BlockdevOptionsBlkverify (Object) Driver specific block device options for blkverify. Members test: BlockdevRef block device to be tested raw: BlockdevRef raw image used for verification Since 2.9 BlockdevOptionsBlkreplay (Object) Driver specific block device options for blkreplay. Members image: BlockdevRef disk image which should be controlled with blkreplay Since 4.2 QuorumReadPattern (Enum) An enumeration of quorum read patterns. Values quorum read all the children and do a quorum vote on reads fifo read only from the first child that has not failed Since 2.9 BlockdevOptionsQuorum (Object) Driver specific block device options for Quorum Members blkverify: boolean (optional) true if the driver must print content mismatch set to false by default children: array of BlockdevRef the children block devices to use vote-threshold: int the vote limit under which a read will fail rewrite-corrupted: boolean (optional) rewrite corrupted data when quorum is reached (Since 2.1) read-pattern: QuorumReadPattern (optional) choose read pattern and set to quorum by default (Since 2.2) Since 2.9 BlockdevOptionsGluster (Object) Driver specific block device options for Gluster Members volume: string name of gluster volume where VM image resides path: string absolute path to image file in gluster volume server: array of SocketAddress gluster servers description debug: int (optional) libgfapi log level (default '4' which is Error) (Since 2.8) logfile: string (optional) libgfapi log file (default /dev/stderr) (Since 2.8) Since 2.9 IscsiTransport (Enum) An enumeration of libiscsi transport types Values tcp Not documented iser Not documented Since 2.9 IscsiHeaderDigest (Enum) An enumeration of header digests supported by libiscsi Values crc32c Not documented none Not documented crc32c-none Not documented none-crc32c Not documented Since 2.9 BlockdevOptionsIscsi (Object) Members transport: IscsiTransport The iscsi transport type portal: string The address of the iscsi portal target: string The target iqn name lun: int (optional) LUN to connect to. Defaults to 0. user: string (optional) User name to log in with. If omitted, no CHAP authentication is performed. password-secret: string (optional) The ID of a QCryptoSecret object providing the password for the login. This option is required if user is specified. initiator-name: string (optional) The iqn name we want to identify to the target as. If this option is not specified, an initiator name is generated automatically. header-digest: IscsiHeaderDigest (optional) The desired header digest. Defaults to none-crc32c. timeout: int (optional) Timeout in seconds after which a request will timeout. 0 means no timeout and is the default. Driver specific block device options for iscsi Since 2.9 RbdAuthMode (Enum) Values cephx Not documented none Not documented Since 3.0 RbdImageEncryptionFormat (Enum) Values luks Not documented luks2 Not documented Since 6.1 RbdEncryptionOptionsLUKSBase (Object) Members key-secret: string ID of a QCryptoSecret object providing a passphrase for unlocking the encryption Since 6.1 RbdEncryptionCreateOptionsLUKSBase (Object) Members cipher-alg: QCryptoCipherAlgorithm (optional) The encryption algorithm The members of RbdEncryptionOptionsLUKSBase Since 6.1 RbdEncryptionOptionsLUKS (Object) Members The members of RbdEncryptionOptionsLUKSBase Since 6.1 RbdEncryptionOptionsLUKS2 (Object) Members The members of RbdEncryptionOptionsLUKSBase Since 6.1 RbdEncryptionCreateOptionsLUKS (Object) Members The members of RbdEncryptionCreateOptionsLUKSBase Since 6.1 RbdEncryptionCreateOptionsLUKS2 (Object) Members The members of RbdEncryptionCreateOptionsLUKSBase Since 6.1 RbdEncryptionOptions (Object) Members format: RbdImageEncryptionFormat Not documented The members of RbdEncryptionOptionsLUKS when format is "luks" The members of RbdEncryptionOptionsLUKS2 when format is "luks2" Since 6.1 RbdEncryptionCreateOptions (Object) Members format: RbdImageEncryptionFormat Not documented The members of RbdEncryptionCreateOptionsLUKS when format is "luks" The members of RbdEncryptionCreateOptionsLUKS2 when format is "luks2" Since 6.1 BlockdevOptionsRbd (Object) Members pool: string Ceph pool name. namespace: string (optional) Rados namespace name in the Ceph pool. (Since 5.0) image: string Image name in the Ceph pool. conf: string (optional) path to Ceph configuration file. Values in the configuration file will be overridden by options specified via QAPI. snapshot: string (optional) Ceph snapshot name. encrypt: RbdEncryptionOptions (optional) Image encryption options. (Since 6.1) user: string (optional) Ceph id name. auth-client-required: array of RbdAuthMode (optional) Acceptable authentication modes. This maps to Ceph configuration option "auth_client_required". (Since 3.0) key-secret: string (optional) ID of a QCryptoSecret object providing a key for cephx authentication. This maps to Ceph configuration option "key". (Since 3.0) server: array of InetSocketAddressBase (optional) Monitor host address and port. This maps to the "mon_host" Ceph option. Since 2.9 ReplicationMode (Enum) An enumeration of replication modes. Values primary Primary mode, the vm's state will be sent to secondary QEMU. secondary Secondary mode, receive the vm's state from primary QEMU. Since 2.9 If CONFIG_REPLICATION BlockdevOptionsReplication (Object) Driver specific block device options for replication Members mode: ReplicationMode the replication mode top-id: string (optional) In secondary mode, node name or device ID of the root node who owns the replication node chain. Must not be given in primary mode. The members of BlockdevOptionsGenericFormat Since 2.9 If CONFIG_REPLICATION NFSTransport (Enum) An enumeration of NFS transport types Values inet TCP transport Since 2.9 NFSServer (Object) Captures the address of the socket Members type: NFSTransport transport type used for NFS (only TCP supported) host: string host address for NFS server Since 2.9 BlockdevOptionsNfs (Object) Driver specific block device option for NFS Members server: NFSServer host address path: string path of the image on the host user: int (optional) UID value to use when talking to the server (defaults to 65534 on Windows and getuid() on unix) group: int (optional) GID value to use when talking to the server (defaults to 65534 on Windows and getgid() in unix) tcp-syn-count: int (optional) number of SYNs during the session establishment (defaults to libnfs default) readahead-size: int (optional) set the readahead size in bytes (defaults to libnfs default) page-cache-size: int (optional) set the pagecache size in bytes (defaults to libnfs default) debug: int (optional) set the NFS debug level (max 2) (defaults to libnfs default) Since 2.9 BlockdevOptionsCurlBase (Object) Driver specific block device options shared by all protocols supported by the curl backend. Members url: string URL of the image file readahead: int (optional) Size of the read-ahead cache; must be a multiple of 512 (defaults to 256 kB) timeout: int (optional) Timeout for connections, in seconds (defaults to 5) username: string (optional) Username for authentication (defaults to none) password-secret: string (optional) ID of a QCryptoSecret object providing a password for authentication (defaults to no password) proxy-username: string (optional) Username for proxy authentication (defaults to none) proxy-password-secret: string (optional) ID of a QCryptoSecret object providing a password for proxy authentication (defaults to no password) Since 2.9 BlockdevOptionsCurlHttp (Object) Driver specific block device options for HTTP connections over the curl backend. URLs must start with "http://". Members cookie: string (optional) List of cookies to set; format is "name1=content1; name2=content2;" as explained by CURLOPT_COOKIE(3). Defaults to no cookies. cookie-secret: string (optional) ID of a QCryptoSecret object providing the cookie data in a secure way. See cookie for the format. (since 2.10) The members of BlockdevOptionsCurlBase Since 2.9 BlockdevOptionsCurlHttps (Object) Driver specific block device options for HTTPS connections over the curl backend. URLs must start with "https://". Members cookie: string (optional) List of cookies to set; format is "name1=content1; name2=content2;" as explained by CURLOPT_COOKIE(3). Defaults to no cookies. sslverify: boolean (optional) Whether to verify the SSL certificate's validity (defaults to true) cookie-secret: string (optional) ID of a QCryptoSecret object providing the cookie data in a secure way. See cookie for the format. (since 2.10) The members of BlockdevOptionsCurlBase Since 2.9 BlockdevOptionsCurlFtp (Object) Driver specific block device options for FTP connections over the curl backend. URLs must start with "ftp://". Members The members of BlockdevOptionsCurlBase Since 2.9 BlockdevOptionsCurlFtps (Object) Driver specific block device options for FTPS connections over the curl backend. URLs must start with "ftps://". Members sslverify: boolean (optional) Whether to verify the SSL certificate's validity (defaults to true) The members of BlockdevOptionsCurlBase Since 2.9 BlockdevOptionsNbd (Object) Driver specific block device options for NBD. Members server: SocketAddress NBD server address export: string (optional) export name tls-creds: string (optional) TLS credentials ID x-dirty-bitmap: string (optional) A metadata context name such as "qemu:dirty-bitmap:NAME" or "qemu:allocation-depth" to query in place of the traditional "base:allocation" block status (see NBD_OPT_LIST_META_CONTEXT in the NBD protocol; and yes, naming this option x-context would have made more sense) (since 3.0) reconnect-delay: int (optional) On an unexpected disconnect, the nbd client tries to connect again until succeeding or encountering a serious error. During the first reconnect-delay seconds, all requests are paused and will be rerun on a successful reconnect. After that time, any delayed requests and all future requests before a successful reconnect will immediately fail. Default 0 (Since 4.2) Features unstable Member x-dirty-bitmap is experimental. Since 2.9 BlockdevOptionsRaw (Object) Driver specific block device options for the raw driver. Members offset: int (optional) position where the block device starts size: int (optional) the assumed size of the device The members of BlockdevOptionsGenericFormat Since 2.9 BlockdevOptionsThrottle (Object) Driver specific block device options for the throttle driver Members throttle-group: string the name of the throttle-group object to use. It must already exist. file: BlockdevRef reference to or definition of the data source block device Since 2.11 BlockdevOptionsCor (Object) Driver specific block device options for the copy-on-read driver. Members bottom: string (optional) The name of a non-filter node (allocation-bearing layer) that limits the COR operations in the backing chain (inclusive), so that no data below this node will be copied by this filter. If option is absent, the limit is not applied, so that data from all backing layers may be copied. The members of BlockdevOptionsGenericFormat Since 6.0 BlockdevOptionsCbw (Object) Driver specific block device options for the copy-before-write driver, which does so called copy-before-write operations: when data is written to the filter, the filter first reads corresponding blocks from its file child and copies them to target child. After successfully copying, the write request is propagated to file child. If copying fails, the original write request is failed too and no data is written to file child. Members target: BlockdevRef The target for copy-before-write operations. The members of BlockdevOptionsGenericFormat Since 6.2 BlockdevOptions (Object) Options for creating a block device. Many options are available for all block devices, independent of the block driver: Members driver: BlockdevDriver block driver name node-name: string (optional) the node name of the new node (Since 2.0). This option is required on the top level of blockdev-add. Valid node names start with an alphabetic character and may contain only alphanumeric characters, '-', '.' and '_'. Their maximum length is 31 characters. discard: BlockdevDiscardOptions (optional) discard-related options (default: ignore) cache: BlockdevCacheOptions (optional) cache-related options read-only: boolean (optional) whether the block device should be read-only (default: false). Note that some block drivers support only read-only access, either generally or in certain configurations. In this case, the default value does not work and the option must be specified explicitly. auto-read-only: boolean (optional) if true and read-only is false, QEMU may automatically decide not to open the image read-write as requested, but fall back to read-only instead (and switch between the modes later), e.g. depending on whether the image file is writable or whether a writing user is attached to the node (default: false, since 3.1) detect-zeroes: BlockdevDetectZeroesOptions (optional) detect and optimize zero writes (Since 2.1) (default: off) force-share: boolean (optional) force share all permission on added nodes. Requires read-only=true. (Since 2.10) The members of BlockdevOptionsBlkdebug when driver is "blkdebug" The members of BlockdevOptionsBlklogwrites when driver is "blklogwrites" The members of BlockdevOptionsBlkverify when driver is "blkverify" The members of BlockdevOptionsBlkreplay when driver is "blkreplay" The members of BlockdevOptionsGenericFormat when driver is "bochs" The members of BlockdevOptionsGenericFormat when driver is "cloop" The members of BlockdevOptionsGenericFormat when driver is "compress" The members of BlockdevOptionsCbw when driver is "copy-before-write" The members of BlockdevOptionsCor when driver is "copy-on-read" The members of BlockdevOptionsGenericFormat when driver is "dmg" The members of BlockdevOptionsFile when driver is "file" The members of BlockdevOptionsCurlFtp when driver is "ftp" The members of BlockdevOptionsCurlFtps when driver is "ftps" The members of BlockdevOptionsGluster when driver is "gluster" The members of BlockdevOptionsFile when driver is "host_cdrom" (If: HAVE_HOST_BLOCK_DEVICE) The members of BlockdevOptionsFile when driver is "host_device" (If: HAVE_HOST_BLOCK_DEVICE) The members of BlockdevOptionsCurlHttp when driver is "http" The members of BlockdevOptionsCurlHttps when driver is "https" The members of BlockdevOptionsIscsi when driver is "iscsi" The members of BlockdevOptionsLUKS when driver is "luks" The members of BlockdevOptionsNbd when driver is "nbd" The members of BlockdevOptionsNfs when driver is "nfs" The members of BlockdevOptionsNull when driver is "null-aio" The members of BlockdevOptionsNull when driver is "null-co" The members of BlockdevOptionsNVMe when driver is "nvme" The members of BlockdevOptionsGenericFormat when driver is "parallels" The members of BlockdevOptionsPreallocate when driver is "preallocate" The members of BlockdevOptionsQcow2 when driver is "qcow2" The members of BlockdevOptionsQcow when driver is "qcow" The members of BlockdevOptionsGenericCOWFormat when driver is "qed" The members of BlockdevOptionsQuorum when driver is "quorum" The members of BlockdevOptionsRaw when driver is "raw" The members of BlockdevOptionsRbd when driver is "rbd" The members of BlockdevOptionsReplication when driver is "replication" (If: CONFIG_REPLICATION) The members of BlockdevOptionsSsh when driver is "ssh" The members of BlockdevOptionsThrottle when driver is "throttle" The members of BlockdevOptionsGenericFormat when driver is "vdi" The members of BlockdevOptionsGenericFormat when driver is "vhdx" The members of BlockdevOptionsGenericCOWFormat when driver is "vmdk" The members of BlockdevOptionsGenericFormat when driver is "vpc" The members of BlockdevOptionsVVFAT when driver is "vvfat" Remaining options are determined by the block driver. Since 2.9 BlockdevRef (Alternate) Reference to a block device. Members definition: BlockdevOptions defines a new block device inline reference: string references the ID of an existing block device Since 2.9 BlockdevRefOrNull (Alternate) Reference to a block device. Members definition: BlockdevOptions defines a new block device inline reference: string references the ID of an existing block device. An empty string means that no block device should be referenced. Deprecated; use null instead. null: null No block device should be referenced (since 2.10) Since 2.9 blockdev-add (Command) Creates a new block device. Arguments The members of BlockdevOptions Since 2.9 Example 1. -> { "execute": "blockdev-add", "arguments": { "driver": "qcow2", "node-name": "test1", "file": { "driver": "file", "filename": "test.qcow2" } } } <- { "return": {} } 2. -> { "execute": "blockdev-add", "arguments": { "driver": "qcow2", "node-name": "node0", "discard": "unmap", "cache": { "direct": true }, "file": { "driver": "file", "filename": "/tmp/test.qcow2" }, "backing": { "driver": "raw", "file": { "driver": "file", "filename": "/dev/fdset/4" } } } } <- { "return": {} } blockdev-reopen (Command) Reopens one or more block devices using the given set of options. Any option not specified will be reset to its default value regardless of its previous status. If an option cannot be changed or a particular driver does not support reopening then the command will return an error. All devices in the list are reopened in one transaction, so if one of them fails then the whole transaction is cancelled. The command receives a list of block devices to reopen. For each one of them, the top-level node-name option (from BlockdevOptions) must be specified and is used to select the block device to be reopened. Other node-name options must be either omitted or set to the current name of the appropriate node. This command won't change any node name and any attempt to do it will result in an error. In the case of options that refer to child nodes, the behavior of this command depends on the value: 1. A set of options (BlockdevOptions): the child is reopened with the specified set of options. 2. A reference to the current child: the child is reopened using its existing set of options. 3. A reference to a different node: the current child is replaced with the specified one. 4. NULL: the current child (if any) is detached. Options (1) and (2) are supported in all cases. Option (3) is supported for file and backing, and option (4) for backing only. Unlike with blockdev-add, the backing option must always be present unless the node being reopened does not have a backing file and its image does not have a default backing file name as part of its metadata. Arguments options: array of BlockdevOptions Not documented Since 6.1 blockdev-del (Command) Deletes a block device that has been added using blockdev-add. The command will fail if the node is attached to a device or is otherwise being used. Arguments node-name: string Name of the graph node to delete. Since 2.9 Example -> { "execute": "blockdev-add", "arguments": { "driver": "qcow2", "node-name": "node0", "file": { "driver": "file", "filename": "test.qcow2" } } } <- { "return": {} } -> { "execute": "blockdev-del", "arguments": { "node-name": "node0" } } <- { "return": {} } BlockdevCreateOptionsFile (Object) Driver specific image creation options for file. Members filename: string Filename for the new image file size: int Size of the virtual disk in bytes preallocation: PreallocMode (optional) Preallocation mode for the new image (default: off; allowed values: off, falloc (if CONFIG_POSIX_FALLOCATE), full (if CONFIG_POSIX)) nocow: boolean (optional) Turn off copy-on-write (valid only on btrfs; default: off) extent-size-hint: int (optional) Extent size hint to add to the image file; 0 for not adding an extent size hint (default: 1 MB, since 5.1) Since 2.12 BlockdevCreateOptionsGluster (Object) Driver specific image creation options for gluster. Members location: BlockdevOptionsGluster Where to store the new image file size: int Size of the virtual disk in bytes preallocation: PreallocMode (optional) Preallocation mode for the new image (default: off; allowed values: off, falloc (if CONFIG_GLUSTERFS_FALLOCATE), full (if CONFIG_GLUSTERFS_ZEROFILL)) Since 2.12 BlockdevCreateOptionsLUKS (Object) Driver specific image creation options for LUKS. Members file: BlockdevRef Node to create the image format on size: int Size of the virtual disk in bytes preallocation: PreallocMode (optional) Preallocation mode for the new image (since: 4.2) (default: off; allowed values: off, metadata, falloc, full) The members of QCryptoBlockCreateOptionsLUKS Since 2.12 BlockdevCreateOptionsNfs (Object) Driver specific image creation options for NFS. Members location: BlockdevOptionsNfs Where to store the new image file size: int Size of the virtual disk in bytes Since 2.12 BlockdevCreateOptionsParallels (Object) Driver specific image creation options for parallels. Members file: BlockdevRef Node to create the image format on size: int Size of the virtual disk in bytes cluster-size: int (optional) Cluster size in bytes (default: 1 MB) Since 2.12 BlockdevCreateOptionsQcow (Object) Driver specific image creation options for qcow. Members file: BlockdevRef Node to create the image format on size: int Size of the virtual disk in bytes backing-file: string (optional) File name of the backing file if a backing file should be used encrypt: QCryptoBlockCreateOptions (optional) Encryption options if the image should be encrypted Since 2.12 BlockdevQcow2Version (Enum) Values v2 The original QCOW2 format as introduced in qemu 0.10 (version 2) v3 The extended QCOW2 format as introduced in qemu 1.1 (version 3) Since 2.12 Qcow2CompressionType (Enum) Compression type used in qcow2 image file Values zlib zlib compression, see <http://zlib.net/> zstd (If: CONFIG_ZSTD) zstd compression, see <http://github.com/facebook/zstd> Since 5.1 BlockdevCreateOptionsQcow2 (Object) Driver specific image creation options for qcow2. Members file: BlockdevRef Node to create the image format on data-file: BlockdevRef (optional) Node to use as an external data file in which all guest data is stored so that only metadata remains in the qcow2 file (since: 4.0) data-file-raw: boolean (optional) True if the external data file must stay valid as a standalone (read-only) raw image without looking at qcow2 metadata (default: false; since: 4.0) extended-l2: boolean (optional) True to make the image have extended L2 entries (default: false; since 5.2) size: int Size of the virtual disk in bytes version: BlockdevQcow2Version (optional) Compatibility level (default: v3) backing-file: string (optional) File name of the backing file if a backing file should be used backing-fmt: BlockdevDriver (optional) Name of the block driver to use for the backing file encrypt: QCryptoBlockCreateOptions (optional) Encryption options if the image should be encrypted cluster-size: int (optional) qcow2 cluster size in bytes (default: 65536) preallocation: PreallocMode (optional) Preallocation mode for the new image (default: off; allowed values: off, falloc, full, metadata) lazy-refcounts: boolean (optional) True if refcounts may be updated lazily (default: off) refcount-bits: int (optional) Width of reference counts in bits (default: 16) compression-type: Qcow2CompressionType (optional) The image cluster compression method (default: zlib, since 5.1) Since 2.12 BlockdevCreateOptionsQed (Object) Driver specific image creation options for qed. Members file: BlockdevRef Node to create the image format on size: int Size of the virtual disk in bytes backing-file: string (optional) File name of the backing file if a backing file should be used backing-fmt: BlockdevDriver (optional) Name of the block driver to use for the backing file cluster-size: int (optional) Cluster size in bytes (default: 65536) table-size: int (optional) L1/L2 table size (in clusters) Since 2.12 BlockdevCreateOptionsRbd (Object) Driver specific image creation options for rbd/Ceph. Members location: BlockdevOptionsRbd Where to store the new image file. This location cannot point to a snapshot. size: int Size of the virtual disk in bytes cluster-size: int (optional) RBD object size encrypt: RbdEncryptionCreateOptions (optional) Image encryption options. (Since 6.1) Since 2.12 BlockdevVmdkSubformat (Enum) Subformat options for VMDK images Values monolithicSparse Single file image with sparse cluster allocation monolithicFlat Single flat data image and a descriptor file twoGbMaxExtentSparse Data is split into 2GB (per virtual LBA) sparse extent files, in addition to a descriptor file twoGbMaxExtentFlat Data is split into 2GB (per virtual LBA) flat extent files, in addition to a descriptor file streamOptimized Single file image sparse cluster allocation, optimized for streaming over network. Since 4.0 BlockdevVmdkAdapterType (Enum) Adapter type info for VMDK images Values ide Not documented buslogic Not documented lsilogic Not documented legacyESX Not documented Since 4.0 BlockdevCreateOptionsVmdk (Object) Driver specific image creation options for VMDK. Members file: BlockdevRef Where to store the new image file. This refers to the image file for monolithcSparse and streamOptimized format, or the descriptor file for other formats. size: int Size of the virtual disk in bytes extents: array of BlockdevRef (optional) Where to store the data extents. Required for monolithcFlat, twoGbMaxExtentSparse and twoGbMaxExtentFlat formats. For monolithicFlat, only one entry is required; for twoGbMaxExtent* formats, the number of entries required is calculated as extent_number = virtual_size / 2GB. Providing more extents than will be used is an error. subformat: BlockdevVmdkSubformat (optional) The subformat of the VMDK image. Default: "monolithicSparse". backing-file: string (optional) The path of backing file. Default: no backing file is used. adapter-type: BlockdevVmdkAdapterType (optional) The adapter type used to fill in the descriptor. Default: ide. hwversion: string (optional) Hardware version. The meaningful options are "4" or "6". Default: "4". toolsversion: string (optional) VMware guest tools version. Default: "2147483647" (Since 6.2) zeroed-grain: boolean (optional) Whether to enable zeroed-grain feature for sparse subformats. Default: false. Since 4.0 BlockdevCreateOptionsSsh (Object) Driver specific image creation options for SSH. Members location: BlockdevOptionsSsh Where to store the new image file size: int Size of the virtual disk in bytes Since 2.12 BlockdevCreateOptionsVdi (Object) Driver specific image creation options for VDI. Members file: BlockdevRef Node to create the image format on size: int Size of the virtual disk in bytes preallocation: PreallocMode (optional) Preallocation mode for the new image (default: off; allowed values: off, metadata) Since 2.12 BlockdevVhdxSubformat (Enum) Values dynamic Growing image file fixed Preallocated fixed-size image file Since 2.12 BlockdevCreateOptionsVhdx (Object) Driver specific image creation options for vhdx. Members file: BlockdevRef Node to create the image format on size: int Size of the virtual disk in bytes log-size: int (optional) Log size in bytes, must be a multiple of 1 MB (default: 1 MB) block-size: int (optional) Block size in bytes, must be a multiple of 1 MB and not larger than 256 MB (default: automatically choose a block size depending on the image size) subformat: BlockdevVhdxSubformat (optional) vhdx subformat (default: dynamic) block-state-zero: boolean (optional) Force use of payload blocks of type 'ZERO'. Non-standard, but default. Do not set to 'off' when using 'qemu-img convert' with subformat=dynamic. Since 2.12 BlockdevVpcSubformat (Enum) Values dynamic Growing image file fixed Preallocated fixed-size image file Since 2.12 BlockdevCreateOptionsVpc (Object) Driver specific image creation options for vpc (VHD). Members file: BlockdevRef Node to create the image format on size: int Size of the virtual disk in bytes subformat: BlockdevVpcSubformat (optional) vhdx subformat (default: dynamic) force-size: boolean (optional) Force use of the exact byte size instead of rounding to the next size that can be represented in CHS geometry (default: false) Since 2.12 BlockdevCreateOptions (Object) Options for creating an image format on a given node. Members driver: BlockdevDriver block driver to create the image format The members of BlockdevCreateOptionsFile when driver is "file" The members of BlockdevCreateOptionsGluster when driver is "gluster" The members of BlockdevCreateOptionsLUKS when driver is "luks" The members of BlockdevCreateOptionsNfs when driver is "nfs" The members of BlockdevCreateOptionsParallels when driver is "parallels" The members of BlockdevCreateOptionsQcow when driver is "qcow" The members of BlockdevCreateOptionsQcow2 when driver is "qcow2" The members of BlockdevCreateOptionsQed when driver is "qed" The members of BlockdevCreateOptionsRbd when driver is "rbd" The members of BlockdevCreateOptionsSsh when driver is "ssh" The members of BlockdevCreateOptionsVdi when driver is "vdi" The members of BlockdevCreateOptionsVhdx when driver is "vhdx" The members of BlockdevCreateOptionsVmdk when driver is "vmdk" The members of BlockdevCreateOptionsVpc when driver is "vpc" Since 2.12 blockdev-create (Command) Starts a job to create an image format on a given node. The job is automatically finalized, but a manual job-dismiss is required. Arguments job-id: string Identifier for the newly created job. options: BlockdevCreateOptions Options for the image creation. Since 3.0 BlockdevAmendOptionsLUKS (Object) Driver specific image amend options for LUKS. Members The members of QCryptoBlockAmendOptionsLUKS Since 5.1 BlockdevAmendOptionsQcow2 (Object) Driver specific image amend options for qcow2. For now, only encryption options can be amended encrypt Encryption options to be amended Members encrypt: QCryptoBlockAmendOptions (optional) Not documented Since 5.1 BlockdevAmendOptions (Object) Options for amending an image format Members driver: BlockdevDriver Block driver of the node to amend. The members of BlockdevAmendOptionsLUKS when driver is "luks" The members of BlockdevAmendOptionsQcow2 when driver is "qcow2" Since 5.1 x-blockdev-amend (Command) Starts a job to amend format specific options of an existing open block device The job is automatically finalized, but a manual job-dismiss is required. Arguments job-id: string Identifier for the newly created job. node-name: string Name of the block node to work on options: BlockdevAmendOptions Options (driver specific) force: boolean (optional) Allow unsafe operations, format specific For luks that allows erase of the last active keyslot (permanent loss of data), and replacement of an active keyslot (possible loss of data if IO error happens) Features unstable This command is experimental. Since 5.1 BlockErrorAction (Enum) An enumeration of action that has been taken when a DISK I/O occurs Values ignore error has been ignored report error has been reported to the device stop error caused VM to be stopped Since 2.1 BLOCK_IMAGE_CORRUPTED (Event) Emitted when a disk image is being marked corrupt. The image can be identified by its device or node name. The 'device' field is always present for compatibility reasons, but it can be empty ("") if the image does not have a device name associated. Arguments device: string device name. This is always present for compatibility reasons, but it can be empty ("") if the image does not have a device name associated. node-name: string (optional) node name (Since: 2.4) msg: string informative message for human consumption, such as the kind of corruption being detected. It should not be parsed by machine as it is not guaranteed to be stable offset: int (optional) if the corruption resulted from an image access, this is the host's access offset into the image size: int (optional) if the corruption resulted from an image access, this is the access size fatal: boolean if set, the image is marked corrupt and therefore unusable after this event and must be repaired (Since 2.2; before, every BLOCK_IMAGE_CORRUPTED event was fatal) Note If action is "stop", a STOP event will eventually follow the BLOCK_IO_ERROR event. Example <- { "event": "BLOCK_IMAGE_CORRUPTED", "data": { "device": "ide0-hd0", "node-name": "node0", "msg": "Prevented active L1 table overwrite", "offset": 196608, "size": 65536 }, "timestamp": { "seconds": 1378126126, "microseconds": 966463 } } Since 1.7 BLOCK_IO_ERROR (Event) Emitted when a disk I/O error occurs Arguments device: string device name. This is always present for compatibility reasons, but it can be empty ("") if the image does not have a device name associated. node-name: string (optional) node name. Note that errors may be reported for the root node that is directly attached to a guest device rather than for the node where the error occurred. The node name is not present if the drive is empty. (Since: 2.8) operation: IoOperationType I/O operation action: BlockErrorAction action that has been taken nospace: boolean (optional) true if I/O error was caused due to a no-space condition. This key is only present if query-block's io-status is present, please see query-block documentation for more information (since: 2.2) reason: string human readable string describing the error cause. (This field is a debugging aid for humans, it should not be parsed by applications) (since: 2.2) Note If action is "stop", a STOP event will eventually follow the BLOCK_IO_ERROR event Since 0.13 Example <- { "event": "BLOCK_IO_ERROR", "data": { "device": "ide0-hd1", "node-name": "#block212", "operation": "write", "action": "stop" }, "timestamp": { "seconds": 1265044230, "microseconds": 450486 } } BLOCK_JOB_COMPLETED (Event) Emitted when a block job has completed Arguments type: JobType job type device: string The job identifier. Originally the device name but other values are allowed since QEMU 2.7 len: int maximum progress value offset: int current progress value. On success this is equal to len. On failure this is less than len speed: int rate limit, bytes per second error: string (optional) error message. Only present on failure. This field contains a human-readable error message. There are no semantics other than that streaming has failed and clients should not try to interpret the error string Since 1.1 Example <- { "event": "BLOCK_JOB_COMPLETED", "data": { "type": "stream", "device": "virtio-disk0", "len": 10737418240, "offset": 10737418240, "speed": 0 }, "timestamp": { "seconds": 1267061043, "microseconds": 959568 } } BLOCK_JOB_CANCELLED (Event) Emitted when a block job has been cancelled Arguments type: JobType job type device: string The job identifier. Originally the device name but other values are allowed since QEMU 2.7 len: int maximum progress value offset: int current progress value. On success this is equal to len. On failure this is less than len speed: int rate limit, bytes per second Since 1.1 Example <- { "event": "BLOCK_JOB_CANCELLED", "data": { "type": "stream", "device": "virtio-disk0", "len": 10737418240, "offset": 134217728, "speed": 0 }, "timestamp": { "seconds": 1267061043, "microseconds": 959568 } } BLOCK_JOB_ERROR (Event) Emitted when a block job encounters an error Arguments device: string The job identifier. Originally the device name but other values are allowed since QEMU 2.7 operation: IoOperationType I/O operation action: BlockErrorAction action that has been taken Since 1.3 Example <- { "event": "BLOCK_JOB_ERROR", "data": { "device": "ide0-hd1", "operation": "write", "action": "stop" }, "timestamp": { "seconds": 1265044230, "microseconds": 450486 } } BLOCK_JOB_READY (Event) Emitted when a block job is ready to complete Arguments type: JobType job type device: string The job identifier. Originally the device name but other values are allowed since QEMU 2.7 len: int maximum progress value offset: int current progress value. On success this is equal to len. On failure this is less than len speed: int rate limit, bytes per second Note The "ready to complete" status is always reset by a BLOCK_JOB_ERROR event Since 1.3 Example <- { "event": "BLOCK_JOB_READY", "data": { "device": "drive0", "type": "mirror", "speed": 0, "len": 2097152, "offset": 2097152 } "timestamp": { "seconds": 1265044230, "microseconds": 450486 } } BLOCK_JOB_PENDING (Event) Emitted when a block job is awaiting explicit authorization to finalize graph changes via block-job-finalize. If this job is part of a transaction, it will not emit this event until the transaction has converged first. Arguments type: JobType job type id: string The job identifier. Since 2.12 Example <- { "event": "BLOCK_JOB_WAITING", "data": { "device": "drive0", "type": "mirror" }, "timestamp": { "seconds": 1265044230, "microseconds": 450486 } } PreallocMode (Enum) Preallocation mode of QEMU image file Values off no preallocation metadata preallocate only for metadata falloc like full preallocation but allocate disk space by posix_fallocate() rather than writing data. full preallocate all data by writing it to the device to ensure disk space is really available. This data may or may not be zero, depending on the image format and storage. full preallocation also sets up metadata correctly. Since 2.2 BLOCK_WRITE_THRESHOLD (Event) Emitted when writes on block device reaches or exceeds the configured write threshold. For thin-provisioned devices, this means the device should be extended to avoid pausing for disk exhaustion. The event is one shot. Once triggered, it needs to be re-registered with another block-set-write-threshold command. Arguments node-name: string graph node name on which the threshold was exceeded. amount-exceeded: int amount of data which exceeded the threshold, in bytes. write-threshold: int last configured threshold, in bytes. Since 2.3 block-set-write-threshold (Command) Change the write threshold for a block drive. An event will be delivered if a write to this block drive crosses the configured threshold. The threshold is an offset, thus must be non-negative. Default is no write threshold. Setting the threshold to zero disables it. This is useful to transparently resize thin-provisioned drives without the guest OS noticing. Arguments node-name: string graph node name on which the threshold must be set. write-threshold: int configured threshold for the block device, bytes. Use 0 to disable the threshold. Since 2.3 Example -> { "execute": "block-set-write-threshold", "arguments": { "node-name": "mydev", "write-threshold": 17179869184 } } <- { "return": {} } x-blockdev-change (Command) Dynamically reconfigure the block driver state graph. It can be used to add, remove, insert or replace a graph node. Currently only the Quorum driver implements this feature to add or remove its child. This is useful to fix a broken quorum child. If node is specified, it will be inserted under parent. child may not be specified in this case. If both parent and child are specified but node is not, child will be detached from parent. Arguments parent: string the id or name of the parent node. child: string (optional) the name of a child under the given parent node. node: string (optional) the name of the node that will be added. Features unstable This command is experimental, and its API is not stable. It does not support all kinds of operations, all kinds of children, nor all block drivers. FIXME Removing children from a quorum node means introducing gaps in the child indices. This cannot be represented in the 'children' list of BlockdevOptionsQuorum, as returned by .bdrv_refresh_filename(). Warning: The data in a new quorum child MUST be consistent with that of the rest of the array. Since 2.7 Example 1. Add a new node to a quorum -> { "execute": "blockdev-add", "arguments": { "driver": "raw", "node-name": "new_node", "file": { "driver": "file", "filename": "test.raw" } } } <- { "return": {} } -> { "execute": "x-blockdev-change", "arguments": { "parent": "disk1", "node": "new_node" } } <- { "return": {} } 2. Delete a quorum's node -> { "execute": "x-blockdev-change", "arguments": { "parent": "disk1", "child": "children.1" } } <- { "return": {} } x-blockdev-set-iothread (Command) Move node and its children into the iothread. If iothread is null then move node and its children into the main loop. The node must not be attached to a BlockBackend. Arguments node-name: string the name of the block driver node iothread: StrOrNull the name of the IOThread object or null for the main loop force: boolean (optional) true if the node and its children should be moved when a BlockBackend is already attached Features unstable This command is experimental and intended for test cases that need control over IOThreads only. Since 2.12 Example 1. Move a node into an IOThread -> { "execute": "x-blockdev-set-iothread", "arguments": { "node-name": "disk1", "iothread": "iothread0" } } <- { "return": {} } 2. Move a node into the main loop -> { "execute": "x-blockdev-set-iothread", "arguments": { "node-name": "disk1", "iothread": null } } <- { "return": {} } QuorumOpType (Enum) An enumeration of the quorum operation types Values read read operation write write operation flush flush operation Since 2.6 QUORUM_FAILURE (Event) Emitted by the Quorum block driver if it fails to establish a quorum Arguments reference: string device name if defined else node name sector-num: int number of the first sector of the failed read operation sectors-count: int failed read operation sector count Note This event is rate-limited. Since 2.0 Example <- { "event": "QUORUM_FAILURE", "data": { "reference": "usr1", "sector-num": 345435, "sectors-count": 5 }, "timestamp": { "seconds": 1344522075, "microseconds": 745528 } } QUORUM_REPORT_BAD (Event) Emitted to report a corruption of a Quorum file Arguments type: QuorumOpType quorum operation type (Since 2.6) error: string (optional) error message. Only present on failure. This field contains a human-readable error message. There are no semantics other than that the block layer reported an error and clients should not try to interpret the error string. node-name: string the graph node name of the block driver state sector-num: int number of the first sector of the failed read operation sectors-count: int failed read operation sector count Note This event is rate-limited. Since 2.0 Example 1. Read operation { "event": "QUORUM_REPORT_BAD", "data": { "node-name": "node0", "sector-num": 345435, "sectors-count": 5, "type": "read" }, "timestamp": { "seconds": 1344522075, "microseconds": 745528 } } 2. Flush operation { "event": "QUORUM_REPORT_BAD", "data": { "node-name": "node0", "sector-num": 0, "sectors-count": 2097120, "type": "flush", "error": "Broken pipe" }, "timestamp": { "seconds": 1456406829, "microseconds": 291763 } } BlockdevSnapshotInternal (Object) Members device: string the device name or node-name of a root node to generate the snapshot from name: string the name of the internal snapshot to be created Notes In transaction, if name is empty, or any snapshot matching name exists, the operation will fail. Only some image formats support it, for example, qcow2, and rbd. Since 1.7 blockdev-snapshot-internal-sync (Command) Synchronously take an internal snapshot of a block device, when the format of the image used supports it. If the name is an empty string, or a snapshot with name already exists, the operation will fail. For the arguments, see the documentation of BlockdevSnapshotInternal. Returns • nothing on success • If device is not a valid block device, GenericError • If any snapshot matching name exists, or name is empty, GenericError • If the format of the image used does not support it, BlockFormatFeatureNotSupported Since 1.7 Example -> { "execute": "blockdev-snapshot-internal-sync", "arguments": { "device": "ide-hd0", "name": "snapshot0" } } <- { "return": {} } blockdev-snapshot-delete-internal-sync (Command) Synchronously delete an internal snapshot of a block device, when the format of the image used support it. The snapshot is identified by name or id or both. One of the name or id is required. Return SnapshotInfo for the successfully deleted snapshot. Arguments device: string the device name or node-name of a root node to delete the snapshot from id: string (optional) optional the snapshot's ID to be deleted name: string (optional) optional the snapshot's name to be deleted Returns • SnapshotInfo on success • If device is not a valid block device, GenericError • If snapshot not found, GenericError • If the format of the image used does not support it, BlockFormatFeatureNotSupported • If id and name are both not specified, GenericError Since 1.7 Example -> { "execute": "blockdev-snapshot-delete-internal-sync", "arguments": { "device": "ide-hd0", "name": "snapshot0" } } <- { "return": { "id": "1", "name": "snapshot0", "vm-state-size": 0, "date-sec": 1000012, "date-nsec": 10, "vm-clock-sec": 100, "vm-clock-nsec": 20, "icount": 220414 } } Additional block stuff (VM related) BiosAtaTranslation (Enum) Policy that BIOS should use to interpret cylinder/head/sector addresses. Note that Bochs BIOS and SeaBIOS will not actually translate logical CHS to physical; instead, they will use logical block addressing. Values auto If cylinder/heads/sizes are passed, choose between none and LBA depending on the size of the disk. If they are not passed, choose none if QEMU can guess that the disk had 16 or fewer heads, large if QEMU can guess that the disk had 131072 or fewer tracks across all heads (i.e. cylinders*heads<131072), otherwise LBA. none The physical disk geometry is equal to the logical geometry. lba Assume 63 sectors per track and one of 16, 32, 64, 128 or 255 heads (if fewer than 255 are enough to cover the whole disk with 1024 cylinders/head). The number of cylinders/head is then computed based on the number of sectors and heads. large The number of cylinders per head is scaled down to 1024 by correspondingly scaling up the number of heads. rechs Same as large, but first convert a 16-head geometry to 15-head, by proportionally scaling up the number of cylinders/head. Since 2.0 FloppyDriveType (Enum) Type of Floppy drive to be emulated by the Floppy Disk Controller. Values 144 1.44MB 3.5" drive 288 2.88MB 3.5" drive 120 1.2MB 5.25" drive none No drive connected auto Automatically determined by inserted media at boot Since 2.6 PRManagerInfo (Object) Information about a persistent reservation manager Members id: string the identifier of the persistent reservation manager connected: boolean true if the persistent reservation manager is connected to the underlying storage or helper Since 3.0 query-pr-managers (Command) Returns a list of information about each persistent reservation manager. Returns a list of PRManagerInfo for each persistent reservation manager Since 3.0 eject (Command) Ejects the medium from a removable drive. Arguments device: string (optional) Block device name id: string (optional) The name or QOM path of the guest device (since: 2.8) force: boolean (optional) If true, eject regardless of whether the drive is locked. If not specified, the default value is false. Features deprecated Member device is deprecated. Use id instead. Returns • Nothing on success • If device is not a valid block device, DeviceNotFound Notes Ejecting a device with no media results in success Since 0.14 Example -> { "execute": "eject", "arguments": { "id": "ide1-0-1" } } <- { "return": {} } blockdev-open-tray (Command) Opens a block device's tray. If there is a block driver state tree inserted as a medium, it will become inaccessible to the guest (but it will remain associated to the block device, so closing the tray will make it accessible again). If the tray was already open before, this will be a no-op. Once the tray opens, a DEVICE_TRAY_MOVED event is emitted. There are cases in which no such event will be generated, these include: • if the guest has locked the tray, force is false and the guest does not respond to the eject request • if the BlockBackend denoted by device does not have a guest device attached to it • if the guest device does not have an actual tray Arguments device: string (optional) Block device name id: string (optional) The name or QOM path of the guest device (since: 2.8) force: boolean (optional) if false (the default), an eject request will be sent to the guest if it has locked the tray (and the tray will not be opened immediately); if true, the tray will be opened regardless of whether it is locked Features deprecated Member device is deprecated. Use id instead. Since 2.5 Example -> { "execute": "blockdev-open-tray", "arguments": { "id": "ide0-1-0" } } <- { "timestamp": { "seconds": 1418751016, "microseconds": 716996 }, "event": "DEVICE_TRAY_MOVED", "data": { "device": "ide1-cd0", "id": "ide0-1-0", "tray-open": true } } <- { "return": {} } blockdev-close-tray (Command) Closes a block device's tray. If there is a block driver state tree associated with the block device (which is currently ejected), that tree will be loaded as the medium. If the tray was already closed before, this will be a no-op. Arguments device: string (optional) Block device name id: string (optional) The name or QOM path of the guest device (since: 2.8) Features deprecated Member device is deprecated. Use id instead. Since 2.5 Example -> { "execute": "blockdev-close-tray", "arguments": { "id": "ide0-1-0" } } <- { "timestamp": { "seconds": 1418751345, "microseconds": 272147 }, "event": "DEVICE_TRAY_MOVED", "data": { "device": "ide1-cd0", "id": "ide0-1-0", "tray-open": false } } <- { "return": {} } blockdev-remove-medium (Command) Removes a medium (a block driver state tree) from a block device. That block device's tray must currently be open (unless there is no attached guest device). If the tray is open and there is no medium inserted, this will be a no-op. Arguments id: string The name or QOM path of the guest device Since 2.12 Example -> { "execute": "blockdev-remove-medium", "arguments": { "id": "ide0-1-0" } } <- { "error": { "class": "GenericError", "desc": "Tray of device 'ide0-1-0' is not open" } } -> { "execute": "blockdev-open-tray", "arguments": { "id": "ide0-1-0" } } <- { "timestamp": { "seconds": 1418751627, "microseconds": 549958 }, "event": "DEVICE_TRAY_MOVED", "data": { "device": "ide1-cd0", "id": "ide0-1-0", "tray-open": true } } <- { "return": {} } -> { "execute": "blockdev-remove-medium", "arguments": { "id": "ide0-1-0" } } <- { "return": {} } blockdev-insert-medium (Command) Inserts a medium (a block driver state tree) into a block device. That block device's tray must currently be open (unless there is no attached guest device) and there must be no medium inserted already. Arguments id: string The name or QOM path of the guest device node-name: string name of a node in the block driver state graph Since 2.12 Example -> { "execute": "blockdev-add", "arguments": { "node-name": "node0", "driver": "raw", "file": { "driver": "file", "filename": "fedora.iso" } } } <- { "return": {} } -> { "execute": "blockdev-insert-medium", "arguments": { "id": "ide0-1-0", "node-name": "node0" } } <- { "return": {} } BlockdevChangeReadOnlyMode (Enum) Specifies the new read-only mode of a block device subject to the blockdev-change-medium command. Values retain Retains the current read-only mode read-only Makes the device read-only read-write Makes the device writable Since 2.3 blockdev-change-medium (Command) Changes the medium inserted into a block device by ejecting the current medium and loading a new image file which is inserted as the new medium (this command combines blockdev-open-tray, blockdev-remove-medium, blockdev-insert-medium and blockdev-close-tray). Arguments device: string (optional) Block device name id: string (optional) The name or QOM path of the guest device (since: 2.8) filename: string filename of the new image to be loaded format: string (optional) format to open the new image with (defaults to the probed format) read-only-mode: BlockdevChangeReadOnlyMode (optional) change the read-only mode of the device; defaults to 'retain' Features deprecated Member device is deprecated. Use id instead. Since 2.5 Examples 1. Change a removable medium -> { "execute": "blockdev-change-medium", "arguments": { "id": "ide0-1-0", "filename": "/srv/images/Fedora-12-x86_64-DVD.iso", "format": "raw" } } <- { "return": {} } 2. Load a read-only medium into a writable drive -> { "execute": "blockdev-change-medium", "arguments": { "id": "floppyA", "filename": "/srv/images/ro.img", "format": "raw", "read-only-mode": "retain" } } <- { "error": { "class": "GenericError", "desc": "Could not open '/srv/images/ro.img': Permission denied" } } -> { "execute": "blockdev-change-medium", "arguments": { "id": "floppyA", "filename": "/srv/images/ro.img", "format": "raw", "read-only-mode": "read-only" } } <- { "return": {} } DEVICE_TRAY_MOVED (Event) Emitted whenever the tray of a removable device is moved by the guest or by HMP/QMP commands Arguments device: string Block device name. This is always present for compatibility reasons, but it can be empty ("") if the image does not have a device name associated. id: string The name or QOM path of the guest device (since 2.8) tray-open: boolean true if the tray has been opened or false if it has been closed Since 1.1 Example <- { "event": "DEVICE_TRAY_MOVED", "data": { "device": "ide1-cd0", "id": "/machine/unattached/device[22]", "tray-open": true }, "timestamp": { "seconds": 1265044230, "microseconds": 450486 } } PR_MANAGER_STATUS_CHANGED (Event) Emitted whenever the connected status of a persistent reservation manager changes. Arguments id: string The id of the PR manager object connected: boolean true if the PR manager is connected to a backend Since 3.0 Example <- { "event": "PR_MANAGER_STATUS_CHANGED", "data": { "id": "pr-helper0", "connected": true }, "timestamp": { "seconds": 1519840375, "microseconds": 450486 } } block_set_io_throttle (Command) Change I/O throttle limits for a block drive. Since QEMU 2.4, each device with I/O limits is member of a throttle group. If two or more devices are members of the same group, the limits will apply to the combined I/O of the whole group in a round-robin fashion. Therefore, setting new I/O limits to a device will affect the whole group. The name of the group can be specified using the 'group' parameter. If the parameter is unset, it is assumed to be the current group of that device. If it's not in any group yet, the name of the device will be used as the name for its group. The 'group' parameter can also be used to move a device to a different group. In this case the limits specified in the parameters will be applied to the new group only. I/O limits can be disabled by setting all of them to 0. In this case the device will be removed from its group and the rest of its members will not be affected. The 'group' parameter is ignored. Arguments The members of BlockIOThrottle Returns • Nothing on success • If device is not a valid block device, DeviceNotFound Since 1.1 Example -> { "execute": "block_set_io_throttle", "arguments": { "id": "virtio-blk-pci0/virtio-backend", "bps": 0, "bps_rd": 0, "bps_wr": 0, "iops": 512, "iops_rd": 0, "iops_wr": 0, "bps_max": 0, "bps_rd_max": 0, "bps_wr_max": 0, "iops_max": 0, "iops_rd_max": 0, "iops_wr_max": 0, "bps_max_length": 0, "iops_size": 0 } } <- { "return": {} } -> { "execute": "block_set_io_throttle", "arguments": { "id": "ide0-1-0", "bps": 1000000, "bps_rd": 0, "bps_wr": 0, "iops": 0, "iops_rd": 0, "iops_wr": 0, "bps_max": 8000000, "bps_rd_max": 0, "bps_wr_max": 0, "iops_max": 0, "iops_rd_max": 0, "iops_wr_max": 0, "bps_max_length": 60, "iops_size": 0 } } <- { "return": {} } block-latency-histogram-set (Command) Manage read, write and flush latency histograms for the device. If only id parameter is specified, remove all present latency histograms for the device. Otherwise, add/reset some of (or all) latency histograms. Arguments id: string The name or QOM path of the guest device. boundaries: array of int (optional) list of interval boundary values (see description in BlockLatencyHistogramInfo definition). If specified, all latency histograms are removed, and empty ones created for all io types with intervals corresponding to boundaries (except for io types, for which specific boundaries are set through the following parameters). boundaries-read: array of int (optional) list of interval boundary values for read latency histogram. If specified, old read latency histogram is removed, and empty one created with intervals corresponding to boundaries-read. The parameter has higher priority then boundaries. boundaries-write: array of int (optional) list of interval boundary values for write latency histogram. boundaries-flush: array of int (optional) list of interval boundary values for flush latency histogram. Returns error if device is not found or any boundary arrays are invalid. Since 4.0 Example set new histograms for all io types with intervals [0, 10), [10, 50), [50, 100), [100, +inf): -> { "execute": "block-latency-histogram-set", "arguments": { "id": "drive0", "boundaries": [10, 50, 100] } } <- { "return": {} } Example set new histogram only for write, other histograms will remain not changed (or not created): -> { "execute": "block-latency-histogram-set", "arguments": { "id": "drive0", "boundaries-write": [10, 50, 100] } } <- { "return": {} } Example set new histograms with the following intervals: read, flush: [0, 10), [10, 50), [50, 100), [100, +inf) write: [0, 1000), [1000, 5000), [5000, +inf) -> { "execute": "block-latency-histogram-set", "arguments": { "id": "drive0", "boundaries": [10, 50, 100], "boundaries-write": [1000, 5000] } } <- { "return": {} } Example remove all latency histograms: -> { "execute": "block-latency-histogram-set", "arguments": { "id": "drive0" } } <- { "return": {} } Block device exports NbdServerOptions (Object) Keep this type consistent with the nbd-server-start arguments. The only intended difference is using SocketAddress instead of SocketAddressLegacy. Members addr: SocketAddress Address on which to listen. tls-creds: string (optional) ID of the TLS credentials object (since 2.6). tls-authz: string (optional) ID of the QAuthZ authorization object used to validate the client's x509 distinguished name. This object is is only resolved at time of use, so can be deleted and recreated on the fly while the NBD server is active. If missing, it will default to denying access (since 4.0). max-connections: int (optional) The maximum number of connections to allow at the same time, 0 for unlimited. (since 5.2; default: 0) Since 4.2 nbd-server-start (Command) Start an NBD server listening on the given host and port. Block devices can then be exported using nbd-server-add. The NBD server will present them as named exports; for example, another QEMU instance could refer to them as "nbd:HOST:PORT:exportname=NAME". Keep this type consistent with the NbdServerOptions type. The only intended difference is using SocketAddressLegacy instead of SocketAddress. Arguments addr: SocketAddressLegacy Address on which to listen. tls-creds: string (optional) ID of the TLS credentials object (since 2.6). tls-authz: string (optional) ID of the QAuthZ authorization object used to validate the client's x509 distinguished name. This object is is only resolved at time of use, so can be deleted and recreated on the fly while the NBD server is active. If missing, it will default to denying access (since 4.0). max-connections: int (optional) The maximum number of connections to allow at the same time, 0 for unlimited. (since 5.2; default: 0) Returns error if the server is already running. Since 1.3 BlockExportOptionsNbdBase (Object) An NBD block export (common options shared between nbd-server-add and the NBD branch of block-export-add). Members name: string (optional) Export name. If unspecified, the device parameter is used as the export name. (Since 2.12) description: string (optional) Free-form description of the export, up to 4096 bytes. (Since 5.0) Since 5.0 BlockExportOptionsNbd (Object) An NBD block export (distinct options used in the NBD branch of block-export-add). Members bitmaps: array of string (optional) Also export each of the named dirty bitmaps reachable from device, so the NBD client can use NBD_OPT_SET_META_CONTEXT with the metadata context name "qemu:dirty-bitmap:BITMAP" to inspect each bitmap. allocation-depth: boolean (optional) Also export the allocation depth map for device, so the NBD client can use NBD_OPT_SET_META_CONTEXT with the metadata context name "qemu:allocation-depth" to inspect allocation details. (since 5.2) The members of BlockExportOptionsNbdBase Since 5.2 BlockExportOptionsVhostUserBlk (Object) A vhost-user-blk block export. Members addr: SocketAddress The vhost-user socket on which to listen. Both 'unix' and 'fd' SocketAddress types are supported. Passed fds must be UNIX domain sockets. logical-block-size: int (optional) Logical block size in bytes. Defaults to 512 bytes. num-queues: int (optional) Number of request virtqueues. Must be greater than 0. Defaults to 1. Since 5.2 FuseExportAllowOther (Enum) Possible allow_other modes for FUSE exports. Values off Do not pass allow_other as a mount option. on Pass allow_other as a mount option. auto Try mounting with allow_other first, and if that fails, retry without allow_other. Since 6.1 BlockExportOptionsFuse (Object) Options for exporting a block graph node on some (file) mountpoint as a raw image. Members mountpoint: string Path on which to export the block device via FUSE. This must point to an existing regular file. growable: boolean (optional) Whether writes beyond the EOF should grow the block node accordingly. (default: false) allow-other: FuseExportAllowOther (optional) If this is off, only qemu's user is allowed access to this export. That cannot be changed even with chmod or chown. Enabling this option will allow other users access to the export with the FUSE mount option "allow_other". Note that using allow_other as a non-root user requires user_allow_other to be enabled in the global fuse.conf configuration file. In auto mode (the default), the FUSE export driver will first attempt to mount the export with allow_other, and if that fails, try again without. (since 6.1; default: auto) Since 6.0 If CONFIG_FUSE NbdServerAddOptions (Object) An NBD block export, per legacy nbd-server-add command. Members device: string The device name or node name of the node to be exported writable: boolean (optional) Whether clients should be able to write to the device via the NBD connection (default false). bitmap: string (optional) Also export a single dirty bitmap reachable from device, so the NBD client can use NBD_OPT_SET_META_CONTEXT with the metadata context name "qemu:dirty-bitmap:BITMAP" to inspect the bitmap (since 4.0). The members of BlockExportOptionsNbdBase Since 5.0 nbd-server-add (Command) Export a block node to QEMU's embedded NBD server. The export name will be used as the id for the resulting block export. Arguments The members of NbdServerAddOptions Features deprecated This command is deprecated. Use block-export-add instead. Returns error if the server is not running, or export with the same name already exists. Since 1.3 BlockExportRemoveMode (Enum) Mode for removing a block export. Values safe Remove export if there are no existing connections, fail otherwise. hard Drop all connections immediately and remove export. Potential additional modes to be added in the future: hide: Just hide export from new clients, leave existing connections as is. Remove export after all clients are disconnected. soft: Hide export from new clients, answer with ESHUTDOWN for all further requests from existing clients. Since 2.12 nbd-server-remove (Command) Remove NBD export by name. Arguments name: string Block export id. mode: BlockExportRemoveMode (optional) Mode of command operation. See BlockExportRemoveMode description. Default is 'safe'. Features deprecated This command is deprecated. Use block-export-del instead. Returns error if • the server is not running • export is not found • mode is 'safe' and there are existing connections Since 2.12 nbd-server-stop (Command) Stop QEMU's embedded NBD server, and unregister all devices previously added via nbd-server-add. Since 1.3 BlockExportType (Enum) An enumeration of block export types Values nbd NBD export vhost-user-blk vhost-user-blk export (since 5.2) fuse (If: CONFIG_FUSE) FUSE export (since: 6.0) Since 4.2 BlockExportOptions (Object) Describes a block export, i.e. how single node should be exported on an external interface. Members id: string A unique identifier for the block export (across all export types) node-name: string The node name of the block node to be exported (since: 5.2) writable: boolean (optional) True if clients should be able to write to the export (default false) writethrough: boolean (optional) If true, caches are flushed after every write request to the export before completion is signalled. (since: 5.2; default: false) iothread: string (optional) The name of the iothread object where the export will run. The default is to use the thread currently associated with the block node. (since: 5.2) fixed-iothread: boolean (optional) True prevents the block node from being moved to another thread while the export is active. If true and iothread is given, export creation fails if the block node cannot be moved to the iothread. The default is false. (since: 5.2) type: BlockExportType Not documented The members of BlockExportOptionsNbd when type is "nbd" The members of BlockExportOptionsVhostUserBlk when type is "vhost-user-blk" The members of BlockExportOptionsFuse when type is "fuse" (If: CONFIG_FUSE) Since 4.2 block-export-add (Command) Creates a new block export. Arguments The members of BlockExportOptions Since 5.2 block-export-del (Command) Request to remove a block export. This drops the user's reference to the export, but the export may still stay around after this command returns until the shutdown of the export has completed. Arguments id: string Block export id. mode: BlockExportRemoveMode (optional) Mode of command operation. See BlockExportRemoveMode description. Default is 'safe'. Returns Error if the export is not found or mode is 'safe' and the export is still in use (e.g. by existing client connections) Since 5.2 BLOCK_EXPORT_DELETED (Event) Emitted when a block export is removed and its id can be reused. Arguments id: string Block export id. Since 5.2 BlockExportInfo (Object) Information about a single block export. Members id: string The unique identifier for the block export type: BlockExportType The block export type node-name: string The node name of the block node that is exported shutting-down: boolean True if the export is shutting down (e.g. after a block-export-del command, but before the shutdown has completed) Since 5.2 query-block-exports (Command) Returns A list of BlockExportInfo describing all block exports Since 5.2
CHARACTER DEVICES
ChardevInfo (Object) Information about a character device. Members label: string the label of the character device filename: string the filename of the character device frontend-open: boolean shows whether the frontend device attached to this backend (eg. with the chardev=... option) is in open or closed state (since 2.1) Notes filename is encoded using the QEMU command line character device encoding. See the QEMU man page for details. Since 0.14 query-chardev (Command) Returns information about current character devices. Returns a list of ChardevInfo Since 0.14 Example -> { "execute": "query-chardev" } <- { "return": [ { "label": "charchannel0", "filename": "unix:/var/lib/libvirt/qemu/seabios.rhel6.agent,server=on", "frontend-open": false }, { "label": "charmonitor", "filename": "unix:/var/lib/libvirt/qemu/seabios.rhel6.monitor,server=on", "frontend-open": true }, { "label": "charserial0", "filename": "pty:/dev/pts/2", "frontend-open": true } ] } ChardevBackendInfo (Object) Information about a character device backend Members name: string The backend name Since 2.0 query-chardev-backends (Command) Returns information about character device backends. Returns a list of ChardevBackendInfo Since 2.0 Example -> { "execute": "query-chardev-backends" } <- { "return":[ { "name":"udp" }, { "name":"tcp" }, { "name":"unix" }, { "name":"spiceport" } ] } DataFormat (Enum) An enumeration of data format. Values utf8 Data is a UTF-8 string (RFC 3629) base64 Data is Base64 encoded binary (RFC 3548) Since 1.4 ringbuf-write (Command) Write to a ring buffer character device. Arguments device: string the ring buffer character device name data: string data to write format: DataFormat (optional) data encoding (default 'utf8'). • base64: data must be base64 encoded text. Its binary decoding gets written. • utf8: data's UTF-8 encoding is written • data itself is always Unicode regardless of format, like any other string. Returns Nothing on success Since 1.4 Example -> { "execute": "ringbuf-write", "arguments": { "device": "foo", "data": "abcdefgh", "format": "utf8" } } <- { "return": {} } ringbuf-read (Command) Read from a ring buffer character device. Arguments device: string the ring buffer character device name size: int how many bytes to read at most format: DataFormat (optional) data encoding (default 'utf8'). • base64: the data read is returned in base64 encoding. • utf8: the data read is interpreted as UTF-8. Bug: can screw up when the buffer contains invalid UTF-8 sequences, NUL characters, after the ring buffer lost data, and when reading stops because the size limit is reached. • The return value is always Unicode regardless of format, like any other string. Returns data read from the device Since 1.4 Example -> { "execute": "ringbuf-read", "arguments": { "device": "foo", "size": 1000, "format": "utf8" } } <- { "return": "abcdefgh" } ChardevCommon (Object) Configuration shared across all chardev backends Members logfile: string (optional) The name of a logfile to save output logappend: boolean (optional) true to append instead of truncate (default to false to truncate) Since 2.6 ChardevFile (Object) Configuration info for file chardevs. Members in: string (optional) The name of the input file out: string The name of the output file append: boolean (optional) Open the file in append mode (default false to truncate) (Since 2.6) The members of ChardevCommon Since 1.4 ChardevHostdev (Object) Configuration info for device and pipe chardevs. Members device: string The name of the special file for the device, i.e. /dev/ttyS0 on Unix or COM1: on Windows The members of ChardevCommon Since 1.4 ChardevSocket (Object) Configuration info for (stream) socket chardevs. Members addr: SocketAddressLegacy socket address to listen on (server=true) or connect to (server=false) tls-creds: string (optional) the ID of the TLS credentials object (since 2.6) tls-authz: string (optional) the ID of the QAuthZ authorization object against which the client's x509 distinguished name will be validated. This object is only resolved at time of use, so can be deleted and recreated on the fly while the chardev server is active. If missing, it will default to denying access (since 4.0) server: boolean (optional) create server socket (default: true) wait: boolean (optional) wait for incoming connection on server sockets (default: false). Silently ignored with server: false. This use is deprecated. nodelay: boolean (optional) set TCP_NODELAY socket option (default: false) telnet: boolean (optional) enable telnet protocol on server sockets (default: false) tn3270: boolean (optional) enable tn3270 protocol on server sockets (default: false) (Since: 2.10) websocket: boolean (optional) enable websocket protocol on server sockets (default: false) (Since: 3.1) reconnect: int (optional) For a client socket, if a socket is disconnected, then attempt a reconnect after the given number of seconds. Setting this to zero disables this function. (default: 0) (Since: 2.2) The members of ChardevCommon Since 1.4 ChardevUdp (Object) Configuration info for datagram socket chardevs. Members remote: SocketAddressLegacy remote address local: SocketAddressLegacy (optional) local address The members of ChardevCommon Since 1.5 ChardevMux (Object) Configuration info for mux chardevs. Members chardev: string name of the base chardev. The members of ChardevCommon Since 1.5 ChardevStdio (Object) Configuration info for stdio chardevs. Members signal: boolean (optional) Allow signals (such as SIGINT triggered by ^C) be delivered to qemu. Default: true. The members of ChardevCommon Since 1.5 ChardevSpiceChannel (Object) Configuration info for spice vm channel chardevs. Members type: string kind of channel (for example vdagent). The members of ChardevCommon Since 1.5 If CONFIG_SPICE ChardevSpicePort (Object) Configuration info for spice port chardevs. Members fqdn: string name of the channel (see docs/spice-port-fqdn.txt) The members of ChardevCommon Since 1.5 If CONFIG_SPICE ChardevVC (Object) Configuration info for virtual console chardevs. Members width: int (optional) console width, in pixels height: int (optional) console height, in pixels cols: int (optional) console width, in chars rows: int (optional) console height, in chars The members of ChardevCommon Since 1.5 ChardevRingbuf (Object) Configuration info for ring buffer chardevs. Members size: int (optional) ring buffer size, must be power of two, default is 65536 The members of ChardevCommon Since 1.5 ChardevQemuVDAgent (Object) Configuration info for qemu vdagent implementation. Members mouse: boolean (optional) enable/disable mouse, default is enabled. clipboard: boolean (optional) enable/disable clipboard, default is disabled. The members of ChardevCommon Since 6.1 If CONFIG_SPICE_PROTOCOL ChardevBackendKind (Enum) Values pipe Since 1.5 udp Since 1.5 mux Since 1.5 msmouse Since 1.5 wctablet Since 2.9 braille Since 1.5 testdev Since 2.2 stdio Since 1.5 console Since 1.5 spicevmc (If: CONFIG_SPICE) Since 1.5 spiceport (If: CONFIG_SPICE) Since 1.5 qemu-vdagent (If: CONFIG_SPICE_PROTOCOL) Since 6.1 vc v1.5 ringbuf Since 1.6 memory Since 1.5 file Not documented serial Not documented parallel Not documented socket Not documented pty Not documented null Not documented Since 1.4 ChardevFileWrapper (Object) Members data: ChardevFile Not documented Since 1.4 ChardevHostdevWrapper (Object) Members data: ChardevHostdev Not documented Since 1.4 ChardevSocketWrapper (Object) Members data: ChardevSocket Not documented Since 1.4 ChardevUdpWrapper (Object) Members data: ChardevUdp Not documented Since 1.5 ChardevCommonWrapper (Object) Members data: ChardevCommon Not documented Since 2.6 ChardevMuxWrapper (Object) Members data: ChardevMux Not documented Since 1.5 ChardevStdioWrapper (Object) Members data: ChardevStdio Not documented Since 1.5 ChardevSpiceChannelWrapper (Object) Members data: ChardevSpiceChannel Not documented Since 1.5 If CONFIG_SPICE ChardevSpicePortWrapper (Object) Members data: ChardevSpicePort Not documented Since 1.5 If CONFIG_SPICE ChardevQemuVDAgentWrapper (Object) Members data: ChardevQemuVDAgent Not documented Since 6.1 If CONFIG_SPICE_PROTOCOL ChardevVCWrapper (Object) Members data: ChardevVC Not documented Since 1.5 ChardevRingbufWrapper (Object) Members data: ChardevRingbuf Not documented Since 1.5 ChardevBackend (Object) Configuration info for the new chardev backend. Members type: ChardevBackendKind Not documented The members of ChardevFileWrapper when type is "file" The members of ChardevHostdevWrapper when type is "serial" The members of ChardevHostdevWrapper when type is "parallel" The members of ChardevHostdevWrapper when type is "pipe" The members of ChardevSocketWrapper when type is "socket" The members of ChardevUdpWrapper when type is "udp" The members of ChardevCommonWrapper when type is "pty" The members of ChardevCommonWrapper when type is "null" The members of ChardevMuxWrapper when type is "mux" The members of ChardevCommonWrapper when type is "msmouse" The members of ChardevCommonWrapper when type is "wctablet" The members of ChardevCommonWrapper when type is "braille" The members of ChardevCommonWrapper when type is "testdev" The members of ChardevStdioWrapper when type is "stdio" The members of ChardevCommonWrapper when type is "console" The members of ChardevSpiceChannelWrapper when type is "spicevmc" (If: CONFIG_SPICE) The members of ChardevSpicePortWrapper when type is "spiceport" (If: CONFIG_SPICE) The members of ChardevQemuVDAgentWrapper when type is "qemu-vdagent" (If: CONFIG_SPICE_PROTOCOL) The members of ChardevVCWrapper when type is "vc" The members of ChardevRingbufWrapper when type is "ringbuf" The members of ChardevRingbufWrapper when type is "memory" Since 1.4 ChardevReturn (Object) Return info about the chardev backend just created. Members pty: string (optional) name of the slave pseudoterminal device, present if and only if a chardev of type 'pty' was created Since 1.4 chardev-add (Command) Add a character device backend Arguments id: string the chardev's ID, must be unique backend: ChardevBackend backend type and parameters Returns ChardevReturn. Since 1.4 Example -> { "execute" : "chardev-add", "arguments" : { "id" : "foo", "backend" : { "type" : "null", "data" : {} } } } <- { "return": {} } -> { "execute" : "chardev-add", "arguments" : { "id" : "bar", "backend" : { "type" : "file", "data" : { "out" : "/tmp/bar.log" } } } } <- { "return": {} } -> { "execute" : "chardev-add", "arguments" : { "id" : "baz", "backend" : { "type" : "pty", "data" : {} } } } <- { "return": { "pty" : "/dev/pty/42" } } chardev-change (Command) Change a character device backend Arguments id: string the chardev's ID, must exist backend: ChardevBackend new backend type and parameters Returns ChardevReturn. Since 2.10 Example -> { "execute" : "chardev-change", "arguments" : { "id" : "baz", "backend" : { "type" : "pty", "data" : {} } } } <- { "return": { "pty" : "/dev/pty/42" } } -> {"execute" : "chardev-change", "arguments" : { "id" : "charchannel2", "backend" : { "type" : "socket", "data" : { "addr" : { "type" : "unix" , "data" : { "path" : "/tmp/charchannel2.socket" } }, "server" : true, "wait" : false }}}} <- {"return": {}} chardev-remove (Command) Remove a character device backend Arguments id: string the chardev's ID, must exist and not be in use Returns Nothing on success Since 1.4 Example -> { "execute": "chardev-remove", "arguments": { "id" : "foo" } } <- { "return": {} } chardev-send-break (Command) Send a break to a character device Arguments id: string the chardev's ID, must exist Returns Nothing on success Since 2.10 Example -> { "execute": "chardev-send-break", "arguments": { "id" : "foo" } } <- { "return": {} } VSERPORT_CHANGE (Event) Emitted when the guest opens or closes a virtio-serial port. Arguments id: string device identifier of the virtio-serial port open: boolean true if the guest has opened the virtio-serial port Note This event is rate-limited. Since 2.1 Example <- { "event": "VSERPORT_CHANGE", "data": { "id": "channel0", "open": true }, "timestamp": { "seconds": 1401385907, "microseconds": 422329 } }
DUMP GUEST MEMORY
DumpGuestMemoryFormat (Enum) An enumeration of guest-memory-dump's format. Values elf elf format kdump-zlib kdump-compressed format with zlib-compressed kdump-lzo kdump-compressed format with lzo-compressed kdump-snappy kdump-compressed format with snappy-compressed win-dmp Windows full crashdump format, can be used instead of ELF converting (since 2.13) Since 2.0 dump-guest-memory (Command) Dump guest's memory to vmcore. It is a synchronous operation that can take very long depending on the amount of guest memory. Arguments paging: boolean if true, do paging to get guest's memory mapping. This allows using gdb to process the core file. IMPORTANT: this option can make QEMU allocate several gigabytes of RAM. This can happen for a large guest, or a malicious guest pretending to be large. Also, paging=true has the following limitations: 1. The guest may be in a catastrophic state or can have corrupted memory, which cannot be trusted 2. The guest can be in real-mode even if paging is enabled. For example, the guest uses ACPI to sleep, and ACPI sleep state goes in real-mode 3. Currently only supported on i386 and x86_64. protocol: string the filename or file descriptor of the vmcore. The supported protocols are: 1. file: the protocol starts with "file:", and the following string is the file's path. 2. fd: the protocol starts with "fd:", and the following string is the fd's name. detach: boolean (optional) if true, QMP will return immediately rather than waiting for the dump to finish. The user can track progress using "query-dump". (since 2.6). begin: int (optional) if specified, the starting physical address. length: int (optional) if specified, the memory size, in bytes. If you don't want to dump all guest's memory, please specify the start begin and length format: DumpGuestMemoryFormat (optional) if specified, the format of guest memory dump. But non-elf format is conflict with paging and filter, ie. paging, begin and length is not allowed to be specified with non-elf format at the same time (since 2.0) Note All boolean arguments default to false Returns nothing on success Since 1.2 Example -> { "execute": "dump-guest-memory", "arguments": { "protocol": "fd:dump" } } <- { "return": {} } DumpStatus (Enum) Describe the status of a long-running background guest memory dump. Values none no dump-guest-memory has started yet. active there is one dump running in background. completed the last dump has finished successfully. failed the last dump has failed. Since 2.6 DumpQueryResult (Object) The result format for 'query-dump'. Members status: DumpStatus enum of DumpStatus, which shows current dump status completed: int bytes written in latest dump (uncompressed) total: int total bytes to be written in latest dump (uncompressed) Since 2.6 query-dump (Command) Query latest dump status. Returns A DumpStatus object showing the dump status. Since 2.6 Example -> { "execute": "query-dump" } <- { "return": { "status": "active", "completed": 1024000, "total": 2048000 } } DUMP_COMPLETED (Event) Emitted when background dump has completed Arguments result: DumpQueryResult final dump status error: string (optional) human-readable error string that provides hint on why dump failed. Only presents on failure. The user should not try to interpret the error string. Since 2.6 Example { "event": "DUMP_COMPLETED", "data": {"result": {"total": 1090650112, "status": "completed", "completed": 1090650112} } } DumpGuestMemoryCapability (Object) A list of the available formats for dump-guest-memory Members formats: array of DumpGuestMemoryFormat Not documented Since 2.0 query-dump-guest-memory-capability (Command) Returns the available formats for dump-guest-memory Returns A DumpGuestMemoryCapability object listing available formats for dump-guest-memory Since 2.0 Example -> { "execute": "query-dump-guest-memory-capability" } <- { "return": { "formats": ["elf", "kdump-zlib", "kdump-lzo", "kdump-snappy"] }
NET DEVICES
set_link (Command) Sets the link status of a virtual network adapter. Arguments name: string the device name of the virtual network adapter up: boolean true to set the link status to be up Returns Nothing on success If name is not a valid network device, DeviceNotFound Since 0.14 Notes Not all network adapters support setting link status. This command will succeed even if the network adapter does not support link status notification. Example -> { "execute": "set_link", "arguments": { "name": "e1000.0", "up": false } } <- { "return": {} } netdev_add (Command) Add a network backend. Additional arguments depend on the type. Arguments The members of Netdev Since 0.14 Returns Nothing on success If type is not a valid network backend, DeviceNotFound Example -> { "execute": "netdev_add", "arguments": { "type": "user", "id": "netdev1", "dnssearch": "example.org" } } <- { "return": {} } netdev_del (Command) Remove a network backend. Arguments id: string the name of the network backend to remove Returns Nothing on success If id is not a valid network backend, DeviceNotFound Since 0.14 Example -> { "execute": "netdev_del", "arguments": { "id": "netdev1" } } <- { "return": {} } NetLegacyNicOptions (Object) Create a new Network Interface Card. Members netdev: string (optional) id of -netdev to connect to macaddr: string (optional) MAC address model: string (optional) device model (e1000, rtl8139, virtio etc.) addr: string (optional) PCI device address vectors: int (optional) number of MSI-x vectors, 0 to disable MSI-X Since 1.2 NetdevUserOptions (Object) Use the user mode network stack which requires no administrator privilege to run. Members hostname: string (optional) client hostname reported by the builtin DHCP server restrict: boolean (optional) isolate the guest from the host ipv4: boolean (optional) whether to support IPv4, default true for enabled (since 2.6) ipv6: boolean (optional) whether to support IPv6, default true for enabled (since 2.6) ip: string (optional) legacy parameter, use net= instead net: string (optional) IP network address that the guest will see, in the form addr[/netmask] The netmask is optional, and can be either in the form a.b.c.d or as a number of valid top-most bits. Default is 10.0.2.0/24. host: string (optional) guest-visible address of the host tftp: string (optional) root directory of the built-in TFTP server bootfile: string (optional) BOOTP filename, for use with tftp= dhcpstart: string (optional) the first of the 16 IPs the built-in DHCP server can assign dns: string (optional) guest-visible address of the virtual nameserver dnssearch: array of String (optional) list of DNS suffixes to search, passed as DHCP option to the guest domainname: string (optional) guest-visible domain name of the virtual nameserver (since 3.0) ipv6-prefix: string (optional) IPv6 network prefix (default is fec0::) (since 2.6). The network prefix is given in the usual hexadecimal IPv6 address notation. ipv6-prefixlen: int (optional) IPv6 network prefix length (default is 64) (since 2.6) ipv6-host: string (optional) guest-visible IPv6 address of the host (since 2.6) ipv6-dns: string (optional) guest-visible IPv6 address of the virtual nameserver (since 2.6) smb: string (optional) root directory of the built-in SMB server smbserver: string (optional) IP address of the built-in SMB server hostfwd: array of String (optional) redirect incoming TCP or UDP host connections to guest endpoints guestfwd: array of String (optional) forward guest TCP connections tftp-server-name: string (optional) RFC2132 "TFTP server name" string (Since 3.1) Since 1.2 NetdevTapOptions (Object) Used to configure a host TAP network interface backend. Members ifname: string (optional) interface name fd: string (optional) file descriptor of an already opened tap fds: string (optional) multiple file descriptors of already opened multiqueue capable tap script: string (optional) script to initialize the interface downscript: string (optional) script to shut down the interface br: string (optional) bridge name (since 2.8) helper: string (optional) command to execute to configure bridge sndbuf: int (optional) send buffer limit. Understands [TGMKkb] suffixes. vnet_hdr: boolean (optional) enable the IFF_VNET_HDR flag on the tap interface vhost: boolean (optional) enable vhost-net network accelerator vhostfd: string (optional) file descriptor of an already opened vhost net device vhostfds: string (optional) file descriptors of multiple already opened vhost net devices vhostforce: boolean (optional) vhost on for non-MSIX virtio guests queues: int (optional) number of queues to be created for multiqueue capable tap poll-us: int (optional) maximum number of microseconds that could be spent on busy polling for tap (since 2.7) Since 1.2 NetdevSocketOptions (Object) Socket netdevs are used to establish a network connection to another QEMU virtual machine via a TCP socket. Members fd: string (optional) file descriptor of an already opened socket listen: string (optional) port number, and optional hostname, to listen on connect: string (optional) port number, and optional hostname, to connect to mcast: string (optional) UDP multicast address and port number localaddr: string (optional) source address and port for multicast and udp packets udp: string (optional) UDP unicast address and port number Since 1.2 NetdevL2TPv3Options (Object) Configure an Ethernet over L2TPv3 tunnel. Members src: string source address dst: string destination address srcport: string (optional) source port - mandatory for udp, optional for ip dstport: string (optional) destination port - mandatory for udp, optional for ip ipv6: boolean (optional) force the use of ipv6 udp: boolean (optional) use the udp version of l2tpv3 encapsulation cookie64: boolean (optional) use 64 bit coookies counter: boolean (optional) have sequence counter pincounter: boolean (optional) pin sequence counter to zero - workaround for buggy implementations or networks with packet reorder txcookie: int (optional) 32 or 64 bit transmit cookie rxcookie: int (optional) 32 or 64 bit receive cookie txsession: int 32 bit transmit session rxsession: int (optional) 32 bit receive session - if not specified set to the same value as transmit offset: int (optional) additional offset - allows the insertion of additional application-specific data before the packet payload Since 2.1 NetdevVdeOptions (Object) Connect to a vde switch running on the host. Members sock: string (optional) socket path port: int (optional) port number group: string (optional) group owner of socket mode: int (optional) permissions for socket Since 1.2 NetdevBridgeOptions (Object) Connect a host TAP network interface to a host bridge device. Members br: string (optional) bridge name helper: string (optional) command to execute to configure bridge Since 1.2 NetdevHubPortOptions (Object) Connect two or more net clients through a software hub. Members hubid: int hub identifier number netdev: string (optional) used to connect hub to a netdev instead of a device (since 2.12) Since 1.2 NetdevNetmapOptions (Object) Connect a client to a netmap-enabled NIC or to a VALE switch port Members ifname: string Either the name of an existing network interface supported by netmap, or the name of a VALE port (created on the fly). A VALE port name is in the form 'valeXXX:YYY', where XXX and YYY are non-negative integers. XXX identifies a switch and YYY identifies a port of the switch. VALE ports having the same XXX are therefore connected to the same switch. devname: string (optional) path of the netmap device (default: '/dev/netmap'). Since 2.0 NetdevVhostUserOptions (Object) Vhost-user network backend Members chardev: string name of a unix socket chardev vhostforce: boolean (optional) vhost on for non-MSIX virtio guests (default: false). queues: int (optional) number of queues to be created for multiqueue vhost-user (default: 1) (Since 2.5) Since 2.1 NetdevVhostVDPAOptions (Object) Vhost-vdpa network backend vDPA device is a device that uses a datapath which complies with the virtio specifications with a vendor specific control path. Members vhostdev: string (optional) path of vhost-vdpa device (default:'/dev/vhost-vdpa-0') queues: int (optional) number of queues to be created for multiqueue vhost-vdpa (default: 1) Since 5.1 NetClientDriver (Enum) Available netdev drivers. Values none Not documented nic Not documented user Not documented tap Not documented l2tpv3 Not documented socket Not documented vde Not documented bridge Not documented hubport Not documented netmap Not documented vhost-user Not documented vhost-vdpa Not documented Since 2.7 vhost-vdpa since 5.1 Netdev (Object) Captures the configuration of a network device. Members id: string identifier for monitor commands. type: NetClientDriver Specify the driver used for interpreting remaining arguments. The members of NetLegacyNicOptions when type is "nic" The members of NetdevUserOptions when type is "user" The members of NetdevTapOptions when type is "tap" The members of NetdevL2TPv3Options when type is "l2tpv3" The members of NetdevSocketOptions when type is "socket" The members of NetdevVdeOptions when type is "vde" The members of NetdevBridgeOptions when type is "bridge" The members of NetdevHubPortOptions when type is "hubport" The members of NetdevNetmapOptions when type is "netmap" The members of NetdevVhostUserOptions when type is "vhost-user" The members of NetdevVhostVDPAOptions when type is "vhost-vdpa" Since 1.2 'l2tpv3' - since 2.1 RxState (Enum) Packets receiving state Values normal filter assigned packets according to the mac-table none don't receive any assigned packet all receive all assigned packets Since 1.6 RxFilterInfo (Object) Rx-filter information for a NIC. Members name: string net client name promiscuous: boolean whether promiscuous mode is enabled multicast: RxState multicast receive state unicast: RxState unicast receive state vlan: RxState vlan receive state (Since 2.0) broadcast-allowed: boolean whether to receive broadcast multicast-overflow: boolean multicast table is overflowed or not unicast-overflow: boolean unicast table is overflowed or not main-mac: string the main macaddr string vlan-table: array of int a list of active vlan id unicast-table: array of string a list of unicast macaddr string multicast-table: array of string a list of multicast macaddr string Since 1.6 query-rx-filter (Command) Return rx-filter information for all NICs (or for the given NIC). Arguments name: string (optional) net client name Returns list of RxFilterInfo for all NICs (or for the given NIC). Returns an error if the given name doesn't exist, or given NIC doesn't support rx-filter querying, or given net client isn't a NIC. Since 1.6 Example -> { "execute": "query-rx-filter", "arguments": { "name": "vnet0" } } <- { "return": [ { "promiscuous": true, "name": "vnet0", "main-mac": "52:54:00:12:34:56", "unicast": "normal", "vlan": "normal", "vlan-table": [ 4, 0 ], "unicast-table": [ ], "multicast": "normal", "multicast-overflow": false, "unicast-overflow": false, "multicast-table": [ "01:00:5e:00:00:01", "33:33:00:00:00:01", "33:33:ff:12:34:56" ], "broadcast-allowed": false } ] } NIC_RX_FILTER_CHANGED (Event) Emitted once until the 'query-rx-filter' command is executed, the first event will always be emitted Arguments name: string (optional) net client name path: string device path Since 1.6 Example <- { "event": "NIC_RX_FILTER_CHANGED", "data": { "name": "vnet0", "path": "/machine/peripheral/vnet0/virtio-backend" }, "timestamp": { "seconds": 1368697518, "microseconds": 326866 } } } AnnounceParameters (Object) Parameters for self-announce timers Members initial: int Initial delay (in ms) before sending the first GARP/RARP announcement max: int Maximum delay (in ms) between GARP/RARP announcement packets rounds: int Number of self-announcement attempts step: int Delay increase (in ms) after each self-announcement attempt interfaces: array of string (optional) An optional list of interface names, which restricts the announcement to the listed interfaces. (Since 4.1) id: string (optional) A name to be used to identify an instance of announce-timers and to allow it to modified later. Not for use as part of the migration parameters. (Since 4.1) Since 4.0 announce-self (Command) Trigger generation of broadcast RARP frames to update network switches. This can be useful when network bonds fail-over the active slave. Arguments The members of AnnounceParameters Example -> { "execute": "announce-self", "arguments": { "initial": 50, "max": 550, "rounds": 10, "step": 50, "interfaces": ["vn2", "vn3"], "id": "bob" } } <- { "return": {} } Since 4.0 FAILOVER_NEGOTIATED (Event) Emitted when VIRTIO_NET_F_STANDBY was enabled during feature negotiation. Failover primary devices which were hidden (not hotplugged when requested) before will now be hotplugged by the virtio-net standby device. device-id: QEMU device id of the unplugged device Arguments device-id: string Not documented Since 4.2 Example <- { "event": "FAILOVER_NEGOTIATED", "data": "net1" }
RDMA DEVICE
RDMA_GID_STATUS_CHANGED (Event) Emitted when guest driver adds/deletes GID to/from device Arguments netdev: string RoCE Network Device name gid-status: boolean Add or delete indication subnet-prefix: int Subnet Prefix interface-id: int Not documented interface-id : Interface ID Since 4.0 Example <- {"timestamp": {"seconds": 1541579657, "microseconds": 986760}, "event": "RDMA_GID_STATUS_CHANGED", "data": {"netdev": "bridge0", "interface-id": 15880512517475447892, "gid-status": true, "subnet-prefix": 33022}}
ROCKER SWITCH DEVICE
RockerSwitch (Object) Rocker switch information. Members name: string switch name id: int switch ID ports: int number of front-panel ports Since 2.4 query-rocker (Command) Return rocker switch information. Arguments name: string Not documented Returns Rocker information Since 2.4 Example -> { "execute": "query-rocker", "arguments": { "name": "sw1" } } <- { "return": {"name": "sw1", "ports": 2, "id": 1327446905938}} RockerPortDuplex (Enum) An eumeration of port duplex states. Values half half duplex full full duplex Since 2.4 RockerPortAutoneg (Enum) An eumeration of port autoneg states. Values off autoneg is off on autoneg is on Since 2.4 RockerPort (Object) Rocker switch port information. Members name: string port name enabled: boolean port is enabled for I/O link-up: boolean physical link is UP on port speed: int port link speed in Mbps duplex: RockerPortDuplex port link duplex autoneg: RockerPortAutoneg port link autoneg Since 2.4 query-rocker-ports (Command) Return rocker switch port information. Arguments name: string Not documented Returns a list of RockerPort information Since 2.4 Example -> { "execute": "query-rocker-ports", "arguments": { "name": "sw1" } } <- { "return": [ {"duplex": "full", "enabled": true, "name": "sw1.1", "autoneg": "off", "link-up": true, "speed": 10000}, {"duplex": "full", "enabled": true, "name": "sw1.2", "autoneg": "off", "link-up": true, "speed": 10000} ]} RockerOfDpaFlowKey (Object) Rocker switch OF-DPA flow key Members priority: int key priority, 0 being lowest priority tbl-id: int flow table ID in-pport: int (optional) physical input port tunnel-id: int (optional) tunnel ID vlan-id: int (optional) VLAN ID eth-type: int (optional) Ethernet header type eth-src: string (optional) Ethernet header source MAC address eth-dst: string (optional) Ethernet header destination MAC address ip-proto: int (optional) IP Header protocol field ip-tos: int (optional) IP header TOS field ip-dst: string (optional) IP header destination address Note optional members may or may not appear in the flow key depending if they're relevant to the flow key. Since 2.4 RockerOfDpaFlowMask (Object) Rocker switch OF-DPA flow mask Members in-pport: int (optional) physical input port tunnel-id: int (optional) tunnel ID vlan-id: int (optional) VLAN ID eth-src: string (optional) Ethernet header source MAC address eth-dst: string (optional) Ethernet header destination MAC address ip-proto: int (optional) IP Header protocol field ip-tos: int (optional) IP header TOS field Note optional members may or may not appear in the flow mask depending if they're relevant to the flow mask. Since 2.4 RockerOfDpaFlowAction (Object) Rocker switch OF-DPA flow action Members goto-tbl: int (optional) next table ID group-id: int (optional) group ID tunnel-lport: int (optional) tunnel logical port ID vlan-id: int (optional) VLAN ID new-vlan-id: int (optional) new VLAN ID out-pport: int (optional) physical output port Note optional members may or may not appear in the flow action depending if they're relevant to the flow action. Since 2.4 RockerOfDpaFlow (Object) Rocker switch OF-DPA flow Members cookie: int flow unique cookie ID hits: int count of matches (hits) on flow key: RockerOfDpaFlowKey flow key mask: RockerOfDpaFlowMask flow mask action: RockerOfDpaFlowAction flow action Since 2.4 query-rocker-of-dpa-flows (Command) Return rocker OF-DPA flow information. Arguments name: string switch name tbl-id: int (optional) flow table ID. If tbl-id is not specified, returns flow information for all tables. Returns rocker OF-DPA flow information Since 2.4 Example -> { "execute": "query-rocker-of-dpa-flows", "arguments": { "name": "sw1" } } <- { "return": [ {"key": {"in-pport": 0, "priority": 1, "tbl-id": 0}, "hits": 138, "cookie": 0, "action": {"goto-tbl": 10}, "mask": {"in-pport": 4294901760} }, {...more...}, ]} RockerOfDpaGroup (Object) Rocker switch OF-DPA group Members id: int group unique ID type: int group type vlan-id: int (optional) VLAN ID pport: int (optional) physical port number index: int (optional) group index, unique with group type out-pport: int (optional) output physical port number group-id: int (optional) next group ID set-vlan-id: int (optional) VLAN ID to set pop-vlan: int (optional) pop VLAN headr from packet group-ids: array of int (optional) list of next group IDs set-eth-src: string (optional) set source MAC address in Ethernet header set-eth-dst: string (optional) set destination MAC address in Ethernet header ttl-check: int (optional) perform TTL check Note optional members may or may not appear in the group depending if they're relevant to the group type. Since 2.4 query-rocker-of-dpa-groups (Command) Return rocker OF-DPA group information. Arguments name: string switch name type: int (optional) group type. If type is not specified, returns group information for all group types. Returns rocker OF-DPA group information Since 2.4 Example -> { "execute": "query-rocker-of-dpa-groups", "arguments": { "name": "sw1" } } <- { "return": [ {"type": 0, "out-pport": 2, "pport": 2, "vlan-id": 3841, "pop-vlan": 1, "id": 251723778}, {"type": 0, "out-pport": 0, "pport": 0, "vlan-id": 3841, "pop-vlan": 1, "id": 251723776}, {"type": 0, "out-pport": 1, "pport": 1, "vlan-id": 3840, "pop-vlan": 1, "id": 251658241}, {"type": 0, "out-pport": 0, "pport": 0, "vlan-id": 3840, "pop-vlan": 1, "id": 251658240} ]}
TPM (TRUSTED PLATFORM MODULE) DEVICES
TpmModel (Enum) An enumeration of TPM models Values tpm-tis TPM TIS model tpm-crb TPM CRB model (since 2.12) tpm-spapr TPM SPAPR model (since 5.0) Since 1.5 If CONFIG_TPM query-tpm-models (Command) Return a list of supported TPM models Returns a list of TpmModel Since 1.5 Example -> { "execute": "query-tpm-models" } <- { "return": [ "tpm-tis", "tpm-crb", "tpm-spapr" ] } If CONFIG_TPM TpmType (Enum) An enumeration of TPM types Values passthrough TPM passthrough type emulator Software Emulator TPM type Since: 2.11 Since 1.5 If CONFIG_TPM query-tpm-types (Command) Return a list of supported TPM types Returns a list of TpmType Since 1.5 Example -> { "execute": "query-tpm-types" } <- { "return": [ "passthrough", "emulator" ] } If CONFIG_TPM TPMPassthroughOptions (Object) Information about the TPM passthrough type Members path: string (optional) string describing the path used for accessing the TPM device cancel-path: string (optional) string showing the TPM's sysfs cancel file for cancellation of TPM commands while they are executing Since 1.5 If CONFIG_TPM TPMEmulatorOptions (Object) Information about the TPM emulator type Members chardev: string Name of a unix socket chardev Since 2.11 If CONFIG_TPM TPMPassthroughOptionsWrapper (Object) Members data: TPMPassthroughOptions Not documented Since 1.5 If CONFIG_TPM TPMEmulatorOptionsWrapper (Object) Members data: TPMEmulatorOptions Not documented Since 2.11 If CONFIG_TPM TpmTypeOptions (Object) A union referencing different TPM backend types' configuration options Members type: TpmType • 'passthrough' The configuration options for the TPM passthrough type • 'emulator' The configuration options for TPM emulator backend type The members of TPMPassthroughOptionsWrapper when type is "passthrough" The members of TPMEmulatorOptionsWrapper when type is "emulator" Since 1.5 If CONFIG_TPM TPMInfo (Object) Information about the TPM Members id: string The Id of the TPM model: TpmModel The TPM frontend model options: TpmTypeOptions The TPM (backend) type configuration options Since 1.5 If CONFIG_TPM query-tpm (Command) Return information about the TPM device Returns TPMInfo on success Since 1.5 Example -> { "execute": "query-tpm" } <- { "return": [ { "model": "tpm-tis", "options": { "type": "passthrough", "data": { "cancel-path": "/sys/class/misc/tpm0/device/cancel", "path": "/dev/tpm0" } }, "id": "tpm0" } ] } If CONFIG_TPM
REMOTE DESKTOP
set_password (Command) Sets the password of a remote display session. Arguments protocol: string • 'vnc' to modify the VNC server password • 'spice' to modify the Spice server password password: string the new password connected: string (optional) how to handle existing clients when changing the password. If nothing is specified, defaults to 'keep' 'fail' to fail the command if clients are connected 'disconnect' to disconnect existing clients 'keep' to maintain existing clients Returns • Nothing on success • If Spice is not enabled, DeviceNotFound Since 0.14 Example -> { "execute": "set_password", "arguments": { "protocol": "vnc", "password": "secret" } } <- { "return": {} } expire_password (Command) Expire the password of a remote display server. Arguments protocol: string the name of the remote display protocol 'vnc' or 'spice' time: string when to expire the password. • 'now' to expire the password immediately • 'never' to cancel password expiration • '+INT' where INT is the number of seconds from now (integer) • 'INT' where INT is the absolute time in seconds Returns • Nothing on success • If protocol is 'spice' and Spice is not active, DeviceNotFound Since 0.14 Notes Time is relative to the server and currently there is no way to coordinate server time with client time. It is not recommended to use the absolute time version of the time parameter unless you're sure you are on the same machine as the QEMU instance. Example -> { "execute": "expire_password", "arguments": { "protocol": "vnc", "time": "+60" } } <- { "return": {} } screendump (Command) Write a PPM of the VGA screen to a file. Arguments filename: string the path of a new PPM file to store the image device: string (optional) ID of the display device that should be dumped. If this parameter is missing, the primary display will be used. (Since 2.12) head: int (optional) head to use in case the device supports multiple heads. If this parameter is missing, head #0 will be used. Also note that the head can only be specified in conjunction with the device ID. (Since 2.12) Returns Nothing on success Since 0.14 Example -> { "execute": "screendump", "arguments": { "filename": "/tmp/image" } } <- { "return": {} } Spice SpiceBasicInfo (Object) The basic information for SPICE network connection Members host: string IP address port: string port number family: NetworkAddressFamily address family Since 2.1 If CONFIG_SPICE SpiceServerInfo (Object) Information about a SPICE server Members auth: string (optional) authentication method The members of SpiceBasicInfo Since 2.1 If CONFIG_SPICE SpiceChannel (Object) Information about a SPICE client channel. Members connection-id: int SPICE connection id number. All channels with the same id belong to the same SPICE session. channel-type: int SPICE channel type number. "1" is the main control channel, filter for this one if you want to track spice sessions only channel-id: int SPICE channel ID number. Usually "0", might be different when multiple channels of the same type exist, such as multiple display channels in a multihead setup tls: boolean true if the channel is encrypted, false otherwise. The members of SpiceBasicInfo Since 0.14 If CONFIG_SPICE SpiceQueryMouseMode (Enum) An enumeration of Spice mouse states. Values client Mouse cursor position is determined by the client. server Mouse cursor position is determined by the server. unknown No information is available about mouse mode used by the spice server. Note spice/enums.h has a SpiceMouseMode already, hence the name. Since 1.1 If CONFIG_SPICE SpiceInfo (Object) Information about the SPICE session. Members enabled: boolean true if the SPICE server is enabled, false otherwise migrated: boolean true if the last guest migration completed and spice migration had completed as well. false otherwise. (since 1.4) host: string (optional) The hostname the SPICE server is bound to. This depends on the name resolution on the host and may be an IP address. port: int (optional) The SPICE server's port number. compiled-version: string (optional) SPICE server version. tls-port: int (optional) The SPICE server's TLS port number. auth: string (optional) the current authentication type used by the server • 'none' if no authentication is being used • 'spice' uses SASL or direct TLS authentication, depending on command line options mouse-mode: SpiceQueryMouseMode The mode in which the mouse cursor is displayed currently. Can be determined by the client or the server, or unknown if spice server doesn't provide this information. (since: 1.1) channels: array of SpiceChannel (optional) a list of SpiceChannel for each active spice channel Since 0.14 If CONFIG_SPICE query-spice (Command) Returns information about the current SPICE server Returns SpiceInfo Since 0.14 Example -> { "execute": "query-spice" } <- { "return": { "enabled": true, "auth": "spice", "port": 5920, "tls-port": 5921, "host": "0.0.0.0", "channels": [ { "port": "54924", "family": "ipv4", "channel-type": 1, "connection-id": 1804289383, "host": "127.0.0.1", "channel-id": 0, "tls": true }, { "port": "36710", "family": "ipv4", "channel-type": 4, "connection-id": 1804289383, "host": "127.0.0.1", "channel-id": 0, "tls": false }, [ ... more channels follow ... ] ] } } If CONFIG_SPICE SPICE_CONNECTED (Event) Emitted when a SPICE client establishes a connection Arguments server: SpiceBasicInfo server information client: SpiceBasicInfo client information Since 0.14 Example <- { "timestamp": {"seconds": 1290688046, "microseconds": 388707}, "event": "SPICE_CONNECTED", "data": { "server": { "port": "5920", "family": "ipv4", "host": "127.0.0.1"}, "client": {"port": "52873", "family": "ipv4", "host": "127.0.0.1"} }} If CONFIG_SPICE SPICE_INITIALIZED (Event) Emitted after initial handshake and authentication takes place (if any) and the SPICE channel is up and running Arguments server: SpiceServerInfo server information client: SpiceChannel client information Since 0.14 Example <- { "timestamp": {"seconds": 1290688046, "microseconds": 417172}, "event": "SPICE_INITIALIZED", "data": {"server": {"auth": "spice", "port": "5921", "family": "ipv4", "host": "127.0.0.1"}, "client": {"port": "49004", "family": "ipv4", "channel-type": 3, "connection-id": 1804289383, "host": "127.0.0.1", "channel-id": 0, "tls": true} }} If CONFIG_SPICE SPICE_DISCONNECTED (Event) Emitted when the SPICE connection is closed Arguments server: SpiceBasicInfo server information client: SpiceBasicInfo client information Since 0.14 Example <- { "timestamp": {"seconds": 1290688046, "microseconds": 388707}, "event": "SPICE_DISCONNECTED", "data": { "server": { "port": "5920", "family": "ipv4", "host": "127.0.0.1"}, "client": {"port": "52873", "family": "ipv4", "host": "127.0.0.1"} }} If CONFIG_SPICE SPICE_MIGRATE_COMPLETED (Event) Emitted when SPICE migration has completed Since 1.3 Example <- { "timestamp": {"seconds": 1290688046, "microseconds": 417172}, "event": "SPICE_MIGRATE_COMPLETED" } If CONFIG_SPICE VNC VncBasicInfo (Object) The basic information for vnc network connection Members host: string IP address service: string The service name of the vnc port. This may depend on the host system's service database so symbolic names should not be relied on. family: NetworkAddressFamily address family websocket: boolean true in case the socket is a websocket (since 2.3). Since 2.1 If CONFIG_VNC VncServerInfo (Object) The network connection information for server Members auth: string (optional) authentication method used for the plain (non-websocket) VNC server The members of VncBasicInfo Since 2.1 If CONFIG_VNC VncClientInfo (Object) Information about a connected VNC client. Members x509_dname: string (optional) If x509 authentication is in use, the Distinguished Name of the client. sasl_username: string (optional) If SASL authentication is in use, the SASL username used for authentication. The members of VncBasicInfo Since 0.14 If CONFIG_VNC VncInfo (Object) Information about the VNC session. Members enabled: boolean true if the VNC server is enabled, false otherwise host: string (optional) The hostname the VNC server is bound to. This depends on the name resolution on the host and may be an IP address. family: NetworkAddressFamily (optional) • 'ipv6' if the host is listening for IPv6 connections • 'ipv4' if the host is listening for IPv4 connections • 'unix' if the host is listening on a unix domain socket • 'unknown' otherwise service: string (optional) The service name of the server's port. This may depends on the host system's service database so symbolic names should not be relied on. auth: string (optional) the current authentication type used by the server • 'none' if no authentication is being used • 'vnc' if VNC authentication is being used • 'vencrypt+plain' if VEncrypt is used with plain text authentication • 'vencrypt+tls+none' if VEncrypt is used with TLS and no authentication • 'vencrypt+tls+vnc' if VEncrypt is used with TLS and VNC authentication • 'vencrypt+tls+plain' if VEncrypt is used with TLS and plain text auth • 'vencrypt+x509+none' if VEncrypt is used with x509 and no auth • 'vencrypt+x509+vnc' if VEncrypt is used with x509 and VNC auth • 'vencrypt+x509+plain' if VEncrypt is used with x509 and plain text auth • 'vencrypt+tls+sasl' if VEncrypt is used with TLS and SASL auth • 'vencrypt+x509+sasl' if VEncrypt is used with x509 and SASL auth clients: array of VncClientInfo (optional) a list of VncClientInfo of all currently connected clients Since 0.14 If CONFIG_VNC VncPrimaryAuth (Enum) vnc primary authentication method. Values none Not documented vnc Not documented ra2 Not documented ra2ne Not documented tight Not documented ultra Not documented tls Not documented vencrypt Not documented sasl Not documented Since 2.3 If CONFIG_VNC VncVencryptSubAuth (Enum) vnc sub authentication method with vencrypt. Values plain Not documented tls-none Not documented x509-none Not documented tls-vnc Not documented x509-vnc Not documented tls-plain Not documented x509-plain Not documented tls-sasl Not documented x509-sasl Not documented Since 2.3 If CONFIG_VNC VncServerInfo2 (Object) The network connection information for server Members auth: VncPrimaryAuth The current authentication type used by the servers vencrypt: VncVencryptSubAuth (optional) The vencrypt sub authentication type used by the servers, only specified in case auth == vencrypt. The members of VncBasicInfo Since 2.9 If CONFIG_VNC VncInfo2 (Object) Information about a vnc server Members id: string vnc server name. server: array of VncServerInfo2 A list of VncBasincInfo describing all listening sockets. The list can be empty (in case the vnc server is disabled). It also may have multiple entries: normal + websocket, possibly also ipv4 + ipv6 in the future. clients: array of VncClientInfo A list of VncClientInfo of all currently connected clients. The list can be empty, for obvious reasons. auth: VncPrimaryAuth The current authentication type used by the non-websockets servers vencrypt: VncVencryptSubAuth (optional) The vencrypt authentication type used by the servers, only specified in case auth == vencrypt. display: string (optional) The display device the vnc server is linked to. Since 2.3 If CONFIG_VNC query-vnc (Command) Returns information about the current VNC server Returns VncInfo Since 0.14 Example -> { "execute": "query-vnc" } <- { "return": { "enabled":true, "host":"0.0.0.0", "service":"50402", "auth":"vnc", "family":"ipv4", "clients":[ { "host":"127.0.0.1", "service":"50401", "family":"ipv4" } ] } } If CONFIG_VNC query-vnc-servers (Command) Returns a list of vnc servers. The list can be empty. Returns a list of VncInfo2 Since 2.3 If CONFIG_VNC change-vnc-password (Command) Change the VNC server password. Arguments password: string the new password to use with VNC authentication Since 1.1 Notes An empty password in this command will set the password to the empty string. Existing clients are unaffected by executing this command. If CONFIG_VNC VNC_CONNECTED (Event) Emitted when a VNC client establishes a connection Arguments server: VncServerInfo server information client: VncBasicInfo client information Note This event is emitted before any authentication takes place, thus the authentication ID is not provided Since 0.13 Example <- { "event": "VNC_CONNECTED", "data": { "server": { "auth": "sasl", "family": "ipv4", "service": "5901", "host": "0.0.0.0" }, "client": { "family": "ipv4", "service": "58425", "host": "127.0.0.1" } }, "timestamp": { "seconds": 1262976601, "microseconds": 975795 } } If CONFIG_VNC VNC_INITIALIZED (Event) Emitted after authentication takes place (if any) and the VNC session is made active Arguments server: VncServerInfo server information client: VncClientInfo client information Since 0.13 Example <- { "event": "VNC_INITIALIZED", "data": { "server": { "auth": "sasl", "family": "ipv4", "service": "5901", "host": "0.0.0.0"}, "client": { "family": "ipv4", "service": "46089", "host": "127.0.0.1", "sasl_username": "luiz" } }, "timestamp": { "seconds": 1263475302, "microseconds": 150772 } } If CONFIG_VNC VNC_DISCONNECTED (Event) Emitted when the connection is closed Arguments server: VncServerInfo server information client: VncClientInfo client information Since 0.13 Example <- { "event": "VNC_DISCONNECTED", "data": { "server": { "auth": "sasl", "family": "ipv4", "service": "5901", "host": "0.0.0.0" }, "client": { "family": "ipv4", "service": "58425", "host": "127.0.0.1", "sasl_username": "luiz" } }, "timestamp": { "seconds": 1262976601, "microseconds": 975795 } } If CONFIG_VNC
INPUT
MouseInfo (Object) Information about a mouse device. Members name: string the name of the mouse device index: int the index of the mouse device current: boolean true if this device is currently receiving mouse events absolute: boolean true if this device supports absolute coordinates as input Since 0.14 query-mice (Command) Returns information about each active mouse device Returns a list of MouseInfo for each device Since 0.14 Example -> { "execute": "query-mice" } <- { "return": [ { "name":"QEMU Microsoft Mouse", "index":0, "current":false, "absolute":false }, { "name":"QEMU PS/2 Mouse", "index":1, "current":true, "absolute":true } ] } QKeyCode (Enum) An enumeration of key name. This is used by the send-key command. Values unmapped since 2.0 pause since 2.0 ro since 2.4 kp_comma since 2.4 kp_equals since 2.6 power since 2.6 hiragana since 2.9 henkan since 2.9 yen since 2.9 sleep since 2.10 wake since 2.10 audionext since 2.10 audioprev since 2.10 audiostop since 2.10 audioplay since 2.10 audiomute since 2.10 volumeup since 2.10 volumedown since 2.10 mediaselect since 2.10 mail since 2.10 calculator since 2.10 computer since 2.10 ac_home since 2.10 ac_back since 2.10 ac_forward since 2.10 ac_refresh since 2.10 ac_bookmarks since 2.10 muhenkan since 2.12 katakanahiragana since 2.12 lang1 since 6.1 lang2 since 6.1 shift Not documented shift_r Not documented alt Not documented alt_r Not documented ctrl Not documented ctrl_r Not documented menu Not documented esc Not documented 1 Not documented 2 Not documented 3 Not documented 4 Not documented 5 Not documented 6 Not documented 7 Not documented 8 Not documented 9 Not documented 0 Not documented minus Not documented equal Not documented backspace Not documented tab Not documented q Not documented w Not documented e Not documented r Not documented t Not documented y Not documented u Not documented i Not documented o Not documented p Not documented bracket_left Not documented bracket_right Not documented ret Not documented a Not documented s Not documented d Not documented f Not documented g Not documented h Not documented j Not documented k Not documented l Not documented semicolon Not documented apostrophe Not documented grave_accent Not documented backslash Not documented z Not documented x Not documented c Not documented v Not documented b Not documented n Not documented m Not documented comma Not documented dot Not documented slash Not documented asterisk Not documented spc Not documented caps_lock Not documented f1 Not documented f2 Not documented f3 Not documented f4 Not documented f5 Not documented f6 Not documented f7 Not documented f8 Not documented f9 Not documented f10 Not documented num_lock Not documented scroll_lock Not documented kp_divide Not documented kp_multiply Not documented kp_subtract Not documented kp_add Not documented kp_enter Not documented kp_decimal Not documented sysrq Not documented kp_0 Not documented kp_1 Not documented kp_2 Not documented kp_3 Not documented kp_4 Not documented kp_5 Not documented kp_6 Not documented kp_7 Not documented kp_8 Not documented kp_9 Not documented less Not documented f11 Not documented f12 Not documented print Not documented home Not documented pgup Not documented pgdn Not documented end Not documented left Not documented up Not documented down Not documented right Not documented insert Not documented delete Not documented stop Not documented again Not documented props Not documented undo Not documented front Not documented copy Not documented open Not documented paste Not documented find Not documented cut Not documented lf Not documented help Not documented meta_l Not documented meta_r Not documented compose Not documented 'sysrq' was mistakenly added to hack around the fact that the ps2 driver was not generating correct scancodes sequences when 'alt+print' was pressed. This flaw is now fixed and the 'sysrq' key serves no further purpose. Any further use of 'sysrq' will be transparently changed to 'print', so they are effectively synonyms. Since 1.3 KeyValueKind (Enum) Values number Not documented qcode Not documented Since 1.3 IntWrapper (Object) Members data: int Not documented Since 1.3 QKeyCodeWrapper (Object) Members data: QKeyCode Not documented Since 1.3 KeyValue (Object) Represents a keyboard key. Members type: KeyValueKind Not documented The members of IntWrapper when type is "number" The members of QKeyCodeWrapper when type is "qcode" Since 1.3 send-key (Command) Send keys to guest. Arguments keys: array of KeyValue An array of KeyValue elements. All KeyValues in this array are simultaneously sent to the guest. A KeyValue.number value is sent directly to the guest, while KeyValue.qcode must be a valid QKeyCode value hold-time: int (optional) time to delay key up events, milliseconds. Defaults to 100 Returns • Nothing on success • If key is unknown or redundant, InvalidParameter Since 1.3 Example -> { "execute": "send-key", "arguments": { "keys": [ { "type": "qcode", "data": "ctrl" }, { "type": "qcode", "data": "alt" }, { "type": "qcode", "data": "delete" } ] } } <- { "return": {} } InputButton (Enum) Button of a pointer input device (mouse, tablet). Values side front side button of a 5-button mouse (since 2.9) extra rear side button of a 5-button mouse (since 2.9) left Not documented middle Not documented right Not documented wheel-up Not documented wheel-down Not documented Since 2.0 InputAxis (Enum) Position axis of a pointer input device (mouse, tablet). Values x Not documented y Not documented Since 2.0 InputKeyEvent (Object) Keyboard input event. Members key: KeyValue Which key this event is for. down: boolean True for key-down and false for key-up events. Since 2.0 InputBtnEvent (Object) Pointer button input event. Members button: InputButton Which button this event is for. down: boolean True for key-down and false for key-up events. Since 2.0 InputMoveEvent (Object) Pointer motion input event. Members axis: InputAxis Which axis is referenced by value. value: int Pointer position. For absolute coordinates the valid range is 0 -> 0x7ffff Since 2.0 InputEventKind (Enum) Values key Not documented btn Not documented rel Not documented abs Not documented Since 2.0 InputKeyEventWrapper (Object) Members data: InputKeyEvent Not documented Since 2.0 InputBtnEventWrapper (Object) Members data: InputBtnEvent Not documented Since 2.0 InputMoveEventWrapper (Object) Members data: InputMoveEvent Not documented Since 2.0 InputEvent (Object) Input event union. Members type: InputEventKind the input type, one of: • 'key': Input event of Keyboard • 'btn': Input event of pointer buttons • 'rel': Input event of relative pointer motion • 'abs': Input event of absolute pointer motion The members of InputKeyEventWrapper when type is "key" The members of InputBtnEventWrapper when type is "btn" The members of InputMoveEventWrapper when type is "rel" The members of InputMoveEventWrapper when type is "abs" Since 2.0 input-send-event (Command) Send input event(s) to guest. The device and head parameters can be used to send the input event to specific input devices in case (a) multiple input devices of the same kind are added to the virtual machine and (b) you have configured input routing (see docs/multiseat.txt) for those input devices. The parameters work exactly like the device and head properties of input devices. If device is missing, only devices that have no input routing config are admissible. If device is specified, both input devices with and without input routing config are admissible, but devices with input routing config take precedence. Arguments device: string (optional) display device to send event(s) to. head: int (optional) head to send event(s) to, in case the display device supports multiple scanouts. events: array of InputEvent List of InputEvent union. Returns Nothing on success. Since 2.6 Note The consoles are visible in the qom tree, under /backend/console[$index]. They have a device link and head property, so it is possible to map which console belongs to which device and display. Example 1. Press left mouse button. -> { "execute": "input-send-event", "arguments": { "device": "video0", "events": [ { "type": "btn", "data" : { "down": true, "button": "left" } } ] } } <- { "return": {} } -> { "execute": "input-send-event", "arguments": { "device": "video0", "events": [ { "type": "btn", "data" : { "down": false, "button": "left" } } ] } } <- { "return": {} } 2. Press ctrl-alt-del. -> { "execute": "input-send-event", "arguments": { "events": [ { "type": "key", "data" : { "down": true, "key": {"type": "qcode", "data": "ctrl" } } }, { "type": "key", "data" : { "down": true, "key": {"type": "qcode", "data": "alt" } } }, { "type": "key", "data" : { "down": true, "key": {"type": "qcode", "data": "delete" } } } ] } } <- { "return": {} } 3. Move mouse pointer to absolute coordinates (20000, 400). -> { "execute": "input-send-event" , "arguments": { "events": [ { "type": "abs", "data" : { "axis": "x", "value" : 20000 } }, { "type": "abs", "data" : { "axis": "y", "value" : 400 } } ] } } <- { "return": {} } DisplayGTK (Object) GTK display options. Members grab-on-hover: boolean (optional) Grab keyboard input on mouse hover. zoom-to-fit: boolean (optional) Zoom guest display to fit into the host window. When turned off the host window will be resized instead. In case the display device can notify the guest on window resizes (virtio-gpu) this will default to "on", assuming the guest will resize the display to match the window size then. Otherwise it defaults to "off". Since 3.1 Since 2.12 DisplayEGLHeadless (Object) EGL headless display options. Members rendernode: string (optional) Which DRM render node should be used. Default is the first available node on the host. Since 3.1 DisplayGLMode (Enum) Display OpenGL mode. Values off Disable OpenGL (default). on Use OpenGL, pick context type automatically. Would better be named 'auto' but is called 'on' for backward compatibility with bool type. core Use OpenGL with Core (desktop) Context. es Use OpenGL with ES (embedded systems) Context. Since 3.0 DisplayCurses (Object) Curses display options. Members charset: string (optional) Font charset used by guest (default: CP437). Since 4.0 DisplayType (Enum) Display (user interface) type. Values default The default user interface, selecting from the first available of gtk, sdl, cocoa, and vnc. none No user interface or video output display. The guest will still see an emulated graphics card, but its output will not be displayed to the QEMU user. gtk (If: CONFIG_GTK) The GTK user interface. sdl (If: CONFIG_SDL) The SDL user interface. egl-headless (If: CONFIG_OPENGL and CONFIG_GBM) No user interface, offload GL operations to a local DRI device. Graphical display need to be paired with VNC or Spice. (Since 3.1) curses (If: CONFIG_CURSES) Display video output via curses. For graphics device models which support a text mode, QEMU can display this output using a curses/ncurses interface. Nothing is displayed when the graphics device is in graphical mode or if the graphics device does not support a text mode. Generally only the VGA device models support text mode. cocoa (If: CONFIG_COCOA) The Cocoa user interface. spice-app (If: CONFIG_SPICE) Set up a Spice server and run the default associated application to connect to it. The server will redirect the serial console and QEMU monitors. (Since 4.0) Since 2.12 DisplayOptions (Object) Display (user interface) options. Members type: DisplayType Which DisplayType qemu should use. full-screen: boolean (optional) Start user interface in fullscreen mode (default: off). window-close: boolean (optional) Allow to quit qemu with window close button (default: on). show-cursor: boolean (optional) Force showing the mouse cursor (default: off). (since: 5.0) gl: DisplayGLMode (optional) Enable OpenGL support (default: off). The members of DisplayGTK when type is "gtk" (If: CONFIG_GTK) The members of DisplayCurses when type is "curses" (If: CONFIG_CURSES) The members of DisplayEGLHeadless when type is "egl-headless" (If: CONFIG_OPENGL and CONFIG_GBM) Since 2.12 query-display-options (Command) Returns information about display configuration Returns DisplayOptions Since 3.1 DisplayReloadType (Enum) Available DisplayReload types. Values vnc VNC display Since 6.0 DisplayReloadOptionsVNC (Object) Specify the VNC reload options. Members tls-certs: boolean (optional) reload tls certs or not. Since 6.0 DisplayReloadOptions (Object) Options of the display configuration reload. Members type: DisplayReloadType Specify the display type. The members of DisplayReloadOptionsVNC when type is "vnc" Since 6.0 display-reload (Command) Reload display configuration. Arguments The members of DisplayReloadOptions Returns Nothing on success. Since 6.0 Example -> { "execute": "display-reload", "arguments": { "type": "vnc", "tls-certs": true } } <- { "return": {} }
USER AUTHORIZATION
QAuthZListPolicy (Enum) The authorization policy result Values deny deny access allow allow access Since 4.0 QAuthZListFormat (Enum) The authorization policy match format Values exact an exact string match glob string with ? and * shell wildcard support Since 4.0 QAuthZListRule (Object) A single authorization rule. Members match: string a string or glob to match against a user identity policy: QAuthZListPolicy the result to return if match evaluates to true format: QAuthZListFormat (optional) the format of the match rule (default 'exact') Since 4.0 AuthZListProperties (Object) Properties for authz-list objects. Members policy: QAuthZListPolicy (optional) Default policy to apply when no rule matches (default: deny) rules: array of QAuthZListRule (optional) Authorization rules based on matching user Since 4.0 AuthZListFileProperties (Object) Properties for authz-listfile objects. Members filename: string File name to load the configuration from. The file must contain valid JSON for AuthZListProperties. refresh: boolean (optional) If true, inotify is used to monitor the file, automatically reloading changes. If an error occurs during reloading, all authorizations will fail until the file is next successfully loaded. (default: true if the binary was built with CONFIG_INOTIFY1, false otherwise) Since 4.0 AuthZPAMProperties (Object) Properties for authz-pam objects. Members service: string PAM service name to use for authorization Since 4.0 AuthZSimpleProperties (Object) Properties for authz-simple objects. Members identity: string Identifies the allowed user. Its format depends on the network service that authorization object is associated with. For authorizing based on TLS x509 certificates, the identity must be the x509 distinguished name. Since 4.0
MIGRATION
MigrationStats (Object) Detailed migration status. Members transferred: int amount of bytes already transferred to the target VM remaining: int amount of bytes remaining to be transferred to the target VM total: int total amount of bytes involved in the migration process duplicate: int number of duplicate (zero) pages (since 1.2) skipped: int number of skipped zero pages (since 1.5) normal: int number of normal pages (since 1.2) normal-bytes: int number of normal bytes sent (since 1.2) dirty-pages-rate: int number of pages dirtied by second by the guest (since 1.3) mbps: number throughput in megabits/sec. (since 1.6) dirty-sync-count: int number of times that dirty ram was synchronized (since 2.1) postcopy-requests: int The number of page requests received from the destination (since 2.7) page-size: int The number of bytes per page for the various page-based statistics (since 2.10) multifd-bytes: int The number of bytes sent through multifd (since 3.0) pages-per-second: int the number of memory pages transferred per second (Since 4.0) Since 0.14 XBZRLECacheStats (Object) Detailed XBZRLE migration cache statistics Members cache-size: int XBZRLE cache size bytes: int amount of bytes already transferred to the target VM pages: int amount of pages transferred to the target VM cache-miss: int number of cache miss cache-miss-rate: number rate of cache miss (since 2.1) encoding-rate: number rate of encoded bytes (since 5.1) overflow: int number of overflows Since 1.2 CompressionStats (Object) Detailed migration compression statistics Members pages: int amount of pages compressed and transferred to the target VM busy: int count of times that no free thread was available to compress data busy-rate: number rate of thread busy compressed-size: int amount of bytes after compression compression-rate: number rate of compressed size Since 3.1 MigrationStatus (Enum) An enumeration of migration status. Values none no migration has ever happened. setup migration process has been initiated. cancelling in the process of cancelling migration. cancelled cancelling migration is finished. active in the process of doing migration. postcopy-active like active, but now in postcopy mode. (since 2.5) postcopy-paused during postcopy but paused. (since 3.0) postcopy-recover trying to recover from a paused postcopy. (since 3.0) completed migration is finished. failed some error occurred during migration process. colo VM is in the process of fault tolerance, VM can not get into this state unless colo capability is enabled for migration. (since 2.8) pre-switchover Paused before device serialisation. (since 2.11) device During device serialisation when pause-before-switchover is enabled (since 2.11) wait-unplug wait for device unplug request by guest OS to be completed. (since 4.2) Since 2.3 VfioStats (Object) Detailed VFIO devices migration statistics Members transferred: int amount of bytes transferred to the target VM by VFIO devices Since 5.2 MigrationInfo (Object) Information about current migration process. Members status: MigrationStatus (optional) MigrationStatus describing the current migration status. If this field is not returned, no migration process has been initiated ram: MigrationStats (optional) MigrationStats containing detailed migration status, only returned if status is 'active' or 'completed'(since 1.2) disk: MigrationStats (optional) MigrationStats containing detailed disk migration status, only returned if status is 'active' and it is a block migration xbzrle-cache: XBZRLECacheStats (optional) XBZRLECacheStats containing detailed XBZRLE migration statistics, only returned if XBZRLE feature is on and status is 'active' or 'completed' (since 1.2) total-time: int (optional) total amount of milliseconds since migration started. If migration has ended, it returns the total migration time. (since 1.2) downtime: int (optional) only present when migration finishes correctly total downtime in milliseconds for the guest. (since 1.3) expected-downtime: int (optional) only present while migration is active expected downtime in milliseconds for the guest in last walk of the dirty bitmap. (since 1.3) setup-time: int (optional) amount of setup time in milliseconds before the iterations begin but after the QMP command is issued. This is designed to provide an accounting of any activities (such as RDMA pinning) which may be expensive, but do not actually occur during the iterative migration rounds themselves. (since 1.6) cpu-throttle-percentage: int (optional) percentage of time guest cpus are being throttled during auto-converge. This is only present when auto-converge has started throttling guest cpus. (Since 2.7) error-desc: string (optional) the human readable error description string, when status is 'failed'. Clients should not attempt to parse the error strings. (Since 2.7) postcopy-blocktime: int (optional) total time when all vCPU were blocked during postcopy live migration. This is only present when the postcopy-blocktime migration capability is enabled. (Since 3.0) postcopy-vcpu-blocktime: array of int (optional) list of the postcopy blocktime per vCPU. This is only present when the postcopy-blocktime migration capability is enabled. (Since 3.0) compression: CompressionStats (optional) migration compression statistics, only returned if compression feature is on and status is 'active' or 'completed' (Since 3.1) socket-address: array of SocketAddress (optional) Only used for tcp, to know what the real port is (Since 4.0) vfio: VfioStats (optional) VfioStats containing detailed VFIO devices migration statistics, only returned if VFIO device is present, migration is supported by all VFIO devices and status is 'active' or 'completed' (since 5.2) blocked-reasons: array of string (optional) A list of reasons an outgoing migration is blocked. Present and non-empty when migration is blocked. (since 6.0) Since 0.14 query-migrate (Command) Returns information about current migration process. If migration is active there will be another json-object with RAM migration status and if block migration is active another one with block migration status. Returns MigrationInfo Since 0.14 Example 1. Before the first migration -> { "execute": "query-migrate" } <- { "return": {} } 2. Migration is done and has succeeded -> { "execute": "query-migrate" } <- { "return": { "status": "completed", "total-time":12345, "setup-time":12345, "downtime":12345, "ram":{ "transferred":123, "remaining":123, "total":246, "duplicate":123, "normal":123, "normal-bytes":123456, "dirty-sync-count":15 } } } 3. Migration is done and has failed -> { "execute": "query-migrate" } <- { "return": { "status": "failed" } } 4. Migration is being performed and is not a block migration: -> { "execute": "query-migrate" } <- { "return":{ "status":"active", "total-time":12345, "setup-time":12345, "expected-downtime":12345, "ram":{ "transferred":123, "remaining":123, "total":246, "duplicate":123, "normal":123, "normal-bytes":123456, "dirty-sync-count":15 } } } 5. Migration is being performed and is a block migration: -> { "execute": "query-migrate" } <- { "return":{ "status":"active", "total-time":12345, "setup-time":12345, "expected-downtime":12345, "ram":{ "total":1057024, "remaining":1053304, "transferred":3720, "duplicate":123, "normal":123, "normal-bytes":123456, "dirty-sync-count":15 }, "disk":{ "total":20971520, "remaining":20880384, "transferred":91136 } } } 6. Migration is being performed and XBZRLE is active: -> { "execute": "query-migrate" } <- { "return":{ "status":"active", "total-time":12345, "setup-time":12345, "expected-downtime":12345, "ram":{ "total":1057024, "remaining":1053304, "transferred":3720, "duplicate":10, "normal":3333, "normal-bytes":3412992, "dirty-sync-count":15 }, "xbzrle-cache":{ "cache-size":67108864, "bytes":20971520, "pages":2444343, "cache-miss":2244, "cache-miss-rate":0.123, "encoding-rate":80.1, "overflow":34434 } } } MigrationCapability (Enum) Migration capabilities enumeration Values xbzrle Migration supports xbzrle (Xor Based Zero Run Length Encoding). This feature allows us to minimize migration traffic for certain work loads, by sending compressed difference of the pages rdma-pin-all Controls whether or not the entire VM memory footprint is mlock()'d on demand or all at once. Refer to docs/rdma.txt for usage. Disabled by default. (since 2.0) zero-blocks During storage migration encode blocks of zeroes efficiently. This essentially saves 1MB of zeroes per block on the wire. Enabling requires source and target VM to support this feature. To enable it is sufficient to enable the capability on the source VM. The feature is disabled by default. (since 1.6) compress Use multiple compression threads to accelerate live migration. This feature can help to reduce the migration traffic, by sending compressed pages. Please note that if compress and xbzrle are both on, compress only takes effect in the ram bulk stage, after that, it will be disabled and only xbzrle takes effect, this can help to minimize migration traffic. The feature is disabled by default. (since 2.4 ) events generate events for each migration state change (since 2.4 ) auto-converge If enabled, QEMU will automatically throttle down the guest to speed up convergence of RAM migration. (since 1.6) postcopy-ram Start executing on the migration target before all of RAM has been migrated, pulling the remaining pages along as needed. The capacity must have the same setting on both source and target or migration will not even start. NOTE: If the migration fails during postcopy the VM will fail. (since 2.6) x-colo If enabled, migration will never end, and the state of the VM on the primary side will be migrated continuously to the VM on secondary side, this process is called COarse-Grain LOck Stepping (COLO) for Non-stop Service. (since 2.8) release-ram if enabled, qemu will free the migrated ram pages on the source during postcopy-ram migration. (since 2.9) block If enabled, QEMU will also migrate the contents of all block devices. Default is disabled. A possible alternative uses mirror jobs to a builtin NBD server on the destination, which offers more flexibility. (Since 2.10) return-path If enabled, migration will use the return path even for precopy. (since 2.10) pause-before-switchover Pause outgoing migration before serialising device state and before disabling block IO (since 2.11) multifd Use more than one fd for migration (since 4.0) dirty-bitmaps If enabled, QEMU will migrate named dirty bitmaps. (since 2.12) postcopy-blocktime Calculate downtime for postcopy live migration (since 3.0) late-block-activate If enabled, the destination will not activate block devices (and thus take locks) immediately at the end of migration. (since 3.0) x-ignore-shared If enabled, QEMU will not migrate shared memory (since 4.0) validate-uuid Send the UUID of the source to allow the destination to ensure it is the same. (since 4.2) background-snapshot If enabled, the migration stream will be a snapshot of the VM exactly at the point when the migration procedure starts. The VM RAM is saved with running VM. (since 6.0) Features unstable Members x-colo and x-ignore-shared are experimental. Since 1.2 MigrationCapabilityStatus (Object) Migration capability information Members capability: MigrationCapability capability enum state: boolean capability state bool Since 1.2 migrate-set-capabilities (Command) Enable/Disable the following migration capabilities (like xbzrle) Arguments capabilities: array of MigrationCapabilityStatus json array of capability modifications to make Since 1.2 Example -> { "execute": "migrate-set-capabilities" , "arguments": { "capabilities": [ { "capability": "xbzrle", "state": true } ] } } query-migrate-capabilities (Command) Returns information about the current migration capabilities status Returns MigrationCapabilitiesStatus Since 1.2 Example -> { "execute": "query-migrate-capabilities" } <- { "return": [ {"state": false, "capability": "xbzrle"}, {"state": false, "capability": "rdma-pin-all"}, {"state": false, "capability": "auto-converge"}, {"state": false, "capability": "zero-blocks"}, {"state": false, "capability": "compress"}, {"state": true, "capability": "events"}, {"state": false, "capability": "postcopy-ram"}, {"state": false, "capability": "x-colo"} ]} MultiFDCompression (Enum) An enumeration of multifd compression methods. Values none no compression. zlib use zlib compression method. zstd (If: CONFIG_ZSTD) use zstd compression method. Since 5.0 BitmapMigrationBitmapAliasTransform (Object) Members persistent: boolean (optional) If present, the bitmap will be made persistent or transient depending on this parameter. Since 6.0 BitmapMigrationBitmapAlias (Object) Members name: string The name of the bitmap. alias: string An alias name for migration (for example the bitmap name on the opposite site). transform: BitmapMigrationBitmapAliasTransform (optional) Allows the modification of the migrated bitmap. (since 6.0) Since 5.2 BitmapMigrationNodeAlias (Object) Maps a block node name and the bitmaps it has to aliases for dirty bitmap migration. Members node-name: string A block node name. alias: string An alias block node name for migration (for example the node name on the opposite site). bitmaps: array of BitmapMigrationBitmapAlias Mappings for the bitmaps on this node. Since 5.2 MigrationParameter (Enum) Migration parameters enumeration Values announce-initial Initial delay (in milliseconds) before sending the first announce (Since 4.0) announce-max Maximum delay (in milliseconds) between packets in the announcement (Since 4.0) announce-rounds Number of self-announce packets sent after migration (Since 4.0) announce-step Increase in delay (in milliseconds) between subsequent packets in the announcement (Since 4.0) compress-level Set the compression level to be used in live migration, the compression level is an integer between 0 and 9, where 0 means no compression, 1 means the best compression speed, and 9 means best compression ratio which will consume more CPU. compress-threads Set compression thread count to be used in live migration, the compression thread count is an integer between 1 and 255. compress-wait-thread Controls behavior when all compression threads are currently busy. If true (default), wait for a free compression thread to become available; otherwise, send the page uncompressed. (Since 3.1) decompress-threads Set decompression thread count to be used in live migration, the decompression thread count is an integer between 1 and 255. Usually, decompression is at least 4 times as fast as compression, so set the decompress-threads to the number about 1/4 of compress-threads is adequate. throttle-trigger-threshold The ratio of bytes_dirty_period and bytes_xfer_period to trigger throttling. It is expressed as percentage. The default value is 50. (Since 5.0) cpu-throttle-initial Initial percentage of time guest cpus are throttled when migration auto-converge is activated. The default value is 20. (Since 2.7) cpu-throttle-increment throttle percentage increase each time auto-converge detects that migration is not making progress. The default value is 10. (Since 2.7) cpu-throttle-tailslow Make CPU throttling slower at tail stage At the tail stage of throttling, the Guest is very sensitive to CPU percentage while the cpu-throttle -increment is excessive usually at tail stage. If this parameter is true, we will compute the ideal CPU percentage used by the Guest, which may exactly make the dirty rate match the dirty rate threshold. Then we will choose a smaller throttle increment between the one specified by cpu-throttle-increment and the one generated by ideal CPU percentage. Therefore, it is compatible to traditional throttling, meanwhile the throttle increment won't be excessive at tail stage. The default value is false. (Since 5.1) tls-creds ID of the 'tls-creds' object that provides credentials for establishing a TLS connection over the migration data channel. On the outgoing side of the migration, the credentials must be for a 'client' endpoint, while for the incoming side the credentials must be for a 'server' endpoint. Setting this will enable TLS for all migrations. The default is unset, resulting in unsecured migration at the QEMU level. (Since 2.7) tls-hostname hostname of the target host for the migration. This is required when using x509 based TLS credentials and the migration URI does not already include a hostname. For example if using fd: or exec: based migration, the hostname must be provided so that the server's x509 certificate identity can be validated. (Since 2.7) tls-authz ID of the 'authz' object subclass that provides access control checking of the TLS x509 certificate distinguished name. This object is only resolved at time of use, so can be deleted and recreated on the fly while the migration server is active. If missing, it will default to denying access (Since 4.0) max-bandwidth to set maximum speed for migration. maximum speed in bytes per second. (Since 2.8) downtime-limit set maximum tolerated downtime for migration. maximum downtime in milliseconds (Since 2.8) x-checkpoint-delay The delay time (in ms) between two COLO checkpoints in periodic mode. (Since 2.8) block-incremental Affects how much storage is migrated when the block migration capability is enabled. When false, the entire storage backing chain is migrated into a flattened image at the destination; when true, only the active qcow2 layer is migrated and the destination must already have access to the same backing chain as was used on the source. (since 2.10) multifd-channels Number of channels used to migrate data in parallel. This is the same number that the number of sockets used for migration. The default value is 2 (since 4.0) xbzrle-cache-size cache size to be used by XBZRLE migration. It needs to be a multiple of the target page size and a power of 2 (Since 2.11) max-postcopy-bandwidth Background transfer bandwidth during postcopy. Defaults to 0 (unlimited). In bytes per second. (Since 3.0) max-cpu-throttle maximum cpu throttle percentage. Defaults to 99. (Since 3.1) multifd-compression Which compression method to use. Defaults to none. (Since 5.0) multifd-zlib-level Set the compression level to be used in live migration, the compression level is an integer between 0 and 9, where 0 means no compression, 1 means the best compression speed, and 9 means best compression ratio which will consume more CPU. Defaults to 1. (Since 5.0) multifd-zstd-level Set the compression level to be used in live migration, the compression level is an integer between 0 and 20, where 0 means no compression, 1 means the best compression speed, and 20 means best compression ratio which will consume more CPU. Defaults to 1. (Since 5.0) block-bitmap-mapping Maps block nodes and bitmaps on them to aliases for the purpose of dirty bitmap migration. Such aliases may for example be the corresponding names on the opposite site. The mapping must be one-to-one, but not necessarily complete: On the source, unmapped bitmaps and all bitmaps on unmapped nodes will be ignored. On the destination, encountering an unmapped alias in the incoming migration stream will result in a report, and all further bitmap migration data will then be discarded. Note that the destination does not know about bitmaps it does not receive, so there is no limitation or requirement regarding the number of bitmaps received, or how they are named, or on which nodes they are placed. By default (when this parameter has never been set), bitmap names are mapped to themselves. Nodes are mapped to their block device name if there is one, and to their node name otherwise. (Since 5.2) Features unstable Member x-checkpoint-delay is experimental. Since 2.4 MigrateSetParameters (Object) Members announce-initial: int (optional) Initial delay (in milliseconds) before sending the first announce (Since 4.0) announce-max: int (optional) Maximum delay (in milliseconds) between packets in the announcement (Since 4.0) announce-rounds: int (optional) Number of self-announce packets sent after migration (Since 4.0) announce-step: int (optional) Increase in delay (in milliseconds) between subsequent packets in the announcement (Since 4.0) compress-level: int (optional) compression level compress-threads: int (optional) compression thread count compress-wait-thread: boolean (optional) Controls behavior when all compression threads are currently busy. If true (default), wait for a free compression thread to become available; otherwise, send the page uncompressed. (Since 3.1) decompress-threads: int (optional) decompression thread count throttle-trigger-threshold: int (optional) The ratio of bytes_dirty_period and bytes_xfer_period to trigger throttling. It is expressed as percentage. The default value is 50. (Since 5.0) cpu-throttle-initial: int (optional) Initial percentage of time guest cpus are throttled when migration auto-converge is activated. The default value is 20. (Since 2.7) cpu-throttle-increment: int (optional) throttle percentage increase each time auto-converge detects that migration is not making progress. The default value is 10. (Since 2.7) cpu-throttle-tailslow: boolean (optional) Make CPU throttling slower at tail stage At the tail stage of throttling, the Guest is very sensitive to CPU percentage while the cpu-throttle -increment is excessive usually at tail stage. If this parameter is true, we will compute the ideal CPU percentage used by the Guest, which may exactly make the dirty rate match the dirty rate threshold. Then we will choose a smaller throttle increment between the one specified by cpu-throttle-increment and the one generated by ideal CPU percentage. Therefore, it is compatible to traditional throttling, meanwhile the throttle increment won't be excessive at tail stage. The default value is false. (Since 5.1) tls-creds: StrOrNull (optional) ID of the 'tls-creds' object that provides credentials for establishing a TLS connection over the migration data channel. On the outgoing side of the migration, the credentials must be for a 'client' endpoint, while for the incoming side the credentials must be for a 'server' endpoint. Setting this to a non-empty string enables TLS for all migrations. An empty string means that QEMU will use plain text mode for migration, rather than TLS (Since 2.9) Previously (since 2.7), this was reported by omitting tls-creds instead. tls-hostname: StrOrNull (optional) hostname of the target host for the migration. This is required when using x509 based TLS credentials and the migration URI does not already include a hostname. For example if using fd: or exec: based migration, the hostname must be provided so that the server's x509 certificate identity can be validated. (Since 2.7) An empty string means that QEMU will use the hostname associated with the migration URI, if any. (Since 2.9) Previously (since 2.7), this was reported by omitting tls-hostname instead. max-bandwidth: int (optional) to set maximum speed for migration. maximum speed in bytes per second. (Since 2.8) downtime-limit: int (optional) set maximum tolerated downtime for migration. maximum downtime in milliseconds (Since 2.8) x-checkpoint-delay: int (optional) the delay time between two COLO checkpoints. (Since 2.8) block-incremental: boolean (optional) Affects how much storage is migrated when the block migration capability is enabled. When false, the entire storage backing chain is migrated into a flattened image at the destination; when true, only the active qcow2 layer is migrated and the destination must already have access to the same backing chain as was used on the source. (since 2.10) multifd-channels: int (optional) Number of channels used to migrate data in parallel. This is the same number that the number of sockets used for migration. The default value is 2 (since 4.0) xbzrle-cache-size: int (optional) cache size to be used by XBZRLE migration. It needs to be a multiple of the target page size and a power of 2 (Since 2.11) max-postcopy-bandwidth: int (optional) Background transfer bandwidth during postcopy. Defaults to 0 (unlimited). In bytes per second. (Since 3.0) max-cpu-throttle: int (optional) maximum cpu throttle percentage. The default value is 99. (Since 3.1) multifd-compression: MultiFDCompression (optional) Which compression method to use. Defaults to none. (Since 5.0) multifd-zlib-level: int (optional) Set the compression level to be used in live migration, the compression level is an integer between 0 and 9, where 0 means no compression, 1 means the best compression speed, and 9 means best compression ratio which will consume more CPU. Defaults to 1. (Since 5.0) multifd-zstd-level: int (optional) Set the compression level to be used in live migration, the compression level is an integer between 0 and 20, where 0 means no compression, 1 means the best compression speed, and 20 means best compression ratio which will consume more CPU. Defaults to 1. (Since 5.0) block-bitmap-mapping: array of BitmapMigrationNodeAlias (optional) Maps block nodes and bitmaps on them to aliases for the purpose of dirty bitmap migration. Such aliases may for example be the corresponding names on the opposite site. The mapping must be one-to-one, but not necessarily complete: On the source, unmapped bitmaps and all bitmaps on unmapped nodes will be ignored. On the destination, encountering an unmapped alias in the incoming migration stream will result in a report, and all further bitmap migration data will then be discarded. Note that the destination does not know about bitmaps it does not receive, so there is no limitation or requirement regarding the number of bitmaps received, or how they are named, or on which nodes they are placed. By default (when this parameter has never been set), bitmap names are mapped to themselves. Nodes are mapped to their block device name if there is one, and to their node name otherwise. (Since 5.2) tls-authz: StrOrNull (optional) Not documented Features unstable Member x-checkpoint-delay is experimental. Since 2.4 migrate-set-parameters (Command) Set various migration parameters. Arguments The members of MigrateSetParameters Since 2.4 Example -> { "execute": "migrate-set-parameters" , "arguments": { "compress-level": 1 } } MigrationParameters (Object) The optional members aren't actually optional. Members announce-initial: int (optional) Initial delay (in milliseconds) before sending the first announce (Since 4.0) announce-max: int (optional) Maximum delay (in milliseconds) between packets in the announcement (Since 4.0) announce-rounds: int (optional) Number of self-announce packets sent after migration (Since 4.0) announce-step: int (optional) Increase in delay (in milliseconds) between subsequent packets in the announcement (Since 4.0) compress-level: int (optional) compression level compress-threads: int (optional) compression thread count compress-wait-thread: boolean (optional) Controls behavior when all compression threads are currently busy. If true (default), wait for a free compression thread to become available; otherwise, send the page uncompressed. (Since 3.1) decompress-threads: int (optional) decompression thread count throttle-trigger-threshold: int (optional) The ratio of bytes_dirty_period and bytes_xfer_period to trigger throttling. It is expressed as percentage. The default value is 50. (Since 5.0) cpu-throttle-initial: int (optional) Initial percentage of time guest cpus are throttled when migration auto-converge is activated. (Since 2.7) cpu-throttle-increment: int (optional) throttle percentage increase each time auto-converge detects that migration is not making progress. (Since 2.7) cpu-throttle-tailslow: boolean (optional) Make CPU throttling slower at tail stage At the tail stage of throttling, the Guest is very sensitive to CPU percentage while the cpu-throttle -increment is excessive usually at tail stage. If this parameter is true, we will compute the ideal CPU percentage used by the Guest, which may exactly make the dirty rate match the dirty rate threshold. Then we will choose a smaller throttle increment between the one specified by cpu-throttle-increment and the one generated by ideal CPU percentage. Therefore, it is compatible to traditional throttling, meanwhile the throttle increment won't be excessive at tail stage. The default value is false. (Since 5.1) tls-creds: string (optional) ID of the 'tls-creds' object that provides credentials for establishing a TLS connection over the migration data channel. On the outgoing side of the migration, the credentials must be for a 'client' endpoint, while for the incoming side the credentials must be for a 'server' endpoint. An empty string means that QEMU will use plain text mode for migration, rather than TLS (Since 2.7) Note: 2.8 reports this by omitting tls-creds instead. tls-hostname: string (optional) hostname of the target host for the migration. This is required when using x509 based TLS credentials and the migration URI does not already include a hostname. For example if using fd: or exec: based migration, the hostname must be provided so that the server's x509 certificate identity can be validated. (Since 2.7) An empty string means that QEMU will use the hostname associated with the migration URI, if any. (Since 2.9) Note: 2.8 reports this by omitting tls-hostname instead. tls-authz: string (optional) ID of the 'authz' object subclass that provides access control checking of the TLS x509 certificate distinguished name. (Since 4.0) max-bandwidth: int (optional) to set maximum speed for migration. maximum speed in bytes per second. (Since 2.8) downtime-limit: int (optional) set maximum tolerated downtime for migration. maximum downtime in milliseconds (Since 2.8) x-checkpoint-delay: int (optional) the delay time between two COLO checkpoints. (Since 2.8) block-incremental: boolean (optional) Affects how much storage is migrated when the block migration capability is enabled. When false, the entire storage backing chain is migrated into a flattened image at the destination; when true, only the active qcow2 layer is migrated and the destination must already have access to the same backing chain as was used on the source. (since 2.10) multifd-channels: int (optional) Number of channels used to migrate data in parallel. This is the same number that the number of sockets used for migration. The default value is 2 (since 4.0) xbzrle-cache-size: int (optional) cache size to be used by XBZRLE migration. It needs to be a multiple of the target page size and a power of 2 (Since 2.11) max-postcopy-bandwidth: int (optional) Background transfer bandwidth during postcopy. Defaults to 0 (unlimited). In bytes per second. (Since 3.0) max-cpu-throttle: int (optional) maximum cpu throttle percentage. Defaults to 99. (Since 3.1) multifd-compression: MultiFDCompression (optional) Which compression method to use. Defaults to none. (Since 5.0) multifd-zlib-level: int (optional) Set the compression level to be used in live migration, the compression level is an integer between 0 and 9, where 0 means no compression, 1 means the best compression speed, and 9 means best compression ratio which will consume more CPU. Defaults to 1. (Since 5.0) multifd-zstd-level: int (optional) Set the compression level to be used in live migration, the compression level is an integer between 0 and 20, where 0 means no compression, 1 means the best compression speed, and 20 means best compression ratio which will consume more CPU. Defaults to 1. (Since 5.0) block-bitmap-mapping: array of BitmapMigrationNodeAlias (optional) Maps block nodes and bitmaps on them to aliases for the purpose of dirty bitmap migration. Such aliases may for example be the corresponding names on the opposite site. The mapping must be one-to-one, but not necessarily complete: On the source, unmapped bitmaps and all bitmaps on unmapped nodes will be ignored. On the destination, encountering an unmapped alias in the incoming migration stream will result in a report, and all further bitmap migration data will then be discarded. Note that the destination does not know about bitmaps it does not receive, so there is no limitation or requirement regarding the number of bitmaps received, or how they are named, or on which nodes they are placed. By default (when this parameter has never been set), bitmap names are mapped to themselves. Nodes are mapped to their block device name if there is one, and to their node name otherwise. (Since 5.2) Features unstable Member x-checkpoint-delay is experimental. Since 2.4 query-migrate-parameters (Command) Returns information about the current migration parameters Returns MigrationParameters Since 2.4 Example -> { "execute": "query-migrate-parameters" } <- { "return": { "decompress-threads": 2, "cpu-throttle-increment": 10, "compress-threads": 8, "compress-level": 1, "cpu-throttle-initial": 20, "max-bandwidth": 33554432, "downtime-limit": 300 } } client_migrate_info (Command) Set migration information for remote display. This makes the server ask the client to automatically reconnect using the new parameters once migration finished successfully. Only implemented for SPICE. Arguments protocol: string must be "spice" hostname: string migration target hostname port: int (optional) spice tcp port for plaintext channels tls-port: int (optional) spice tcp port for tls-secured channels cert-subject: string (optional) server certificate subject Since 0.14 Example -> { "execute": "client_migrate_info", "arguments": { "protocol": "spice", "hostname": "virt42.lab.kraxel.org", "port": 1234 } } <- { "return": {} } migrate-start-postcopy (Command) Followup to a migration command to switch the migration to postcopy mode. The postcopy-ram capability must be set on both source and destination before the original migration command. Since 2.5 Example -> { "execute": "migrate-start-postcopy" } <- { "return": {} } MIGRATION (Event) Emitted when a migration event happens Arguments status: MigrationStatus MigrationStatus describing the current migration status. Since 2.4 Example <- {"timestamp": {"seconds": 1432121972, "microseconds": 744001}, "event": "MIGRATION", "data": {"status": "completed"} } MIGRATION_PASS (Event) Emitted from the source side of a migration at the start of each pass (when it syncs the dirty bitmap) Arguments pass: int An incrementing count (starting at 1 on the first pass) Since 2.6 Example { "timestamp": {"seconds": 1449669631, "microseconds": 239225}, "event": "MIGRATION_PASS", "data": {"pass": 2} } COLOMessage (Enum) The message transmission between Primary side and Secondary side. Values checkpoint-ready Secondary VM (SVM) is ready for checkpointing checkpoint-request Primary VM (PVM) tells SVM to prepare for checkpointing checkpoint-reply SVM gets PVM's checkpoint request vmstate-send VM's state will be sent by PVM. vmstate-size The total size of VMstate. vmstate-received VM's state has been received by SVM. vmstate-loaded VM's state has been loaded by SVM. Since 2.8 COLOMode (Enum) The COLO current mode. Values none COLO is disabled. primary COLO node in primary side. secondary COLO node in slave side. Since 2.8 FailoverStatus (Enum) An enumeration of COLO failover status Values none no failover has ever happened require got failover requirement but not handled active in the process of doing failover completed finish the process of failover relaunch restart the failover process, from 'none' -> 'completed' (Since 2.9) Since 2.8 COLO_EXIT (Event) Emitted when VM finishes COLO mode due to some errors happening or at the request of users. Arguments mode: COLOMode report COLO mode when COLO exited. reason: COLOExitReason describes the reason for the COLO exit. Since 3.1 Example <- { "timestamp": {"seconds": 2032141960, "microseconds": 417172}, "event": "COLO_EXIT", "data": {"mode": "primary", "reason": "request" } } COLOExitReason (Enum) The reason for a COLO exit. Values none failover has never happened. This state does not occur in the COLO_EXIT event, and is only visible in the result of query-colo-status. request COLO exit is due to an external request. error COLO exit is due to an internal error. processing COLO is currently handling a failover (since 4.0). Since 3.1 x-colo-lost-heartbeat (Command) Tell qemu that heartbeat is lost, request it to do takeover procedures. If this command is sent to the PVM, the Primary side will exit COLO mode. If sent to the Secondary, the Secondary side will run failover work, then takes over server operation to become the service VM. Features unstable This command is experimental. Since 2.8 Example -> { "execute": "x-colo-lost-heartbeat" } <- { "return": {} } migrate_cancel (Command) Cancel the current executing migration process. Returns nothing on success Notes This command succeeds even if there is no migration process running. Since 0.14 Example -> { "execute": "migrate_cancel" } <- { "return": {} } migrate-continue (Command) Continue migration when it's in a paused state. Arguments state: MigrationStatus The state the migration is currently expected to be in Returns nothing on success Since 2.11 Example -> { "execute": "migrate-continue" , "arguments": { "state": "pre-switchover" } } <- { "return": {} } migrate (Command) Migrates the current running guest to another Virtual Machine. Arguments uri: string the Uniform Resource Identifier of the destination VM blk: boolean (optional) do block migration (full disk copy) inc: boolean (optional) incremental disk copy migration detach: boolean (optional) this argument exists only for compatibility reasons and is ignored by QEMU resume: boolean (optional) resume one paused migration, default "off". (since 3.0) Returns nothing on success Since 0.14 Notes 1. The 'query-migrate' command should be used to check migration's progress and final result (this information is provided by the 'status' member) 2. All boolean arguments default to false 3. The user Monitor's "detach" argument is invalid in QMP and should not be used Example -> { "execute": "migrate", "arguments": { "uri": "tcp:0:4446" } } <- { "return": {} } migrate-incoming (Command) Start an incoming migration, the qemu must have been started with -incoming defer Arguments uri: string The Uniform Resource Identifier identifying the source or address to listen on Returns nothing on success Since 2.3 Notes 1. It's a bad idea to use a string for the uri, but it needs to stay compatible with -incoming and the format of the uri is already exposed above libvirt. 2. QEMU must be started with -incoming defer to allow migrate-incoming to be used. 3. The uri format is the same as for -incoming Example -> { "execute": "migrate-incoming", "arguments": { "uri": "tcp::4446" } } <- { "return": {} } xen-save-devices-state (Command) Save the state of all devices to file. The RAM and the block devices of the VM are not saved by this command. Arguments filename: string the file to save the state of the devices to as binary data. See xen-save-devices-state.txt for a description of the binary format. live: boolean (optional) Optional argument to ask QEMU to treat this command as part of a live migration. Default to true. (since 2.11) Returns Nothing on success Since 1.1 Example -> { "execute": "xen-save-devices-state", "arguments": { "filename": "/tmp/save" } } <- { "return": {} } xen-set-global-dirty-log (Command) Enable or disable the global dirty log mode. Arguments enable: boolean true to enable, false to disable. Returns nothing Since 1.3 Example -> { "execute": "xen-set-global-dirty-log", "arguments": { "enable": true } } <- { "return": {} } xen-load-devices-state (Command) Load the state of all devices from file. The RAM and the block devices of the VM are not loaded by this command. Arguments filename: string the file to load the state of the devices from as binary data. See xen-save-devices-state.txt for a description of the binary format. Since 2.7 Example -> { "execute": "xen-load-devices-state", "arguments": { "filename": "/tmp/resume" } } <- { "return": {} } xen-set-replication (Command) Enable or disable replication. Arguments enable: boolean true to enable, false to disable. primary: boolean true for primary or false for secondary. failover: boolean (optional) true to do failover, false to stop. but cannot be specified if 'enable' is true. default value is false. Returns nothing. Example -> { "execute": "xen-set-replication", "arguments": {"enable": true, "primary": false} } <- { "return": {} } Since 2.9 If CONFIG_REPLICATION ReplicationStatus (Object) The result format for 'query-xen-replication-status'. Members error: boolean true if an error happened, false if replication is normal. desc: string (optional) the human readable error description string, when error is 'true'. Since 2.9 If CONFIG_REPLICATION query-xen-replication-status (Command) Query replication status while the vm is running. Returns A ReplicationResult object showing the status. Example -> { "execute": "query-xen-replication-status" } <- { "return": { "error": false } } Since 2.9 If CONFIG_REPLICATION xen-colo-do-checkpoint (Command) Xen uses this command to notify replication to trigger a checkpoint. Returns nothing. Example -> { "execute": "xen-colo-do-checkpoint" } <- { "return": {} } Since 2.9 If CONFIG_REPLICATION COLOStatus (Object) The result format for 'query-colo-status'. Members mode: COLOMode COLO running mode. If COLO is running, this field will return 'primary' or 'secondary'. last-mode: COLOMode COLO last running mode. If COLO is running, this field will return same like mode field, after failover we can use this field to get last colo mode. (since 4.0) reason: COLOExitReason describes the reason for the COLO exit. Since 3.1 query-colo-status (Command) Query COLO status while the vm is running. Returns A COLOStatus object showing the status. Example -> { "execute": "query-colo-status" } <- { "return": { "mode": "primary", "reason": "request" } } Since 3.1 migrate-recover (Command) Provide a recovery migration stream URI. Arguments uri: string the URI to be used for the recovery of migration stream. Returns nothing. Example -> { "execute": "migrate-recover", "arguments": { "uri": "tcp:192.168.1.200:12345" } } <- { "return": {} } Since 3.0 migrate-pause (Command) Pause a migration. Currently it only supports postcopy. Returns nothing. Example -> { "execute": "migrate-pause" } <- { "return": {} } Since 3.0 UNPLUG_PRIMARY (Event) Emitted from source side of a migration when migration state is WAIT_UNPLUG. Device was unplugged by guest operating system. Device resources in QEMU are kept on standby to be able to re-plug it in case of migration failure. Arguments device-id: string QEMU device id of the unplugged device Since 4.2 Example {"event": "UNPLUG_PRIMARY", "data": {"device-id": "hostdev0"} } DirtyRateVcpu (Object) Dirty rate of vcpu. Members id: int vcpu index. dirty-rate: int dirty rate. Since 6.2 DirtyRateStatus (Enum) An enumeration of dirtyrate status. Values unstarted the dirtyrate thread has not been started. measuring the dirtyrate thread is measuring. measured the dirtyrate thread has measured and results are available. Since 5.2 DirtyRateMeasureMode (Enum) An enumeration of mode of measuring dirtyrate. Values page-sampling calculate dirtyrate by sampling pages. dirty-ring calculate dirtyrate by dirty ring. dirty-bitmap calculate dirtyrate by dirty bitmap. Since 6.2 DirtyRateInfo (Object) Information about current dirty page rate of vm. Members dirty-rate: int (optional) an estimate of the dirty page rate of the VM in units of MB/s, present only when estimating the rate has completed. status: DirtyRateStatus status containing dirtyrate query status includes 'unstarted' or 'measuring' or 'measured' start-time: int start time in units of second for calculation calc-time: int time in units of second for sample dirty pages sample-pages: int page count per GB for sample dirty pages the default value is 512 (since 6.1) mode: DirtyRateMeasureMode mode containing method of calculate dirtyrate includes 'page-sampling' and 'dirty-ring' (Since 6.2) vcpu-dirty-rate: array of DirtyRateVcpu (optional) dirtyrate for each vcpu if dirty-ring mode specified (Since 6.2) Since 5.2 calc-dirty-rate (Command) start calculating dirty page rate for vm Arguments calc-time: int time in units of second for sample dirty pages sample-pages: int (optional) page count per GB for sample dirty pages the default value is 512 (since 6.1) mode: DirtyRateMeasureMode (optional) mechanism of calculating dirtyrate includes 'page-sampling' and 'dirty-ring' (Since 6.1) Since 5.2 Example {"command": "calc-dirty-rate", "data": {"calc-time": 1, 'sample-pages': 512} } query-dirty-rate (Command) query dirty page rate in units of MB/s for vm Since 5.2 snapshot-save (Command) Save a VM snapshot Arguments job-id: string identifier for the newly created job tag: string name of the snapshot to create vmstate: string block device node name to save vmstate to devices: array of string list of block device node names to save a snapshot to Applications should not assume that the snapshot save is complete when this command returns. The job commands / events must be used to determine completion and to fetch details of any errors that arise. Note that execution of the guest CPUs may be stopped during the time it takes to save the snapshot. A future version of QEMU may ensure CPUs are executing continuously. It is strongly recommended that devices contain all writable block device nodes if a consistent snapshot is required. If tag already exists, an error will be reported Returns nothing Example -> { "execute": "snapshot-save", "data": { "job-id": "snapsave0", "tag": "my-snap", "vmstate": "disk0", "devices": ["disk0", "disk1"] } } <- { "return": { } } <- {"event": "JOB_STATUS_CHANGE", "data": {"status": "created", "id": "snapsave0"}} <- {"event": "JOB_STATUS_CHANGE", "data": {"status": "running", "id": "snapsave0"}} <- {"event": "STOP"} <- {"event": "RESUME"} <- {"event": "JOB_STATUS_CHANGE", "data": {"status": "waiting", "id": "snapsave0"}} <- {"event": "JOB_STATUS_CHANGE", "data": {"status": "pending", "id": "snapsave0"}} <- {"event": "JOB_STATUS_CHANGE", "data": {"status": "concluded", "id": "snapsave0"}} -> {"execute": "query-jobs"} <- {"return": [{"current-progress": 1, "status": "concluded", "total-progress": 1, "type": "snapshot-save", "id": "snapsave0"}]} Since 6.0 snapshot-load (Command) Load a VM snapshot Arguments job-id: string identifier for the newly created job tag: string name of the snapshot to load. vmstate: string block device node name to load vmstate from devices: array of string list of block device node names to load a snapshot from Applications should not assume that the snapshot load is complete when this command returns. The job commands / events must be used to determine completion and to fetch details of any errors that arise. Note that execution of the guest CPUs will be stopped during the time it takes to load the snapshot. It is strongly recommended that devices contain all writable block device nodes that can have changed since the original snapshot-save command execution. Returns nothing Example -> { "execute": "snapshot-load", "data": { "job-id": "snapload0", "tag": "my-snap", "vmstate": "disk0", "devices": ["disk0", "disk1"] } } <- { "return": { } } <- {"event": "JOB_STATUS_CHANGE", "data": {"status": "created", "id": "snapload0"}} <- {"event": "JOB_STATUS_CHANGE", "data": {"status": "running", "id": "snapload0"}} <- {"event": "STOP"} <- {"event": "RESUME"} <- {"event": "JOB_STATUS_CHANGE", "data": {"status": "waiting", "id": "snapload0"}} <- {"event": "JOB_STATUS_CHANGE", "data": {"status": "pending", "id": "snapload0"}} <- {"event": "JOB_STATUS_CHANGE", "data": {"status": "concluded", "id": "snapload0"}} -> {"execute": "query-jobs"} <- {"return": [{"current-progress": 1, "status": "concluded", "total-progress": 1, "type": "snapshot-load", "id": "snapload0"}]} Since 6.0 snapshot-delete (Command) Delete a VM snapshot Arguments job-id: string identifier for the newly created job tag: string name of the snapshot to delete. devices: array of string list of block device node names to delete a snapshot from Applications should not assume that the snapshot delete is complete when this command returns. The job commands / events must be used to determine completion and to fetch details of any errors that arise. Returns nothing Example -> { "execute": "snapshot-delete", "data": { "job-id": "snapdelete0", "tag": "my-snap", "devices": ["disk0", "disk1"] } } <- { "return": { } } <- {"event": "JOB_STATUS_CHANGE", "data": {"status": "created", "id": "snapdelete0"}} <- {"event": "JOB_STATUS_CHANGE", "data": {"status": "running", "id": "snapdelete0"}} <- {"event": "JOB_STATUS_CHANGE", "data": {"status": "waiting", "id": "snapdelete0"}} <- {"event": "JOB_STATUS_CHANGE", "data": {"status": "pending", "id": "snapdelete0"}} <- {"event": "JOB_STATUS_CHANGE", "data": {"status": "concluded", "id": "snapdelete0"}} -> {"execute": "query-jobs"} <- {"return": [{"current-progress": 1, "status": "concluded", "total-progress": 1, "type": "snapshot-delete", "id": "snapdelete0"}]} Since 6.0
TRANSACTIONS
Abort (Object) This action can be used to test transaction failure. Since 1.6 ActionCompletionMode (Enum) An enumeration of Transactional completion modes. Values individual Do not attempt to cancel any other Actions if any Actions fail after the Transaction request succeeds. All Actions that can complete successfully will do so without waiting on others. This is the default. grouped If any Action fails after the Transaction succeeds, cancel all Actions. Actions do not complete until all Actions are ready to complete. May be rejected by Actions that do not support this completion mode. Since 2.5 TransactionActionKind (Enum) Values abort Since 1.6 block-dirty-bitmap-add Since 2.5 block-dirty-bitmap-remove Since 4.2 block-dirty-bitmap-clear Since 2.5 block-dirty-bitmap-enable Since 4.0 block-dirty-bitmap-disable Since 4.0 block-dirty-bitmap-merge Since 4.0 blockdev-backup Since 2.3 blockdev-snapshot Since 2.5 blockdev-snapshot-internal-sync Since 1.7 blockdev-snapshot-sync since 1.1 drive-backup Since 1.6 Features deprecated Member drive-backup is deprecated. Use member blockdev-backup instead. Since 1.1 AbortWrapper (Object) Members data: Abort Not documented Since 1.6 BlockDirtyBitmapAddWrapper (Object) Members data: BlockDirtyBitmapAdd Not documented Since 2.5 BlockDirtyBitmapWrapper (Object) Members data: BlockDirtyBitmap Not documented Since 2.5 BlockDirtyBitmapMergeWrapper (Object) Members data: BlockDirtyBitmapMerge Not documented Since 4.0 BlockdevBackupWrapper (Object) Members data: BlockdevBackup Not documented Since 2.3 BlockdevSnapshotWrapper (Object) Members data: BlockdevSnapshot Not documented Since 2.5 BlockdevSnapshotInternalWrapper (Object) Members data: BlockdevSnapshotInternal Not documented Since 1.7 BlockdevSnapshotSyncWrapper (Object) Members data: BlockdevSnapshotSync Not documented Since 1.1 DriveBackupWrapper (Object) Members data: DriveBackup Not documented Since 1.6 TransactionAction (Object) A discriminated record of operations that can be performed with transaction. Members type: TransactionActionKind Not documented The members of AbortWrapper when type is "abort" The members of BlockDirtyBitmapAddWrapper when type is "block-dirty-bitmap-add" The members of BlockDirtyBitmapWrapper when type is "block-dirty-bitmap-remove" The members of BlockDirtyBitmapWrapper when type is "block-dirty-bitmap-clear" The members of BlockDirtyBitmapWrapper when type is "block-dirty-bitmap-enable" The members of BlockDirtyBitmapWrapper when type is "block-dirty-bitmap-disable" The members of BlockDirtyBitmapMergeWrapper when type is "block-dirty-bitmap-merge" The members of BlockdevBackupWrapper when type is "blockdev-backup" The members of BlockdevSnapshotWrapper when type is "blockdev-snapshot" The members of BlockdevSnapshotInternalWrapper when type is "blockdev-snapshot-internal-sync" The members of BlockdevSnapshotSyncWrapper when type is "blockdev-snapshot-sync" The members of DriveBackupWrapper when type is "drive-backup" Since 1.1 TransactionProperties (Object) Optional arguments to modify the behavior of a Transaction. Members completion-mode: ActionCompletionMode (optional) Controls how jobs launched asynchronously by Actions will complete or fail as a group. See ActionCompletionMode for details. Since 2.5 transaction (Command) Executes a number of transactionable QMP commands atomically. If any operation fails, then the entire set of actions will be abandoned and the appropriate error returned. For external snapshots, the dictionary contains the device, the file to use for the new snapshot, and the format. The default format, if not specified, is qcow2. Each new snapshot defaults to being created by QEMU (wiping any contents if the file already exists), but it is also possible to reuse an externally-created file. In the latter case, you should ensure that the new image file has the same contents as the current one; QEMU cannot perform any meaningful check. Typically this is achieved by using the current image file as the backing file for the new image. On failure, the original disks pre-snapshot attempt will be used. For internal snapshots, the dictionary contains the device and the snapshot's name. If an internal snapshot matching name already exists, the request will be rejected. Only some image formats support it, for example, qcow2, and rbd, On failure, qemu will try delete the newly created internal snapshot in the transaction. When an I/O error occurs during deletion, the user needs to fix it later with qemu-img or other command. Arguments actions: array of TransactionAction List of TransactionAction; information needed for the respective operations. properties: TransactionProperties (optional) structure of additional options to control the execution of the transaction. See TransactionProperties for additional detail. Returns nothing on success Errors depend on the operations of the transaction Note The transaction aborts on the first failure. Therefore, there will be information on only one failed operation returned in an error condition, and subsequent actions will not have been attempted. Since 1.1 Example -> { "execute": "transaction", "arguments": { "actions": [ { "type": "blockdev-snapshot-sync", "data" : { "device": "ide-hd0", "snapshot-file": "/some/place/my-image", "format": "qcow2" } }, { "type": "blockdev-snapshot-sync", "data" : { "node-name": "myfile", "snapshot-file": "/some/place/my-image2", "snapshot-node-name": "node3432", "mode": "existing", "format": "qcow2" } }, { "type": "blockdev-snapshot-sync", "data" : { "device": "ide-hd1", "snapshot-file": "/some/place/my-image2", "mode": "existing", "format": "qcow2" } }, { "type": "blockdev-snapshot-internal-sync", "data" : { "device": "ide-hd2", "name": "snapshot0" } } ] } } <- { "return": {} }
TRACING
TraceEventState (Enum) State of a tracing event. Values unavailable The event is statically disabled. disabled The event is dynamically disabled. enabled The event is dynamically enabled. Since 2.2 TraceEventInfo (Object) Information of a tracing event. Members name: string Event name. state: TraceEventState Tracing state. vcpu: boolean Whether this is a per-vCPU event (since 2.7). An event is per-vCPU if it has the "vcpu" property in the "trace-events" files. Since 2.2 trace-event-get-state (Command) Query the state of events. Arguments name: string Event name pattern (case-sensitive glob). vcpu: int (optional) The vCPU to query (any by default; since 2.7). Returns a list of TraceEventInfo for the matching events An event is returned if: • its name matches the name pattern, and • if vcpu is given, the event has the "vcpu" property. Therefore, if vcpu is given, the operation will only match per-vCPU events, returning their state on the specified vCPU. Special case: if name is an exact match, vcpu is given and the event does not have the "vcpu" property, an error is returned. Since 2.2 Example -> { "execute": "trace-event-get-state", "arguments": { "name": "qemu_memalign" } } <- { "return": [ { "name": "qemu_memalign", "state": "disabled" } ] } trace-event-set-state (Command) Set the dynamic tracing state of events. Arguments name: string Event name pattern (case-sensitive glob). enable: boolean Whether to enable tracing. ignore-unavailable: boolean (optional) Do not match unavailable events with name. vcpu: int (optional) The vCPU to act upon (all by default; since 2.7). An event's state is modified if: - its name matches the name pattern, and - if vcpu is given, the event has the "vcpu" property. Therefore, if vcpu is given, the operation will only match per-vCPU events, setting their state on the specified vCPU. Special case: if name is an exact match, vcpu is given and the event does not have the "vcpu" property, an error is returned. Since 2.2 Example -> { "execute": "trace-event-set-state", "arguments": { "name": "qemu_memalign", "enable": true } } <- { "return": {} }
COMPATIBILITY POLICY
CompatPolicyInput (Enum) Policy for handling "funny" input. Values accept Accept silently reject Reject with an error crash abort() the process Since 6.0 CompatPolicyOutput (Enum) Policy for handling "funny" output. Values accept Pass on unchanged hide Filter out Since 6.0 CompatPolicy (Object) Policy for handling deprecated management interfaces. This is intended for testing users of the management interfaces. Limitation: covers only syntactic aspects of QMP, i.e. stuff tagged with feature 'deprecated'. We may want to extend it to cover semantic aspects, CLI, and experimental features. Limitation: deprecated-output policy hide is not implemented for enumeration values. They behave the same as with policy accept. Members deprecated-input: CompatPolicyInput (optional) how to handle deprecated input (default 'accept') deprecated-output: CompatPolicyOutput (optional) how to handle deprecated output (default 'accept') unstable-input: CompatPolicyInput (optional) how to handle unstable input (default 'accept') (since 6.2) unstable-output: CompatPolicyOutput (optional) how to handle unstable output (default 'accept') (since 6.2) Since 6.0
QMP MONITOR CONTROL
qmp_capabilities (Command) Enable QMP capabilities. Arguments: Arguments enable: array of QMPCapability (optional) An optional list of QMPCapability values to enable. The client must not enable any capability that is not mentioned in the QMP greeting message. If the field is not provided, it means no QMP capabilities will be enabled. (since 2.12) Example -> { "execute": "qmp_capabilities", "arguments": { "enable": [ "oob" ] } } <- { "return": {} } Notes This command is valid exactly when first connecting: it must be issued before any other command will be accepted, and will fail once the monitor is accepting other commands. (see qemu docs/interop/qmp-spec.txt) The QMP client needs to explicitly enable QMP capabilities, otherwise all the QMP capabilities will be turned off by default. Since 0.13 QMPCapability (Enum) Enumeration of capabilities to be advertised during initial client connection, used for agreeing on particular QMP extension behaviors. Values oob QMP ability to support out-of-band requests. (Please refer to qmp-spec.txt for more information on OOB) Since 2.12 VersionTriple (Object) A three-part version number. Members major: int The major version number. minor: int The minor version number. micro: int The micro version number. Since 2.4 VersionInfo (Object) A description of QEMU's version. Members qemu: VersionTriple The version of QEMU. By current convention, a micro version of 50 signifies a development branch. A micro version greater than or equal to 90 signifies a release candidate for the next minor version. A micro version of less than 50 signifies a stable release. package: string QEMU will always set this field to an empty string. Downstream versions of QEMU should set this to a non-empty string. The exact format depends on the downstream however it highly recommended that a unique name is used. Since 0.14 query-version (Command) Returns the current version of QEMU. Returns A VersionInfo object describing the current version of QEMU. Since 0.14 Example -> { "execute": "query-version" } <- { "return":{ "qemu":{ "major":0, "minor":11, "micro":5 }, "package":"" } } CommandInfo (Object) Information about a QMP command Members name: string The command name Since 0.14 query-commands (Command) Return a list of supported QMP commands by this server Returns A list of CommandInfo for all supported commands Since 0.14 Example -> { "execute": "query-commands" } <- { "return":[ { "name":"query-balloon" }, { "name":"system_powerdown" } ] } Note This example has been shortened as the real response is too long. quit (Command) This command will cause the QEMU process to exit gracefully. While every attempt is made to send the QMP response before terminating, this is not guaranteed. When using this interface, a premature EOF would not be unexpected. Since 0.14 Example -> { "execute": "quit" } <- { "return": {} } MonitorMode (Enum) An enumeration of monitor modes. Values readline HMP monitor (human-oriented command line interface) control QMP monitor (JSON-based machine interface) Since 5.0 MonitorOptions (Object) Options to be used for adding a new monitor. Members id: string (optional) Name of the monitor mode: MonitorMode (optional) Selects the monitor mode (default: readline in the system emulator, control in qemu-storage-daemon) pretty: boolean (optional) Enables pretty printing (QMP only) chardev: string Name of a character device to expose the monitor on Since 5.0
QMP INTROSPECTION
query-qmp-schema (Command) Command query-qmp-schema exposes the QMP wire ABI as an array of SchemaInfo. This lets QMP clients figure out what commands and events are available in this QEMU, and their parameters and results. However, the SchemaInfo can't reflect all the rules and restrictions that apply to QMP. It's interface introspection (figuring out what's there), not interface specification. The specification is in the QAPI schema. Furthermore, while we strive to keep the QMP wire format backwards-compatible across qemu versions, the introspection output is not guaranteed to have the same stability. For example, one version of qemu may list an object member as an optional non-variant, while another lists the same member only through the object's variants; or the type of a member may change from a generic string into a specific enum or from one specific type into an alternate that includes the original type alongside something else. Returns array of SchemaInfo, where each element describes an entity in the ABI: command, event, type, ... The order of the various SchemaInfo is unspecified; however, all names are guaranteed to be unique (no name will be duplicated with different meta-types). Note the QAPI schema is also used to help define internal interfaces, by defining QAPI types. These are not part of the QMP wire ABI, and therefore not returned by this command. Since 2.5 SchemaMetaType (Enum) This is a SchemaInfo's meta type, i.e. the kind of entity it describes. Values builtin a predefined type such as 'int' or 'bool'. enum an enumeration type array an array type object an object type (struct or union) alternate an alternate type command a QMP command event a QMP event Since 2.5 SchemaInfo (Object) Members name: string the entity's name, inherited from base. The SchemaInfo is always referenced by this name. Commands and events have the name defined in the QAPI schema. Unlike command and event names, type names are not part of the wire ABI. Consequently, type names are meaningless strings here, although they are still guaranteed unique regardless of meta-type. meta-type: SchemaMetaType the entity's meta type, inherited from base. features: array of string (optional) names of features associated with the entity, in no particular order. (since 4.1 for object types, 4.2 for commands, 5.0 for the rest) The members of SchemaInfoBuiltin when meta-type is "builtin" The members of SchemaInfoEnum when meta-type is "enum" The members of SchemaInfoArray when meta-type is "array" The members of SchemaInfoObject when meta-type is "object" The members of SchemaInfoAlternate when meta-type is "alternate" The members of SchemaInfoCommand when meta-type is "command" The members of SchemaInfoEvent when meta-type is "event" Additional members depend on the value of meta-type. Since 2.5 SchemaInfoBuiltin (Object) Additional SchemaInfo members for meta-type 'builtin'. Members json-type: JSONType the JSON type used for this type on the wire. Since 2.5 JSONType (Enum) The four primitive and two structured types according to RFC 8259 section 1, plus 'int' (split off 'number'), plus the obvious top type 'value'. Values string Not documented number Not documented int Not documented boolean Not documented null Not documented object Not documented array Not documented value Not documented Since 2.5 SchemaInfoEnum (Object) Additional SchemaInfo members for meta-type 'enum'. Members members: array of SchemaInfoEnumMember the enum type's members, in no particular order (since 6.2). values: array of string the enumeration type's member names, in no particular order. Redundant with members. Just for backward compatibility. Features deprecated Member values is deprecated. Use members instead. Values of this type are JSON string on the wire. Since 2.5 SchemaInfoEnumMember (Object) An object member. Members name: string the member's name, as defined in the QAPI schema. features: array of string (optional) names of features associated with the member, in no particular order. Since 6.2 SchemaInfoArray (Object) Additional SchemaInfo members for meta-type 'array'. Members element-type: string the array type's element type. Values of this type are JSON array on the wire. Since 2.5 SchemaInfoObject (Object) Additional SchemaInfo members for meta-type 'object'. Members members: array of SchemaInfoObjectMember the object type's (non-variant) members, in no particular order. tag: string (optional) the name of the member serving as type tag. An element of members with this name must exist. variants: array of SchemaInfoObjectVariant (optional) variant members, i.e. additional members that depend on the type tag's value. Present exactly when tag is present. The variants are in no particular order, and may even differ from the order of the values of the enum type of the tag. Values of this type are JSON object on the wire. Since 2.5 SchemaInfoObjectMember (Object) An object member. Members name: string the member's name, as defined in the QAPI schema. type: string the name of the member's type. default: value (optional) default when used as command parameter. If absent, the parameter is mandatory. If present, the value must be null. The parameter is optional, and behavior when it's missing is not specified here. Future extension: if present and non-null, the parameter is optional, and defaults to this value. features: array of string (optional) names of features associated with the member, in no particular order. (since 5.0) Since 2.5 SchemaInfoObjectVariant (Object) The variant members for a value of the type tag. Members case: string a value of the type tag. type: string the name of the object type that provides the variant members when the type tag has value case. Since 2.5 SchemaInfoAlternate (Object) Additional SchemaInfo members for meta-type 'alternate'. Members members: array of SchemaInfoAlternateMember the alternate type's members, in no particular order. The members' wire encoding is distinct, see docs/devel/qapi-code-gen.txt section Alternate types. On the wire, this can be any of the members. Since 2.5 SchemaInfoAlternateMember (Object) An alternate member. Members type: string the name of the member's type. Since 2.5 SchemaInfoCommand (Object) Additional SchemaInfo members for meta-type 'command'. Members arg-type: string the name of the object type that provides the command's parameters. ret-type: string the name of the command's result type. allow-oob: boolean (optional) whether the command allows out-of-band execution, defaults to false (Since: 2.12) TODO success-response (currently irrelevant, because it's QGA, not QMP) Since 2.5 SchemaInfoEvent (Object) Additional SchemaInfo members for meta-type 'event'. Members arg-type: string the name of the object type that provides the event's parameters. Since 2.5
QEMU OBJECT MODEL (QOM)
ObjectPropertyInfo (Object) Members name: string the name of the property type: string the type of the property. This will typically come in one of four forms: 1. A primitive type such as 'u8', 'u16', 'bool', 'str', or 'double'. These types are mapped to the appropriate JSON type. 2. A child type in the form 'child<subtype>' where subtype is a qdev device type name. Child properties create the composition tree. 3. A link type in the form 'link<subtype>' where subtype is a qdev device type name. Link properties form the device model graph. description: string (optional) if specified, the description of the property. default-value: value (optional) the default value, if any (since 5.0) Since 1.2 qom-list (Command) This command will list any properties of a object given a path in the object model. Arguments path: string the path within the object model. See qom-get for a description of this parameter. Returns a list of ObjectPropertyInfo that describe the properties of the object. Since 1.2 Example -> { "execute": "qom-list", "arguments": { "path": "/chardevs" } } <- { "return": [ { "name": "type", "type": "string" }, { "name": "parallel0", "type": "child<chardev-vc>" }, { "name": "serial0", "type": "child<chardev-vc>" }, { "name": "mon0", "type": "child<chardev-stdio>" } ] } qom-get (Command) This command will get a property from a object model path and return the value. Arguments path: string The path within the object model. There are two forms of supported paths--absolute and partial paths. Absolute paths are derived from the root object and can follow child<> or link<> properties. Since they can follow link<> properties, they can be arbitrarily long. Absolute paths look like absolute filenames and are prefixed with a leading slash. Partial paths look like relative filenames. They do not begin with a prefix. The matching rules for partial paths are subtle but designed to make specifying objects easy. At each level of the composition tree, the partial path is matched as an absolute path. The first match is not returned. At least two matches are searched for. A successful result is only returned if only one match is found. If more than one match is found, a flag is return to indicate that the match was ambiguous. property: string The property name to read Returns The property value. The type depends on the property type. child<> and link<> properties are returned as #str pathnames. All integer property types (u8, u16, etc) are returned as #int. Since 1.2 Example 1. Use absolute path -> { "execute": "qom-get", "arguments": { "path": "/machine/unattached/device[0]", "property": "hotplugged" } } <- { "return": false } 2. Use partial path -> { "execute": "qom-get", "arguments": { "path": "unattached/sysbus", "property": "type" } } <- { "return": "System" } qom-set (Command) This command will set a property from a object model path. Arguments path: string see qom-get for a description of this parameter property: string the property name to set value: value a value who's type is appropriate for the property type. See qom-get for a description of type mapping. Since 1.2 Example -> { "execute": "qom-set", "arguments": { "path": "/machine", "property": "graphics", "value": false } } <- { "return": {} } ObjectTypeInfo (Object) This structure describes a search result from qom-list-types Members name: string the type name found in the search abstract: boolean (optional) the type is abstract and can't be directly instantiated. Omitted if false. (since 2.10) parent: string (optional) Name of parent type, if any (since 2.10) Since 1.1 qom-list-types (Command) This command will return a list of types given search parameters Arguments implements: string (optional) if specified, only return types that implement this type name abstract: boolean (optional) if true, include abstract types in the results Returns a list of ObjectTypeInfo or an empty list if no results are found Since 1.1 qom-list-properties (Command) List properties associated with a QOM object. Arguments typename: string the type name of an object Note objects can create properties at runtime, for example to describe links between different devices and/or objects. These properties are not included in the output of this command. Returns a list of ObjectPropertyInfo describing object properties Since 2.12 CanHostSocketcanProperties (Object) Properties for can-host-socketcan objects. Members if: string interface name of the host system CAN bus to connect to canbus: string object ID of the can-bus object to connect to the host interface Since 2.12 ColoCompareProperties (Object) Properties for colo-compare objects. Members primary_in: string name of the character device backend to use for the primary input (incoming packets are redirected to outdev) secondary_in: string name of the character device backend to use for secondary input (incoming packets are only compared to the input on primary_in and then dropped) outdev: string name of the character device backend to use for output iothread: string name of the iothread to run in notify_dev: string (optional) name of the character device backend to be used to communicate with the remote colo-frame (only for Xen COLO) compare_timeout: int (optional) the maximum time to hold a packet from primary_in for comparison with an incoming packet on secondary_in in milliseconds (default: 3000) expired_scan_cycle: int (optional) the interval at which colo-compare checks whether packets from primary have timed out, in milliseconds (default: 3000) max_queue_size: int (optional) the maximum number of packets to keep in the queue for comparing with incoming packets from secondary_in. If the queue is full and additional packets are received, the additional packets are dropped. (default: 1024) vnet_hdr_support: boolean (optional) if true, vnet header support is enabled (default: false) Since 2.8 CryptodevBackendProperties (Object) Properties for cryptodev-backend and cryptodev-backend-builtin objects. Members queues: int (optional) the number of queues for the cryptodev backend. Ignored for cryptodev-backend and must be 1 for cryptodev-backend-builtin. (default: 1) Since 2.8 CryptodevVhostUserProperties (Object) Properties for cryptodev-vhost-user objects. Members chardev: string the name of a Unix domain socket character device that connects to the vhost-user server The members of CryptodevBackendProperties Since 2.12 DBusVMStateProperties (Object) Properties for dbus-vmstate objects. Members addr: string the name of the DBus bus to connect to id-list: string (optional) a comma separated list of DBus IDs of helpers whose data should be included in the VM state on migration Since 5.0 NetfilterInsert (Enum) Indicates where to insert a netfilter relative to a given other filter. Values before insert before the specified filter behind insert behind the specified filter Since 5.0 NetfilterProperties (Object) Properties for objects of classes derived from netfilter. Members netdev: string id of the network device backend to filter queue: NetFilterDirection (optional) indicates which queue(s) to filter (default: all) status: string (optional) indicates whether the filter is enabled ("on") or disabled ("off") (default: "on") position: string (optional) specifies where the filter should be inserted in the filter list. "head" means the filter is inserted at the head of the filter list, before any existing filters. "tail" means the filter is inserted at the tail of the filter list, behind any existing filters (default). "id=<id>" means the filter is inserted before or behind the filter specified by <id>, depending on the insert property. (default: "tail") insert: NetfilterInsert (optional) where to insert the filter relative to the filter given in position. Ignored if position is "head" or "tail". (default: behind) Since 2.5 FilterBufferProperties (Object) Properties for filter-buffer objects. Members interval: int a non-zero interval in microseconds. All packets arriving in the given interval are delayed until the end of the interval. The members of NetfilterProperties Since 2.5 FilterDumpProperties (Object) Properties for filter-dump objects. Members file: string the filename where the dumped packets should be stored maxlen: int (optional) maximum number of bytes in a packet that are stored (default: 65536) The members of NetfilterProperties Since 2.5 FilterMirrorProperties (Object) Properties for filter-mirror objects. Members outdev: string the name of a character device backend to which all incoming packets are mirrored vnet_hdr_support: boolean (optional) if true, vnet header support is enabled (default: false) The members of NetfilterProperties Since 2.6 FilterRedirectorProperties (Object) Properties for filter-redirector objects. At least one of indev or outdev must be present. If both are present, they must not refer to the same character device backend. Members indev: string (optional) the name of a character device backend from which packets are received and redirected to the filtered network device outdev: string (optional) the name of a character device backend to which all incoming packets are redirected vnet_hdr_support: boolean (optional) if true, vnet header support is enabled (default: false) The members of NetfilterProperties Since 2.6 FilterRewriterProperties (Object) Properties for filter-rewriter objects. Members vnet_hdr_support: boolean (optional) if true, vnet header support is enabled (default: false) The members of NetfilterProperties Since 2.8 InputBarrierProperties (Object) Properties for input-barrier objects. Members name: string the screen name as declared in the screens section of barrier.conf server: string (optional) hostname of the Barrier server (default: "localhost") port: string (optional) TCP port of the Barrier server (default: "24800") x-origin: string (optional) x coordinate of the leftmost pixel on the guest screen (default: "0") y-origin: string (optional) y coordinate of the topmost pixel on the guest screen (default: "0") width: string (optional) the width of secondary screen in pixels (default: "1920") height: string (optional) the height of secondary screen in pixels (default: "1080") Since 4.2 InputLinuxProperties (Object) Properties for input-linux objects. Members evdev: string the path of the host evdev device to use grab_all: boolean (optional) if true, grab is toggled for all devices (e.g. both keyboard and mouse) instead of just one device (default: false) repeat: boolean (optional) enables auto-repeat events (default: false) grab-toggle: GrabToggleKeys (optional) the key or key combination that toggles device grab (default: ctrl-ctrl) Since 2.6 IothreadProperties (Object) Properties for iothread objects. Members poll-max-ns: int (optional) the maximum number of nanoseconds to busy wait for events. 0 means polling is disabled (default: 32768 on POSIX hosts, 0 otherwise) poll-grow: int (optional) the multiplier used to increase the polling time when the algorithm detects it is missing events due to not polling long enough. 0 selects a default behaviour (default: 0) poll-shrink: int (optional) the divisor used to decrease the polling time when the algorithm detects it is spending too long polling without encountering events. 0 selects a default behaviour (default: 0) aio-max-batch: int (optional) maximum number of requests in a batch for the AIO engine, 0 means that the engine will use its default (default:0, since 6.1) Since 2.0 MemoryBackendProperties (Object) Properties for objects of classes derived from memory-backend. Members merge: boolean (optional) if true, mark the memory as mergeable (default depends on the machine type) dump: boolean (optional) if true, include the memory in core dumps (default depends on the machine type) host-nodes: array of int (optional) the list of NUMA host nodes to bind the memory to policy: HostMemPolicy (optional) the NUMA policy (default: 'default') prealloc: boolean (optional) if true, preallocate memory (default: false) prealloc-threads: int (optional) number of CPU threads to use for prealloc (default: 1) share: boolean (optional) if false, the memory is private to QEMU; if true, it is shared (default: false) reserve: boolean (optional) if true, reserve swap space (or huge pages) if applicable (default: true) (since 6.1) size: int size of the memory region in bytes x-use-canonical-path-for-ramblock-id: boolean (optional) if true, the canoncial path is used for ramblock-id. Disable this for 4.0 machine types or older to allow migration with newer QEMU versions. (default: false generally, but true for machine types <= 4.0) Note prealloc=true and reserve=false cannot be set at the same time. With reserve=true, the behavior depends on the operating system: for example, Linux will not reserve swap space for shared file mappings -- "not applicable". In contrast, reserve=false will bail out if it cannot be configured accordingly. Since 2.1 MemoryBackendFileProperties (Object) Properties for memory-backend-file objects. Members align: int (optional) the base address alignment when QEMU mmap(2)s mem-path. Some backend stores specified by mem-path require an alignment different than the default one used by QEMU, e.g. the device DAX /dev/dax0.0 requires 2M alignment rather than 4K. In such cases, users can specify the required alignment via this option. 0 selects a default alignment (currently the page size). (default: 0) discard-data: boolean (optional) if true, the file contents can be destroyed when QEMU exits, to avoid unnecessarily flushing data to the backing file. Note that discard-data is only an optimization, and QEMU might not discard file contents if it aborts unexpectedly or is terminated using SIGKILL. (default: false) mem-path: string the path to either a shared memory or huge page filesystem mount pmem: boolean (optional) (If: CONFIG_LIBPMEM) specifies whether the backing file specified by mem-path is in host persistent memory that can be accessed using the SNIA NVM programming model (e.g. Intel NVDIMM). readonly: boolean (optional) if true, the backing file is opened read-only; if false, it is opened read-write. (default: false) The members of MemoryBackendProperties Since 2.1 MemoryBackendMemfdProperties (Object) Properties for memory-backend-memfd objects. The share boolean option is true by default with memfd. Members hugetlb: boolean (optional) if true, the file to be created resides in the hugetlbfs filesystem (default: false) hugetlbsize: int (optional) the hugetlb page size on systems that support multiple hugetlb page sizes (it must be a power of 2 value supported by the system). 0 selects a default page size. This option is ignored if hugetlb is false. (default: 0) seal: boolean (optional) if true, create a sealed-file, which will block further resizing of the memory (default: true) The members of MemoryBackendProperties Since 2.12 MemoryBackendEpcProperties (Object) Properties for memory-backend-epc objects. The share boolean option is true by default with epc The merge boolean option is false by default with epc The dump boolean option is false by default with epc Members The members of MemoryBackendProperties Since 6.2 PrManagerHelperProperties (Object) Properties for pr-manager-helper objects. Members path: string the path to a Unix domain socket for connecting to the external helper Since 2.11 QtestProperties (Object) Properties for qtest objects. Members chardev: string the chardev to be used to receive qtest commands on. log: string (optional) the path to a log file Since 6.0 RemoteObjectProperties (Object) Properties for x-remote-object objects. Members fd: string file descriptor name previously passed via 'getfd' command devid: string the id of the device to be associated with the file descriptor Since 6.0 RngProperties (Object) Properties for objects of classes derived from rng. Members opened: boolean (optional) if true, the device is opened immediately when applying this option and will probably fail when processing the next option. Don't use; only provided for compatibility. (default: false) Features deprecated Member opened is deprecated. Setting true doesn't make sense, and false is already the default. Since 1.3 RngEgdProperties (Object) Properties for rng-egd objects. Members chardev: string the name of a character device backend that provides the connection to the RNG daemon The members of RngProperties Since 1.3 RngRandomProperties (Object) Properties for rng-random objects. Members filename: string (optional) the filename of the device on the host to obtain entropy from (default: "/dev/urandom") The members of RngProperties Since 1.3 SevGuestProperties (Object) Properties for sev-guest objects. Members sev-device: string (optional) SEV device to use (default: "/dev/sev") dh-cert-file: string (optional) guest owners DH certificate (encoded with base64) session-file: string (optional) guest owners session parameters (encoded with base64) policy: int (optional) SEV policy value (default: 0x1) handle: int (optional) SEV firmware handle (default: 0) cbitpos: int (optional) C-bit location in page table entry (default: 0) reduced-phys-bits: int number of bits in physical addresses that become unavailable when SEV is enabled kernel-hashes: boolean (optional) if true, add hashes of kernel/initrd/cmdline to a designated guest firmware page for measured boot with -kernel (default: false) (since 6.2) Since 2.12 ObjectType (Enum) Values authz-list Not documented authz-listfile Not documented authz-pam Not documented authz-simple Not documented can-bus Not documented can-host-socketcan (If: CONFIG_LINUX) Not documented colo-compare Not documented cryptodev-backend Not documented cryptodev-backend-builtin Not documented cryptodev-vhost-user (If: CONFIG_VHOST_CRYPTO) Not documented dbus-vmstate Not documented filter-buffer Not documented filter-dump Not documented filter-mirror Not documented filter-redirector Not documented filter-replay Not documented filter-rewriter Not documented input-barrier Not documented input-linux (If: CONFIG_LINUX) Not documented iothread Not documented memory-backend-epc (If: CONFIG_LINUX) Not documented memory-backend-file Not documented memory-backend-memfd (If: CONFIG_LINUX) Not documented memory-backend-ram Not documented pef-guest Not documented pr-manager-helper (If: CONFIG_LINUX) Not documented qtest Not documented rng-builtin Not documented rng-egd Not documented rng-random (If: CONFIG_POSIX) Not documented secret Not documented secret_keyring (If: CONFIG_SECRET_KEYRING) Not documented sev-guest Not documented s390-pv-guest Not documented throttle-group Not documented tls-creds-anon Not documented tls-creds-psk Not documented tls-creds-x509 Not documented tls-cipher-suites Not documented x-remote-object Not documented Features unstable Member x-remote-object is experimental. Since 6.0 ObjectOptions (Object) Describes the options of a user creatable QOM object. Members qom-type: ObjectType the class name for the object to be created id: string the name of the new object The members of AuthZListProperties when qom-type is "authz-list" The members of AuthZListFileProperties when qom-type is "authz-listfile" The members of AuthZPAMProperties when qom-type is "authz-pam" The members of AuthZSimpleProperties when qom-type is "authz-simple" The members of CanHostSocketcanProperties when qom-type is "can-host-socketcan" (If: CONFIG_LINUX) The members of ColoCompareProperties when qom-type is "colo-compare" The members of CryptodevBackendProperties when qom-type is "cryptodev-backend" The members of CryptodevBackendProperties when qom-type is "cryptodev-backend-builtin" The members of CryptodevVhostUserProperties when qom-type is "cryptodev-vhost-user" (If: CONFIG_VHOST_CRYPTO) The members of DBusVMStateProperties when qom-type is "dbus-vmstate" The members of FilterBufferProperties when qom-type is "filter-buffer" The members of FilterDumpProperties when qom-type is "filter-dump" The members of FilterMirrorProperties when qom-type is "filter-mirror" The members of FilterRedirectorProperties when qom-type is "filter-redirector" The members of NetfilterProperties when qom-type is "filter-replay" The members of FilterRewriterProperties when qom-type is "filter-rewriter" The members of InputBarrierProperties when qom-type is "input-barrier" The members of InputLinuxProperties when qom-type is "input-linux" (If: CONFIG_LINUX) The members of IothreadProperties when qom-type is "iothread" The members of MemoryBackendEpcProperties when qom-type is "memory-backend-epc" (If: CONFIG_LINUX) The members of MemoryBackendFileProperties when qom-type is "memory-backend-file" The members of MemoryBackendMemfdProperties when qom-type is "memory-backend-memfd" (If: CONFIG_LINUX) The members of MemoryBackendProperties when qom-type is "memory-backend-ram" The members of PrManagerHelperProperties when qom-type is "pr-manager-helper" (If: CONFIG_LINUX) The members of QtestProperties when qom-type is "qtest" The members of RngProperties when qom-type is "rng-builtin" The members of RngEgdProperties when qom-type is "rng-egd" The members of RngRandomProperties when qom-type is "rng-random" (If: CONFIG_POSIX) The members of SecretProperties when qom-type is "secret" The members of SecretKeyringProperties when qom-type is "secret_keyring" (If: CONFIG_SECRET_KEYRING) The members of SevGuestProperties when qom-type is "sev-guest" The members of ThrottleGroupProperties when qom-type is "throttle-group" The members of TlsCredsAnonProperties when qom-type is "tls-creds-anon" The members of TlsCredsPskProperties when qom-type is "tls-creds-psk" The members of TlsCredsX509Properties when qom-type is "tls-creds-x509" The members of TlsCredsProperties when qom-type is "tls-cipher-suites" The members of RemoteObjectProperties when qom-type is "x-remote-object" Since 6.0 object-add (Command) Create a QOM object. Arguments The members of ObjectOptions Returns Nothing on success Error if qom-type is not a valid class name Since 2.0 Example -> { "execute": "object-add", "arguments": { "qom-type": "rng-random", "id": "rng1", "filename": "/dev/hwrng" } } <- { "return": {} } object-del (Command) Remove a QOM object. Arguments id: string the name of the QOM object to remove Returns Nothing on success Error if id is not a valid id for a QOM object Since 2.0 Example -> { "execute": "object-del", "arguments": { "id": "rng1" } } <- { "return": {} }
DEVICE INFRASTRUCTURE (QDEV)
device-list-properties (Command) List properties associated with a device. Arguments typename: string the type name of a device Returns a list of ObjectPropertyInfo describing a devices properties Note objects can create properties at runtime, for example to describe links between different devices and/or objects. These properties are not included in the output of this command. Since 1.2 device_add (Command) Add a device. Arguments driver: string the name of the new device's driver bus: string (optional) the device's parent bus (device tree path) id: string (optional) the device's ID, must be unique Features json-cli If present, the "-device" command line option supports JSON syntax with a structure identical to the arguments of this command. Notes Additional arguments depend on the type. 1. For detailed information about this command, please refer to the 'docs/qdev-device-use.txt' file. 2. It's possible to list device properties by running QEMU with the "-device DEVICE,help" command-line argument, where DEVICE is the device's name Example -> { "execute": "device_add", "arguments": { "driver": "e1000", "id": "net1", "bus": "pci.0", "mac": "52:54:00:12:34:56" } } <- { "return": {} } TODO This command effectively bypasses QAPI completely due to its "additional arguments" business. It shouldn't have been added to the schema in this form. It should be qapified properly, or replaced by a properly qapified command. Since 0.13 device_del (Command) Remove a device from a guest Arguments id: string the device's ID or QOM path Returns Nothing on success If id is not a valid device, DeviceNotFound Notes When this command completes, the device may not be removed from the guest. Hot removal is an operation that requires guest cooperation. This command merely requests that the guest begin the hot removal process. Completion of the device removal process is signaled with a DEVICE_DELETED event. Guest reset will automatically complete removal for all devices. If a guest-side error in the hot removal process is detected, the device will not be removed and a DEVICE_UNPLUG_GUEST_ERROR event is sent. Some errors cannot be detected. Since 0.14 Example -> { "execute": "device_del", "arguments": { "id": "net1" } } <- { "return": {} } -> { "execute": "device_del", "arguments": { "id": "/machine/peripheral-anon/device[0]" } } <- { "return": {} } DEVICE_DELETED (Event) Emitted whenever the device removal completion is acknowledged by the guest. At this point, it's safe to reuse the specified device ID. Device removal can be initiated by the guest or by HMP/QMP commands. Arguments device: string (optional) the device's ID if it has one path: string the device's QOM path Since 1.5 Example <- { "event": "DEVICE_DELETED", "data": { "device": "virtio-net-pci-0", "path": "/machine/peripheral/virtio-net-pci-0" }, "timestamp": { "seconds": 1265044230, "microseconds": 450486 } } DEVICE_UNPLUG_GUEST_ERROR (Event) Emitted when a device hot unplug fails due to a guest reported error. Arguments device: string (optional) the device's ID if it has one path: string the device's QOM path Since 6.2 Example <- { "event": "DEVICE_UNPLUG_GUEST_ERROR" "data": { "device": "core1", "path": "/machine/peripheral/core1" }, }, "timestamp": { "seconds": 1615570772, "microseconds": 202844 } }
MACHINES
SysEmuTarget (Enum) The comprehensive enumeration of QEMU system emulation ("softmmu") targets. Run "./configure --help" in the project root directory, and look for the *-softmmu targets near the "--target-list" option. The individual target constants are not documented here, for the time being. Values rx since 5.0 avr since 5.1 aarch64 Not documented alpha Not documented arm Not documented cris Not documented hppa Not documented i386 Not documented m68k Not documented microblaze Not documented microblazeel Not documented mips Not documented mips64 Not documented mips64el Not documented mipsel Not documented nios2 Not documented or1k Not documented ppc Not documented ppc64 Not documented riscv32 Not documented riscv64 Not documented s390x Not documented sh4 Not documented sh4eb Not documented sparc Not documented sparc64 Not documented tricore Not documented x86_64 Not documented xtensa Not documented xtensaeb Not documented Notes The resulting QMP strings can be appended to the "qemu-system-" prefix to produce the corresponding QEMU executable name. This is true even for "qemu-system-x86_64". Since 3.0 CpuS390State (Enum) An enumeration of cpu states that can be assumed by a virtual S390 CPU Values uninitialized Not documented stopped Not documented check-stop Not documented operating Not documented load Not documented Since 2.12 CpuInfoS390 (Object) Additional information about a virtual S390 CPU Members cpu-state: CpuS390State the virtual CPU's state Since 2.12 CpuInfoFast (Object) Information about a virtual CPU Members cpu-index: int index of the virtual CPU qom-path: string path to the CPU object in the QOM tree thread-id: int ID of the underlying host thread props: CpuInstanceProperties (optional) properties describing to which node/socket/core/thread virtual CPU belongs to, provided if supported by board target: SysEmuTarget the QEMU system emulation target, which determines which additional fields will be listed (since 3.0) The members of CpuInfoS390 when target is "s390x" Since 2.12 query-cpus-fast (Command) Returns information about all virtual CPUs. Returns list of CpuInfoFast Since 2.12 Example -> { "execute": "query-cpus-fast" } <- { "return": [ { "thread-id": 25627, "props": { "core-id": 0, "thread-id": 0, "socket-id": 0 }, "qom-path": "/machine/unattached/device[0]", "arch":"x86", "target":"x86_64", "cpu-index": 0 }, { "thread-id": 25628, "props": { "core-id": 0, "thread-id": 0, "socket-id": 1 }, "qom-path": "/machine/unattached/device[2]", "arch":"x86", "target":"x86_64", "cpu-index": 1 } ] } MachineInfo (Object) Information describing a machine. Members name: string the name of the machine alias: string (optional) an alias for the machine name is-default: boolean (optional) whether the machine is default cpu-max: int maximum number of CPUs supported by the machine type (since 1.5) hotpluggable-cpus: boolean cpu hotplug via -device is supported (since 2.7) numa-mem-supported: boolean true if '-numa node,mem' option is supported by the machine type and false otherwise (since 4.1) deprecated: boolean if true, the machine type is deprecated and may be removed in future versions of QEMU according to the QEMU deprecation policy (since 4.1) default-cpu-type: string (optional) default CPU model typename if none is requested via the -cpu argument. (since 4.2) default-ram-id: string (optional) the default ID of initial RAM memory backend (since 5.2) Since 1.2 query-machines (Command) Return a list of supported machines Returns a list of MachineInfo Since 1.2 CurrentMachineParams (Object) Information describing the running machine parameters. Members wakeup-suspend-support: boolean true if the machine supports wake up from suspend Since 4.0 query-current-machine (Command) Return information on the current virtual machine. Returns CurrentMachineParams Since 4.0 TargetInfo (Object) Information describing the QEMU target. Members arch: SysEmuTarget the target architecture Since 1.2 query-target (Command) Return information about the target for this QEMU Returns TargetInfo Since 1.2 UuidInfo (Object) Guest UUID information (Universally Unique Identifier). Members UUID: string the UUID of the guest Since 0.14 Notes If no UUID was specified for the guest, a null UUID is returned. query-uuid (Command) Query the guest UUID information. Returns The UuidInfo for the guest Since 0.14 Example -> { "execute": "query-uuid" } <- { "return": { "UUID": "550e8400-e29b-41d4-a716-446655440000" } } GuidInfo (Object) GUID information. Members guid: string the globally unique identifier Since 2.9 query-vm-generation-id (Command) Show Virtual Machine Generation ID Since 2.9 system_reset (Command) Performs a hard reset of a guest. Since 0.14 Example -> { "execute": "system_reset" } <- { "return": {} } system_powerdown (Command) Requests that a guest perform a powerdown operation. Since 0.14 Notes A guest may or may not respond to this command. This command returning does not indicate that a guest has accepted the request or that it has shut down. Many guests will respond to this command by prompting the user in some way. Example -> { "execute": "system_powerdown" } <- { "return": {} } system_wakeup (Command) Wake up guest from suspend. If the guest has wake-up from suspend support enabled (wakeup-suspend-support flag from query-current-machine), wake-up guest from suspend if the guest is in SUSPENDED state. Return an error otherwise. Since 1.1 Returns nothing. Note prior to 4.0, this command does nothing in case the guest isn't suspended. Example -> { "execute": "system_wakeup" } <- { "return": {} } LostTickPolicy (Enum) Policy for handling lost ticks in timer devices. Ticks end up getting lost when, for example, the guest is paused. Values discard throw away the missed ticks and continue with future injection normally. The guest OS will see the timer jump ahead by a potentially quite significant amount all at once, as if the intervening chunk of time had simply not existed; needless to say, such a sudden jump can easily confuse a guest OS which is not specifically prepared to deal with it. Assuming the guest OS can deal correctly with the time jump, the time in the guest and in the host should now match. delay continue to deliver ticks at the normal rate. The guest OS will not notice anything is amiss, as from its point of view time will have continued to flow normally. The time in the guest should now be behind the time in the host by exactly the amount of time during which ticks have been missed. slew deliver ticks at a higher rate to catch up with the missed ticks. The guest OS will not notice anything is amiss, as from its point of view time will have continued to flow normally. Once the timer has managed to catch up with all the missing ticks, the time in the guest and in the host should match. Since 2.0 inject-nmi (Command) Injects a Non-Maskable Interrupt into the default CPU (x86/s390) or all CPUs (ppc64). The command fails when the guest doesn't support injecting. Returns If successful, nothing Since 0.14 Note prior to 2.1, this command was only supported for x86 and s390 VMs Example -> { "execute": "inject-nmi" } <- { "return": {} } KvmInfo (Object) Information about support for KVM acceleration Members enabled: boolean true if KVM acceleration is active present: boolean true if KVM acceleration is built into this executable Since 0.14 query-kvm (Command) Returns information about KVM acceleration Returns KvmInfo Since 0.14 Example -> { "execute": "query-kvm" } <- { "return": { "enabled": true, "present": true } } NumaOptionsType (Enum) Values node NUMA nodes configuration dist NUMA distance configuration (since 2.10) cpu property based CPU(s) to node mapping (Since: 2.10) hmat-lb memory latency and bandwidth information (Since: 5.0) hmat-cache memory side cache information (Since: 5.0) Since 2.1 NumaOptions (Object) A discriminated record of NUMA options. (for OptsVisitor) Members type: NumaOptionsType Not documented The members of NumaNodeOptions when type is "node" The members of NumaDistOptions when type is "dist" The members of NumaCpuOptions when type is "cpu" The members of NumaHmatLBOptions when type is "hmat-lb" The members of NumaHmatCacheOptions when type is "hmat-cache" Since 2.1 NumaNodeOptions (Object) Create a guest NUMA node. (for OptsVisitor) Members nodeid: int (optional) NUMA node ID (increase by 1 from 0 if omitted) cpus: array of int (optional) VCPUs belonging to this node (assign VCPUS round-robin if omitted) mem: int (optional) memory size of this node; mutually exclusive with memdev. Equally divide total memory among nodes if both mem and memdev are omitted. memdev: string (optional) memory backend object. If specified for one node, it must be specified for all nodes. initiator: int (optional) defined in ACPI 6.3 Chapter 5.2.27.3 Table 5-145, points to the nodeid which has the memory controller responsible for this NUMA node. This field provides additional information as to the initiator node that is closest (as in directly attached) to this node, and therefore has the best performance (since 5.0) Since 2.1 NumaDistOptions (Object) Set the distance between 2 NUMA nodes. Members src: int source NUMA node. dst: int destination NUMA node. val: int NUMA distance from source node to destination node. When a node is unreachable from another node, set the distance between them to 255. Since 2.10 X86CPURegister32 (Enum) A X86 32-bit register Values EAX Not documented EBX Not documented ECX Not documented EDX Not documented ESP Not documented EBP Not documented ESI Not documented EDI Not documented Since 1.5 X86CPUFeatureWordInfo (Object) Information about a X86 CPU feature word Members cpuid-input-eax: int Input EAX value for CPUID instruction for that feature word cpuid-input-ecx: int (optional) Input ECX value for CPUID instruction for that feature word cpuid-register: X86CPURegister32 Output register containing the feature bits features: int value of output register, containing the feature bits Since 1.5 DummyForceArrays (Object) Not used by QMP; hack to let us use X86CPUFeatureWordInfoList internally Members unused: array of X86CPUFeatureWordInfo Not documented Since 2.5 NumaCpuOptions (Object) Option "-numa cpu" overrides default cpu to node mapping. It accepts the same set of cpu properties as returned by query-hotpluggable-cpus[].props, where node-id could be used to override default node mapping. Members The members of CpuInstanceProperties Since 2.10 HmatLBMemoryHierarchy (Enum) The memory hierarchy in the System Locality Latency and Bandwidth Information Structure of HMAT (Heterogeneous Memory Attribute Table) For more information about HmatLBMemoryHierarchy, see chapter 5.2.27.4: Table 5-146: Field "Flags" of ACPI 6.3 spec. Values memory the structure represents the memory performance first-level first level of memory side cache second-level second level of memory side cache third-level third level of memory side cache Since 5.0 HmatLBDataType (Enum) Data type in the System Locality Latency and Bandwidth Information Structure of HMAT (Heterogeneous Memory Attribute Table) For more information about HmatLBDataType, see chapter 5.2.27.4: Table 5-146: Field "Data Type" of ACPI 6.3 spec. Values access-latency access latency (nanoseconds) read-latency read latency (nanoseconds) write-latency write latency (nanoseconds) access-bandwidth access bandwidth (Bytes per second) read-bandwidth read bandwidth (Bytes per second) write-bandwidth write bandwidth (Bytes per second) Since 5.0 NumaHmatLBOptions (Object) Set the system locality latency and bandwidth information between Initiator and Target proximity Domains. For more information about NumaHmatLBOptions, see chapter 5.2.27.4: Table 5-146 of ACPI 6.3 spec. Members initiator: int the Initiator Proximity Domain. target: int the Target Proximity Domain. hierarchy: HmatLBMemoryHierarchy the Memory Hierarchy. Indicates the performance of memory or side cache. data-type: HmatLBDataType presents the type of data, access/read/write latency or hit latency. latency: int (optional) the value of latency from initiator to target proximity domain, the latency unit is "ns(nanosecond)". bandwidth: int (optional) the value of bandwidth between initiator and target proximity domain, the bandwidth unit is "Bytes per second". Since 5.0 HmatCacheAssociativity (Enum) Cache associativity in the Memory Side Cache Information Structure of HMAT For more information of HmatCacheAssociativity, see chapter 5.2.27.5: Table 5-147 of ACPI 6.3 spec. Values none None (no memory side cache in this proximity domain, or cache associativity unknown) direct Direct Mapped complex Complex Cache Indexing (implementation specific) Since 5.0 HmatCacheWritePolicy (Enum) Cache write policy in the Memory Side Cache Information Structure of HMAT For more information of HmatCacheWritePolicy, see chapter 5.2.27.5: Table 5-147: Field "Cache Attributes" of ACPI 6.3 spec. Values none None (no memory side cache in this proximity domain, or cache write policy unknown) write-back Write Back (WB) write-through Write Through (WT) Since 5.0 NumaHmatCacheOptions (Object) Set the memory side cache information for a given memory domain. For more information of NumaHmatCacheOptions, see chapter 5.2.27.5: Table 5-147: Field "Cache Attributes" of ACPI 6.3 spec. Members node-id: int the memory proximity domain to which the memory belongs. size: int the size of memory side cache in bytes. level: int the cache level described in this structure. associativity: HmatCacheAssociativity the cache associativity, none/direct-mapped/complex(complex cache indexing). policy: HmatCacheWritePolicy the write policy, none/write-back/write-through. line: int the cache Line size in bytes. Since 5.0 memsave (Command) Save a portion of guest memory to a file. Arguments val: int the virtual address of the guest to start from size: int the size of memory region to save filename: string the file to save the memory to as binary data cpu-index: int (optional) the index of the virtual CPU to use for translating the virtual address (defaults to CPU 0) Returns Nothing on success Since 0.14 Notes Errors were not reliably returned until 1.1 Example -> { "execute": "memsave", "arguments": { "val": 10, "size": 100, "filename": "/tmp/virtual-mem-dump" } } <- { "return": {} } pmemsave (Command) Save a portion of guest physical memory to a file. Arguments val: int the physical address of the guest to start from size: int the size of memory region to save filename: string the file to save the memory to as binary data Returns Nothing on success Since 0.14 Notes Errors were not reliably returned until 1.1 Example -> { "execute": "pmemsave", "arguments": { "val": 10, "size": 100, "filename": "/tmp/physical-mem-dump" } } <- { "return": {} } Memdev (Object) Information about memory backend Members id: string (optional) backend's ID if backend has 'id' property (since 2.9) size: int memory backend size merge: boolean whether memory merge support is enabled dump: boolean whether memory backend's memory is included in a core dump prealloc: boolean whether memory was preallocated share: boolean whether memory is private to QEMU or shared (since 6.1) reserve: boolean (optional) whether swap space (or huge pages) was reserved if applicable. This corresponds to the user configuration and not the actual behavior implemented in the OS to perform the reservation. For example, Linux will never reserve swap space for shared file mappings. (since 6.1) host-nodes: array of int host nodes for its memory policy policy: HostMemPolicy memory policy of memory backend Since 2.1 query-memdev (Command) Returns information for all memory backends. Returns a list of Memdev. Since 2.1 Example -> { "execute": "query-memdev" } <- { "return": [ { "id": "mem1", "size": 536870912, "merge": false, "dump": true, "prealloc": false, "host-nodes": [0, 1], "policy": "bind" }, { "size": 536870912, "merge": false, "dump": true, "prealloc": true, "host-nodes": [2, 3], "policy": "preferred" } ] } CpuInstanceProperties (Object) List of properties to be used for hotplugging a CPU instance, it should be passed by management with device_add command when a CPU is being hotplugged. Members node-id: int (optional) NUMA node ID the CPU belongs to socket-id: int (optional) socket number within node/board the CPU belongs to die-id: int (optional) die number within node/board the CPU belongs to (Since 4.1) core-id: int (optional) core number within die the CPU belongs to thread-id: int (optional) thread number within core the CPU belongs to Note currently there are 5 properties that could be present but management should be prepared to pass through other properties with device_add command to allow for future interface extension. This also requires the filed names to be kept in sync with the properties passed to -device/device_add. Since 2.7 HotpluggableCPU (Object) Members type: string CPU object type for usage with device_add command props: CpuInstanceProperties list of properties to be used for hotplugging CPU vcpus-count: int number of logical VCPU threads HotpluggableCPU provides qom-path: string (optional) link to existing CPU object if CPU is present or omitted if CPU is not present. Since 2.7 query-hotpluggable-cpus (Command) TODO Better documentation; currently there is none. Returns a list of HotpluggableCPU objects. Since 2.7 Example For pseries machine type started with -smp 2,cores=2,maxcpus=4 -cpu POWER8: -> { "execute": "query-hotpluggable-cpus" } <- {"return": [ { "props": { "core": 8 }, "type": "POWER8-spapr-cpu-core", "vcpus-count": 1 }, { "props": { "core": 0 }, "type": "POWER8-spapr-cpu-core", "vcpus-count": 1, "qom-path": "/machine/unattached/device[0]"} ]}' For pc machine type started with -smp 1,maxcpus=2: -> { "execute": "query-hotpluggable-cpus" } <- {"return": [ { "type": "qemu64-x86_64-cpu", "vcpus-count": 1, "props": {"core-id": 0, "socket-id": 1, "thread-id": 0} }, { "qom-path": "/machine/unattached/device[0]", "type": "qemu64-x86_64-cpu", "vcpus-count": 1, "props": {"core-id": 0, "socket-id": 0, "thread-id": 0} } ]} For s390x-virtio-ccw machine type started with -smp 1,maxcpus=2 -cpu qemu (Since: 2.11): -> { "execute": "query-hotpluggable-cpus" } <- {"return": [ { "type": "qemu-s390x-cpu", "vcpus-count": 1, "props": { "core-id": 1 } }, { "qom-path": "/machine/unattached/device[0]", "type": "qemu-s390x-cpu", "vcpus-count": 1, "props": { "core-id": 0 } } ]} set-numa-node (Command) Runtime equivalent of '-numa' CLI option, available at preconfigure stage to configure numa mapping before initializing machine. Since 3.0 Arguments The members of NumaOptions balloon (Command) Request the balloon driver to change its balloon size. Arguments value: int the target logical size of the VM in bytes. We can deduce the size of the balloon using this formula: logical_vm_size = vm_ram_size - balloon_size From it we have: balloon_size = vm_ram_size - value Returns • Nothing on success • If the balloon driver is enabled but not functional because the KVM kernel module cannot support it, KvmMissingCap • If no balloon device is present, DeviceNotActive Notes This command just issues a request to the guest. When it returns, the balloon size may not have changed. A guest can change the balloon size independent of this command. Since 0.14 Example -> { "execute": "balloon", "arguments": { "value": 536870912 } } <- { "return": {} } With a 2.5GiB guest this command inflated the ballon to 3GiB. BalloonInfo (Object) Information about the guest balloon device. Members actual: int the logical size of the VM in bytes Formula used: logical_vm_size = vm_ram_size - balloon_size Since 0.14 query-balloon (Command) Return information about the balloon device. Returns • BalloonInfo on success • If the balloon driver is enabled but not functional because the KVM kernel module cannot support it, KvmMissingCap • If no balloon device is present, DeviceNotActive Since 0.14 Example -> { "execute": "query-balloon" } <- { "return": { "actual": 1073741824, } } BALLOON_CHANGE (Event) Emitted when the guest changes the actual BALLOON level. This value is equivalent to the actual field return by the 'query-balloon' command Arguments actual: int the logical size of the VM in bytes Formula used: logical_vm_size = vm_ram_size - balloon_size Note this event is rate-limited. Since 1.2 Example <- { "event": "BALLOON_CHANGE", "data": { "actual": 944766976 }, "timestamp": { "seconds": 1267020223, "microseconds": 435656 } } MemoryInfo (Object) Actual memory information in bytes. Members base-memory: int size of "base" memory specified with command line option -m. plugged-memory: int (optional) size of memory that can be hot-unplugged. This field is omitted if target doesn't support memory hotplug (i.e. CONFIG_MEM_DEVICE not defined at build time). Since 2.11 query-memory-size-summary (Command) Return the amount of initially allocated and present hotpluggable (if enabled) memory in bytes. Example -> { "execute": "query-memory-size-summary" } <- { "return": { "base-memory": 4294967296, "plugged-memory": 0 } } Since 2.11 PCDIMMDeviceInfo (Object) PCDIMMDevice state information Members id: string (optional) device's ID addr: int physical address, where device is mapped size: int size of memory that the device provides slot: int slot number at which device is plugged in node: int NUMA node number where device is plugged in memdev: string memory backend linked with device hotplugged: boolean true if device was hotplugged hotpluggable: boolean true if device if could be added/removed while machine is running Since 2.1 VirtioPMEMDeviceInfo (Object) VirtioPMEM state information Members id: string (optional) device's ID memaddr: int physical address in memory, where device is mapped size: int size of memory that the device provides memdev: string memory backend linked with device Since 4.1 VirtioMEMDeviceInfo (Object) VirtioMEMDevice state information Members id: string (optional) device's ID memaddr: int physical address in memory, where device is mapped requested-size: int the user requested size of the device size: int the (current) size of memory that the device provides max-size: int the maximum size of memory that the device can provide block-size: int the block size of memory that the device provides node: int NUMA node number where device is assigned to memdev: string memory backend linked with the region Since 5.1 SgxEPCDeviceInfo (Object) Sgx EPC state information Members id: string (optional) device's ID memaddr: int physical address in memory, where device is mapped size: int size of memory that the device provides memdev: string memory backend linked with device Since 6.2 MemoryDeviceInfoKind (Enum) Values dimm Not documented nvdimm Not documented virtio-pmem Not documented virtio-mem Not documented sgx-epc Not documented Since 2.1 PCDIMMDeviceInfoWrapper (Object) Members data: PCDIMMDeviceInfo Not documented Since 2.1 VirtioPMEMDeviceInfoWrapper (Object) Members data: VirtioPMEMDeviceInfo Not documented Since 2.1 VirtioMEMDeviceInfoWrapper (Object) Members data: VirtioMEMDeviceInfo Not documented Since 2.1 SgxEPCDeviceInfoWrapper (Object) Members data: SgxEPCDeviceInfo Not documented Since 6.2 MemoryDeviceInfo (Object) Union containing information about a memory device nvdimm is included since 2.12. virtio-pmem is included since 4.1. virtio-mem is included since 5.1. sgx-epc is included since 6.2. Members type: MemoryDeviceInfoKind Not documented The members of PCDIMMDeviceInfoWrapper when type is "dimm" The members of PCDIMMDeviceInfoWrapper when type is "nvdimm" The members of VirtioPMEMDeviceInfoWrapper when type is "virtio-pmem" The members of VirtioMEMDeviceInfoWrapper when type is "virtio-mem" The members of SgxEPCDeviceInfoWrapper when type is "sgx-epc" Since 2.1 SgxEPC (Object) Sgx EPC cmdline information Members memdev: string memory backend linked with device Since 6.2 SgxEPCProperties (Object) SGX properties of machine types. Members sgx-epc: array of SgxEPC list of ids of memory-backend-epc objects. Since 6.2 query-memory-devices (Command) Lists available memory devices and their state Since 2.1 Example -> { "execute": "query-memory-devices" } <- { "return": [ { "data": { "addr": 5368709120, "hotpluggable": true, "hotplugged": true, "id": "d1", "memdev": "/objects/memX", "node": 0, "size": 1073741824, "slot": 0}, "type": "dimm" } ] } MEMORY_DEVICE_SIZE_CHANGE (Event) Emitted when the size of a memory device changes. Only emitted for memory devices that can actually change the size (e.g., virtio-mem due to guest action). Arguments id: string (optional) device's ID size: int the new size of memory that the device provides qom-path: string path to the device object in the QOM tree (since 6.2) Note this event is rate-limited. Since 5.1 Example <- { "event": "MEMORY_DEVICE_SIZE_CHANGE", "data": { "id": "vm0", "size": 1073741824}, "timestamp": { "seconds": 1588168529, "microseconds": 201316 } } MEM_UNPLUG_ERROR (Event) Emitted when memory hot unplug error occurs. Arguments device: string device name msg: string Informative message Features deprecated This event is deprecated. Use DEVICE_UNPLUG_GUEST_ERROR instead. Since 2.4 Example <- { "event": "MEM_UNPLUG_ERROR" "data": { "device": "dimm1", "msg": "acpi: device unplug for unsupported device" }, "timestamp": { "seconds": 1265044230, "microseconds": 450486 } } SMPConfiguration (Object) Schema for CPU topology configuration. A missing value lets QEMU figure out a suitable value based on the ones that are provided. Members cpus: int (optional) number of virtual CPUs in the virtual machine sockets: int (optional) number of sockets in the CPU topology dies: int (optional) number of dies per socket in the CPU topology cores: int (optional) number of cores per die in the CPU topology threads: int (optional) number of threads per core in the CPU topology maxcpus: int (optional) maximum number of hotpluggable virtual CPUs in the virtual machine Since 6.1 x-query-irq (Command) Query interrupt statistics Features unstable This command is meant for debugging. Returns interrupt statistics Since 6.2 x-query-jit (Command) Query TCG compiler statistics Features unstable This command is meant for debugging. Returns TCG compiler statistics Since 6.2 If CONFIG_TCG x-query-numa (Command) Query NUMA topology information Features unstable This command is meant for debugging. Returns topology information Since 6.2 x-query-opcount (Command) Query TCG opcode counters Features unstable This command is meant for debugging. Returns TCG opcode counters Since 6.2 If CONFIG_TCG x-query-profile (Command) Query TCG profiling information Features unstable This command is meant for debugging. Returns profile information Since 6.2 x-query-ramblock (Command) Query system ramblock information Features unstable This command is meant for debugging. Returns system ramblock information Since 6.2 x-query-rdma (Command) Query RDMA state Features unstable This command is meant for debugging. Returns RDMA state Since 6.2 x-query-roms (Command) Query information on the registered ROMS Features unstable This command is meant for debugging. Returns registered ROMs Since 6.2 x-query-usb (Command) Query information on the USB devices Features unstable This command is meant for debugging. Returns USB device information Since 6.2 CpuModelInfo (Object) Virtual CPU model. A CPU model consists of the name of a CPU definition, to which delta changes are applied (e.g. features added/removed). Most magic values that an architecture might require should be hidden behind the name. However, if required, architectures can expose relevant properties. Members name: string the name of the CPU definition the model is based on props: value (optional) a dictionary of QOM properties to be applied Since 2.8 CpuModelExpansionType (Enum) An enumeration of CPU model expansion types. Values static Expand to a static CPU model, a combination of a static base model name and property delta changes. As the static base model will never change, the expanded CPU model will be the same, independent of QEMU version, machine type, machine options, and accelerator options. Therefore, the resulting model can be used by tooling without having to specify a compatibility machine - e.g. when displaying the "host" model. The static CPU models are migration-safe. full Expand all properties. The produced model is not guaranteed to be migration-safe, but allows tooling to get an insight and work with model details. Note When a non-migration-safe CPU model is expanded in static mode, some features enabled by the CPU model may be omitted, because they can't be implemented by a static CPU model definition (e.g. cache info passthrough and PMU passthrough in x86). If you need an accurate representation of the features enabled by a non-migration-safe CPU model, use full. If you need a static representation that will keep ABI compatibility even when changing QEMU version or machine-type, use static (but keep in mind that some features may be omitted). Since 2.8 CpuModelCompareResult (Enum) An enumeration of CPU model comparison results. The result is usually calculated using e.g. CPU features or CPU generations. Values incompatible If model A is incompatible to model B, model A is not guaranteed to run where model B runs and the other way around. identical If model A is identical to model B, model A is guaranteed to run where model B runs and the other way around. superset If model A is a superset of model B, model B is guaranteed to run where model A runs. There are no guarantees about the other way. subset If model A is a subset of model B, model A is guaranteed to run where model B runs. There are no guarantees about the other way. Since 2.8 CpuModelBaselineInfo (Object) The result of a CPU model baseline. Members model: CpuModelInfo the baselined CpuModelInfo. Since 2.8 If TARGET_S390X CpuModelCompareInfo (Object) The result of a CPU model comparison. Members result: CpuModelCompareResult The result of the compare operation. responsible-properties: array of string List of properties that led to the comparison result not being identical. responsible-properties is a list of QOM property names that led to both CPUs not being detected as identical. For identical models, this list is empty. If a QOM property is read-only, that means there's no known way to make the CPU models identical. If the special property name "type" is included, the models are by definition not identical and cannot be made identical. Since 2.8 If TARGET_S390X query-cpu-model-comparison (Command) Compares two CPU models, returning how they compare in a specific configuration. The results indicates how both models compare regarding runnability. This result can be used by tooling to make decisions if a certain CPU model will run in a certain configuration or if a compatible CPU model has to be created by baselining. Usually, a CPU model is compared against the maximum possible CPU model of a certain configuration (e.g. the "host" model for KVM). If that CPU model is identical or a subset, it will run in that configuration. The result returned by this command may be affected by: • QEMU version: CPU models may look different depending on the QEMU version. (Except for CPU models reported as "static" in query-cpu-definitions.) • machine-type: CPU model may look different depending on the machine-type. (Except for CPU models reported as "static" in query-cpu-definitions.) • machine options (including accelerator): in some architectures, CPU models may look different depending on machine and accelerator options. (Except for CPU models reported as "static" in query-cpu-definitions.) • "-cpu" arguments and global properties: arguments to the -cpu option and global properties may affect expansion of CPU models. Using query-cpu-model-expansion while using these is not advised. Some architectures may not support comparing CPU models. s390x supports comparing CPU models. Arguments modela: CpuModelInfo Not documented modelb: CpuModelInfo Not documented Returns a CpuModelBaselineInfo. Returns an error if comparing CPU models is not supported, if a model cannot be used, if a model contains an unknown cpu definition name, unknown properties or properties with wrong types. Note this command isn't specific to s390x, but is only implemented on this architecture currently. Since 2.8 If TARGET_S390X query-cpu-model-baseline (Command) Baseline two CPU models, creating a compatible third model. The created model will always be a static, migration-safe CPU model (see "static" CPU model expansion for details). This interface can be used by tooling to create a compatible CPU model out two CPU models. The created CPU model will be identical to or a subset of both CPU models when comparing them. Therefore, the created CPU model is guaranteed to run where the given CPU models run. The result returned by this command may be affected by: • QEMU version: CPU models may look different depending on the QEMU version. (Except for CPU models reported as "static" in query-cpu-definitions.) • machine-type: CPU model may look different depending on the machine-type. (Except for CPU models reported as "static" in query-cpu-definitions.) • machine options (including accelerator): in some architectures, CPU models may look different depending on machine and accelerator options. (Except for CPU models reported as "static" in query-cpu-definitions.) • "-cpu" arguments and global properties: arguments to the -cpu option and global properties may affect expansion of CPU models. Using query-cpu-model-expansion while using these is not advised. Some architectures may not support baselining CPU models. s390x supports baselining CPU models. Arguments modela: CpuModelInfo Not documented modelb: CpuModelInfo Not documented Returns a CpuModelBaselineInfo. Returns an error if baselining CPU models is not supported, if a model cannot be used, if a model contains an unknown cpu definition name, unknown properties or properties with wrong types. Note this command isn't specific to s390x, but is only implemented on this architecture currently. Since 2.8 If TARGET_S390X CpuModelExpansionInfo (Object) The result of a cpu model expansion. Members model: CpuModelInfo the expanded CpuModelInfo. Since 2.8 If TARGET_S390X or TARGET_I386 or TARGET_ARM query-cpu-model-expansion (Command) Expands a given CPU model (or a combination of CPU model + additional options) to different granularities, allowing tooling to get an understanding what a specific CPU model looks like in QEMU under a certain configuration. This interface can be used to query the "host" CPU model. The data returned by this command may be affected by: • QEMU version: CPU models may look different depending on the QEMU version. (Except for CPU models reported as "static" in query-cpu-definitions.) • machine-type: CPU model may look different depending on the machine-type. (Except for CPU models reported as "static" in query-cpu-definitions.) • machine options (including accelerator): in some architectures, CPU models may look different depending on machine and accelerator options. (Except for CPU models reported as "static" in query-cpu-definitions.) • "-cpu" arguments and global properties: arguments to the -cpu option and global properties may affect expansion of CPU models. Using query-cpu-model-expansion while using these is not advised. Some architectures may not support all expansion types. s390x supports "full" and "static". Arm only supports "full". Arguments type: CpuModelExpansionType Not documented model: CpuModelInfo Not documented Returns a CpuModelExpansionInfo. Returns an error if expanding CPU models is not supported, if the model cannot be expanded, if the model contains an unknown CPU definition name, unknown properties or properties with a wrong type. Also returns an error if an expansion type is not supported. Since 2.8 If TARGET_S390X or TARGET_I386 or TARGET_ARM CpuDefinitionInfo (Object) Virtual CPU definition. Members name: string the name of the CPU definition migration-safe: boolean (optional) whether a CPU definition can be safely used for migration in combination with a QEMU compatibility machine when migrating between different QEMU versions and between hosts with different sets of (hardware or software) capabilities. If not provided, information is not available and callers should not assume the CPU definition to be migration-safe. (since 2.8) static: boolean whether a CPU definition is static and will not change depending on QEMU version, machine type, machine options and accelerator options. A static model is always migration-safe. (since 2.8) unavailable-features: array of string (optional) List of properties that prevent the CPU model from running in the current host. (since 2.8) typename: string Type name that can be used as argument to device-list-properties, to introspect properties configurable using -cpu or -global. (since 2.9) alias-of: string (optional) Name of CPU model this model is an alias for. The target of the CPU model alias may change depending on the machine type. Management software is supposed to translate CPU model aliases in the VM configuration, because aliases may stop being migration-safe in the future (since 4.1) deprecated: boolean If true, this CPU model is deprecated and may be removed in in some future version of QEMU according to the QEMU deprecation policy. (since 5.2) unavailable-features is a list of QOM property names that represent CPU model attributes that prevent the CPU from running. If the QOM property is read-only, that means there's no known way to make the CPU model run in the current host. Implementations that choose not to provide specific information return the property name "type". If the property is read-write, it means that it MAY be possible to run the CPU model in the current host if that property is changed. Management software can use it as hints to suggest or choose an alternative for the user, or just to generate meaningful error messages explaining why the CPU model can't be used. If unavailable-features is an empty list, the CPU model is runnable using the current host and machine-type. If unavailable-features is not present, runnability information for the CPU is not available. Since 1.2 If TARGET_PPC or TARGET_ARM or TARGET_I386 or TARGET_S390X or TARGET_MIPS query-cpu-definitions (Command) Return a list of supported virtual CPU definitions Returns a list of CpuDefInfo Since 1.2 If TARGET_PPC or TARGET_ARM or TARGET_I386 or TARGET_S390X or TARGET_MIPS
RECORD/REPLAY
ReplayMode (Enum) Mode of the replay subsystem. Values none normal execution mode. Replay or record are not enabled. record record mode. All non-deterministic data is written into the replay log. play replay mode. Non-deterministic data required for system execution is read from the log. Since 2.5 ReplayInfo (Object) Record/replay information. Members mode: ReplayMode current mode. filename: string (optional) name of the record/replay log file. It is present only in record or replay modes, when the log is recorded or replayed. icount: int current number of executed instructions. Since 5.2 query-replay (Command) Retrieve the record/replay information. It includes current instruction count which may be used for replay-break and replay-seek commands. Returns record/replay information. Since 5.2 Example -> { "execute": "query-replay" } <- { "return": { "mode": "play", "filename": "log.rr", "icount": 220414 } } replay-break (Command) Set replay breakpoint at instruction count icount. Execution stops when the specified instruction is reached. There can be at most one breakpoint. When breakpoint is set, any prior one is removed. The breakpoint may be set only in replay mode and only "in the future", i.e. at instruction counts greater than the current one. The current instruction count can be observed with query-replay. Arguments icount: int instruction count to stop at Since 5.2 Example -> { "execute": "replay-break", "data": { "icount": 220414 } } replay-delete-break (Command) Remove replay breakpoint which was set with replay-break. The command is ignored when there are no replay breakpoints. Since 5.2 Example -> { "execute": "replay-delete-break" } replay-seek (Command) Automatically proceed to the instruction count icount, when replaying the execution. The command automatically loads nearest snapshot and replays the execution to find the desired instruction. When there is no preceding snapshot or the execution is not replayed, then the command fails. icount for the reference may be obtained with query-replay command. Arguments icount: int target instruction count Since 5.2 Example -> { "execute": "replay-seek", "data": { "icount": 220414 } }
YANK FEATURE
YankInstanceType (Enum) An enumeration of yank instance types. See YankInstance for more information. Values block-node Not documented chardev Not documented migration Not documented Since 6.0 YankInstanceBlockNode (Object) Specifies which block graph node to yank. See YankInstance for more information. Members node-name: string the name of the block graph node Since 6.0 YankInstanceChardev (Object) Specifies which character device to yank. See YankInstance for more information. Members id: string the chardev's ID Since 6.0 YankInstance (Object) A yank instance can be yanked with the yank qmp command to recover from a hanging QEMU. Currently implemented yank instances: • nbd block device: Yanking it will shut down the connection to the nbd server without attempting to reconnect. • socket chardev: Yanking it will shut down the connected socket. • migration: Yanking it will shut down all migration connections. Unlike migrate_cancel, it will not notify the migration process, so migration will go into failed state, instead of cancelled state. yank should be used to recover from hangs. Members type: YankInstanceType Not documented The members of YankInstanceBlockNode when type is "block-node" The members of YankInstanceChardev when type is "chardev" Since 6.0 yank (Command) Try to recover from hanging QEMU by yanking the specified instances. See YankInstance for more information. Takes a list of YankInstance as argument. Arguments instances: array of YankInstance Not documented Returns • Nothing on success • DeviceNotFound error, if any of the YankInstances doesn't exist Example -> { "execute": "yank", "arguments": { "instances": [ { "type": "block-node", "node-name": "nbd0" } ] } } <- { "return": {} } Since 6.0 query-yank (Command) Query yank instances. See YankInstance for more information. Returns list of YankInstance Example -> { "execute": "query-yank" } <- { "return": [ { "type": "block-node", "node-name": "nbd0" } ] } Since 6.0
MISCELLANEA
add_client (Command) Allow client connections for VNC, Spice and socket based character devices to be passed in to QEMU via SCM_RIGHTS. Arguments protocol: string protocol name. Valid names are "vnc", "spice" or the name of a character device (eg. from -chardev id=XXXX) fdname: string file descriptor name previously passed via 'getfd' command skipauth: boolean (optional) whether to skip authentication. Only applies to "vnc" and "spice" protocols tls: boolean (optional) whether to perform TLS. Only applies to the "spice" protocol Returns nothing on success. Since 0.14 Example -> { "execute": "add_client", "arguments": { "protocol": "vnc", "fdname": "myclient" } } <- { "return": {} } NameInfo (Object) Guest name information. Members name: string (optional) The name of the guest Since 0.14 query-name (Command) Return the name information of a guest. Returns NameInfo of the guest Since 0.14 Example -> { "execute": "query-name" } <- { "return": { "name": "qemu-name" } } IOThreadInfo (Object) Information about an iothread Members id: string the identifier of the iothread thread-id: int ID of the underlying host thread poll-max-ns: int maximum polling time in ns, 0 means polling is disabled (since 2.9) poll-grow: int how many ns will be added to polling time, 0 means that it's not configured (since 2.9) poll-shrink: int how many ns will be removed from polling time, 0 means that it's not configured (since 2.9) aio-max-batch: int maximum number of requests in a batch for the AIO engine, 0 means that the engine will use its default (since 6.1) Since 2.0 query-iothreads (Command) Returns a list of information about each iothread. Note this list excludes the QEMU main loop thread, which is not declared using the -object iothread command-line option. It is always the main thread of the process. Returns a list of IOThreadInfo for each iothread Since 2.0 Example -> { "execute": "query-iothreads" } <- { "return": [ { "id":"iothread0", "thread-id":3134 }, { "id":"iothread1", "thread-id":3135 } ] } stop (Command) Stop all guest VCPU execution. Since 0.14 Notes This function will succeed even if the guest is already in the stopped state. In "inmigrate" state, it will ensure that the guest remains paused once migration finishes, as if the -S option was passed on the command line. Example -> { "execute": "stop" } <- { "return": {} } cont (Command) Resume guest VCPU execution. Since 0.14 Returns If successful, nothing Notes This command will succeed if the guest is currently running. It will also succeed if the guest is in the "inmigrate" state; in this case, the effect of the command is to make sure the guest starts once migration finishes, removing the effect of the -S command line option if it was passed. Example -> { "execute": "cont" } <- { "return": {} } x-exit-preconfig (Command) Exit from "preconfig" state This command makes QEMU exit the preconfig state and proceed with VM initialization using configuration data provided on the command line and via the QMP monitor during the preconfig state. The command is only available during the preconfig state (i.e. when the --preconfig command line option was in use). Features unstable This command is experimental. Since 3.0 Returns nothing Example -> { "execute": "x-exit-preconfig" } <- { "return": {} } human-monitor-command (Command) Execute a command on the human monitor and return the output. Arguments command-line: string the command to execute in the human monitor cpu-index: int (optional) The CPU to use for commands that require an implicit CPU Features savevm-monitor-nodes If present, HMP command savevm only snapshots monitor-owned nodes if they have no parents. This allows the use of 'savevm' with -blockdev. (since 4.2) Returns the output of the command as a string Since 0.14 Notes This command only exists as a stop-gap. Its use is highly discouraged. The semantics of this command are not guaranteed: this means that command names, arguments and responses can change or be removed at ANY time. Applications that rely on long term stability guarantees should NOT use this command. Known limitations: • This command is stateless, this means that commands that depend on state information (such as getfd) might not work • Commands that prompt the user for data don't currently work Example -> { "execute": "human-monitor-command", "arguments": { "command-line": "info kvm" } } <- { "return": "kvm support: enabled\r\n" } getfd (Command) Receive a file descriptor via SCM rights and assign it a name Arguments fdname: string file descriptor name Returns Nothing on success Since 0.14 Notes If fdname already exists, the file descriptor assigned to it will be closed and replaced by the received file descriptor. The 'closefd' command can be used to explicitly close the file descriptor when it is no longer needed. Example -> { "execute": "getfd", "arguments": { "fdname": "fd1" } } <- { "return": {} } closefd (Command) Close a file descriptor previously passed via SCM rights Arguments fdname: string file descriptor name Returns Nothing on success Since 0.14 Example -> { "execute": "closefd", "arguments": { "fdname": "fd1" } } <- { "return": {} } AddfdInfo (Object) Information about a file descriptor that was added to an fd set. Members fdset-id: int The ID of the fd set that fd was added to. fd: int The file descriptor that was received via SCM rights and added to the fd set. Since 1.2 add-fd (Command) Add a file descriptor, that was passed via SCM rights, to an fd set. Arguments fdset-id: int (optional) The ID of the fd set to add the file descriptor to. opaque: string (optional) A free-form string that can be used to describe the fd. Returns • AddfdInfo on success • If file descriptor was not received, FdNotSupplied • If fdset-id is a negative value, InvalidParameterValue Notes The list of fd sets is shared by all monitor connections. If fdset-id is not specified, a new fd set will be created. Since 1.2 Example -> { "execute": "add-fd", "arguments": { "fdset-id": 1 } } <- { "return": { "fdset-id": 1, "fd": 3 } } remove-fd (Command) Remove a file descriptor from an fd set. Arguments fdset-id: int The ID of the fd set that the file descriptor belongs to. fd: int (optional) The file descriptor that is to be removed. Returns • Nothing on success • If fdset-id or fd is not found, FdNotFound Since 1.2 Notes The list of fd sets is shared by all monitor connections. If fd is not specified, all file descriptors in fdset-id will be removed. Example -> { "execute": "remove-fd", "arguments": { "fdset-id": 1, "fd": 3 } } <- { "return": {} } FdsetFdInfo (Object) Information about a file descriptor that belongs to an fd set. Members fd: int The file descriptor value. opaque: string (optional) A free-form string that can be used to describe the fd. Since 1.2 FdsetInfo (Object) Information about an fd set. Members fdset-id: int The ID of the fd set. fds: array of FdsetFdInfo A list of file descriptors that belong to this fd set. Since 1.2 query-fdsets (Command) Return information describing all fd sets. Returns A list of FdsetInfo Since 1.2 Note The list of fd sets is shared by all monitor connections. Example -> { "execute": "query-fdsets" } <- { "return": [ { "fds": [ { "fd": 30, "opaque": "rdonly:/path/to/file" }, { "fd": 24, "opaque": "rdwr:/path/to/file" } ], "fdset-id": 1 }, { "fds": [ { "fd": 28 }, { "fd": 29 } ], "fdset-id": 0 } ] } CommandLineParameterType (Enum) Possible types for an option parameter. Values string accepts a character string boolean accepts "on" or "off" number accepts a number size accepts a number followed by an optional suffix (K)ilo, (M)ega, (G)iga, (T)era Since 1.5 CommandLineParameterInfo (Object) Details about a single parameter of a command line option. Members name: string parameter name type: CommandLineParameterType parameter CommandLineParameterType help: string (optional) human readable text string, not suitable for parsing. default: string (optional) default value string (since 2.1) Since 1.5 CommandLineOptionInfo (Object) Details about a command line option, including its list of parameter details Members option: string option name parameters: array of CommandLineParameterInfo an array of CommandLineParameterInfo Since 1.5 query-command-line-options (Command) Query command line option schema. Arguments option: string (optional) option name Returns list of CommandLineOptionInfo for all options (or for the given option). Returns an error if the given option doesn't exist. Since 1.5 Example -> { "execute": "query-command-line-options", "arguments": { "option": "option-rom" } } <- { "return": [ { "parameters": [ { "name": "romfile", "type": "string" }, { "name": "bootindex", "type": "number" } ], "option": "option-rom" } ] } RTC_CHANGE (Event) Emitted when the guest changes the RTC time. Arguments offset: int offset between base RTC clock (as specified by -rtc base), and new RTC clock value Note This event is rate-limited. Since 0.13 Example <- { "event": "RTC_CHANGE", "data": { "offset": 78 }, "timestamp": { "seconds": 1267020223, "microseconds": 435656 } } If TARGET_ALPHA or TARGET_ARM or TARGET_HPPA or TARGET_I386 or TARGET_MIPS or TARGET_MIPS64 or TARGET_PPC or TARGET_PPC64 or TARGET_S390X or TARGET_SH4 or TARGET_SPARC rtc-reset-reinjection (Command) This command will reset the RTC interrupt reinjection backlog. Can be used if another mechanism to synchronize guest time is in effect, for example QEMU guest agent's guest-set-time command. Since 2.1 Example -> { "execute": "rtc-reset-reinjection" } <- { "return": {} } If TARGET_I386 SevState (Enum) An enumeration of SEV state information used during query-sev. Values uninit The guest is uninitialized. launch-update The guest is currently being launched; plaintext data and register state is being imported. launch-secret The guest is currently being launched; ciphertext data is being imported. running The guest is fully launched or migrated in. send-update The guest is currently being migrated out to another machine. receive-update The guest is currently being migrated from another machine. Since 2.12 If TARGET_I386 SevInfo (Object) Information about Secure Encrypted Virtualization (SEV) support Members enabled: boolean true if SEV is active api-major: int SEV API major version api-minor: int SEV API minor version build-id: int SEV FW build id policy: int SEV policy value state: SevState SEV guest state handle: int SEV firmware handle Since 2.12 If TARGET_I386 query-sev (Command) Returns information about SEV Returns SevInfo Since 2.12 Example -> { "execute": "query-sev" } <- { "return": { "enabled": true, "api-major" : 0, "api-minor" : 0, "build-id" : 0, "policy" : 0, "state" : "running", "handle" : 1 } } If TARGET_I386 SevLaunchMeasureInfo (Object) SEV Guest Launch measurement information Members data: string the measurement value encoded in base64 Since 2.12 If TARGET_I386 query-sev-launch-measure (Command) Query the SEV guest launch information. Returns The SevLaunchMeasureInfo for the guest Since 2.12 Example -> { "execute": "query-sev-launch-measure" } <- { "return": { "data": "4l8LXeNlSPUDlXPJG5966/8%YZ" } } If TARGET_I386 SevCapability (Object) The struct describes capability for a Secure Encrypted Virtualization feature. Members pdh: string Platform Diffie-Hellman key (base64 encoded) cert-chain: string PDH certificate chain (base64 encoded) cbitpos: int C-bit location in page table entry reduced-phys-bits: int Number of physical Address bit reduction when SEV is enabled Since 2.12 If TARGET_I386 query-sev-capabilities (Command) This command is used to get the SEV capabilities, and is supported on AMD X86 platforms only. Returns SevCapability objects. Since 2.12 Example -> { "execute": "query-sev-capabilities" } <- { "return": { "pdh": "8CCDD8DDD", "cert-chain": "888CCCDDDEE", "cbitpos": 47, "reduced-phys-bits": 5}} If TARGET_I386 sev-inject-launch-secret (Command) This command injects a secret blob into memory of SEV guest. Arguments packet-header: string the launch secret packet header encoded in base64 secret: string the launch secret data to be injected encoded in base64 gpa: int (optional) the guest physical address where secret will be injected. Since 6.0 If TARGET_I386 SevAttestationReport (Object) The struct describes attestation report for a Secure Encrypted Virtualization feature. Members data: string guest attestation report (base64 encoded) Since 6.1 If TARGET_I386 query-sev-attestation-report (Command) This command is used to get the SEV attestation report, and is supported on AMD X86 platforms only. Arguments mnonce: string a random 16 bytes value encoded in base64 (it will be included in report) Returns SevAttestationReport objects. Since 6.1 Example -> { "execute" : "query-sev-attestation-report", "arguments": { "mnonce": "aaaaaaa" } } <- { "return" : { "data": "aaaaaaaabbbddddd"} } If TARGET_I386 dump-skeys (Command) Dump guest's storage keys Arguments filename: string the path to the file to dump to This command is only supported on s390 architecture. Since 2.5 Example -> { "execute": "dump-skeys", "arguments": { "filename": "/tmp/skeys" } } <- { "return": {} } If TARGET_S390X GICCapability (Object) The struct describes capability for a specific GIC (Generic Interrupt Controller) version. These bits are not only decided by QEMU/KVM software version, but also decided by the hardware that the program is running upon. Members version: int version of GIC to be described. Currently, only 2 and 3 are supported. emulated: boolean whether current QEMU/hardware supports emulated GIC device in user space. kernel: boolean whether current QEMU/hardware supports hardware accelerated GIC device in kernel. Since 2.6 If TARGET_ARM query-gic-capabilities (Command) This command is ARM-only. It will return a list of GICCapability objects that describe its capability bits. Returns a list of GICCapability objects. Since 2.6 Example -> { "execute": "query-gic-capabilities" } <- { "return": [{ "version": 2, "emulated": true, "kernel": false }, { "version": 3, "emulated": false, "kernel": true } ] } If TARGET_ARM SGXInfo (Object) Information about intel Safe Guard eXtension (SGX) support Members sgx: boolean true if SGX is supported sgx1: boolean true if SGX1 is supported sgx2: boolean true if SGX2 is supported flc: boolean true if FLC is supported section-size: int The EPC section size for guest Since 6.2 If TARGET_I386 query-sgx (Command) Returns information about SGX Returns SGXInfo Since 6.2 Example -> { "execute": "query-sgx" } <- { "return": { "sgx": true, "sgx1" : true, "sgx2" : true, "flc": true, "section-size" : 0 } } If TARGET_I386 query-sgx-capabilities (Command) Returns information from host SGX capabilities Returns SGXInfo Since 6.2 Example -> { "execute": "query-sgx-capabilities" } <- { "return": { "sgx": true, "sgx1" : true, "sgx2" : true, "flc": true, "section-size" : 0 } } If TARGET_I386
AUDIO
AudiodevPerDirectionOptions (Object) General audio backend options that are used for both playback and recording. Members mixing-engine: boolean (optional) use QEMU's mixing engine to mix all streams inside QEMU and convert audio formats when not supported by the backend. When set to off, fixed-settings must be also off (default on, since 4.2) fixed-settings: boolean (optional) use fixed settings for host input/output. When off, frequency, channels and format must not be specified (default true) frequency: int (optional) frequency to use when using fixed settings (default 44100) channels: int (optional) number of channels when using fixed settings (default 2) voices: int (optional) number of voices to use (default 1) format: AudioFormat (optional) sample format to use when using fixed settings (default s16) buffer-length: int (optional) the buffer length in microseconds Since 4.0 AudiodevGenericOptions (Object) Generic driver-specific options. Members in: AudiodevPerDirectionOptions (optional) options of the capture stream out: AudiodevPerDirectionOptions (optional) options of the playback stream Since 4.0 AudiodevAlsaPerDirectionOptions (Object) Options of the ALSA backend that are used for both playback and recording. Members dev: string (optional) the name of the ALSA device to use (default 'default') period-length: int (optional) the period length in microseconds try-poll: boolean (optional) attempt to use poll mode, falling back to non-polling access on failure (default true) The members of AudiodevPerDirectionOptions Since 4.0 AudiodevAlsaOptions (Object) Options of the ALSA audio backend. Members in: AudiodevAlsaPerDirectionOptions (optional) options of the capture stream out: AudiodevAlsaPerDirectionOptions (optional) options of the playback stream threshold: int (optional) set the threshold (in microseconds) when playback starts Since 4.0 AudiodevCoreaudioPerDirectionOptions (Object) Options of the Core Audio backend that are used for both playback and recording. Members buffer-count: int (optional) number of buffers The members of AudiodevPerDirectionOptions Since 4.0 AudiodevCoreaudioOptions (Object) Options of the coreaudio audio backend. Members in: AudiodevCoreaudioPerDirectionOptions (optional) options of the capture stream out: AudiodevCoreaudioPerDirectionOptions (optional) options of the playback stream Since 4.0 AudiodevDsoundOptions (Object) Options of the DirectSound audio backend. Members in: AudiodevPerDirectionOptions (optional) options of the capture stream out: AudiodevPerDirectionOptions (optional) options of the playback stream latency: int (optional) add extra latency to playback in microseconds (default 10000) Since 4.0 AudiodevJackPerDirectionOptions (Object) Options of the JACK backend that are used for both playback and recording. Members server-name: string (optional) select from among several possible concurrent server instances (default: environment variable $JACK_DEFAULT_SERVER if set, else "default") client-name: string (optional) the client name to use. The server will modify this name to create a unique variant, if needed unless exact-name is true (default: the guest's name) connect-ports: string (optional) if set, a regular expression of JACK client port name(s) to monitor for and automatically connect to start-server: boolean (optional) start a jack server process if one is not already present (default: false) exact-name: boolean (optional) use the exact name requested otherwise JACK automatically generates a unique one, if needed (default: false) The members of AudiodevPerDirectionOptions Since 5.1 AudiodevJackOptions (Object) Options of the JACK audio backend. Members in: AudiodevJackPerDirectionOptions (optional) options of the capture stream out: AudiodevJackPerDirectionOptions (optional) options of the playback stream Since 5.1 AudiodevOssPerDirectionOptions (Object) Options of the OSS backend that are used for both playback and recording. Members dev: string (optional) file name of the OSS device (default '/dev/dsp') buffer-count: int (optional) number of buffers try-poll: boolean (optional) attempt to use poll mode, falling back to non-polling access on failure (default true) The members of AudiodevPerDirectionOptions Since 4.0 AudiodevOssOptions (Object) Options of the OSS audio backend. Members in: AudiodevOssPerDirectionOptions (optional) options of the capture stream out: AudiodevOssPerDirectionOptions (optional) options of the playback stream try-mmap: boolean (optional) try using memory-mapped access, falling back to non-memory-mapped access on failure (default true) exclusive: boolean (optional) open device in exclusive mode (vmix won't work) (default false) dsp-policy: int (optional) set the timing policy of the device (between 0 and 10, where smaller number means smaller latency but higher CPU usage) or -1 to use fragment mode (option ignored on some platforms) (default 5) Since 4.0 AudiodevPaPerDirectionOptions (Object) Options of the Pulseaudio backend that are used for both playback and recording. Members name: string (optional) name of the sink/source to use stream-name: string (optional) name of the PulseAudio stream created by qemu. Can be used to identify the stream in PulseAudio when you create multiple PulseAudio devices or run multiple qemu instances (default: audiodev's id, since 4.2) latency: int (optional) latency you want PulseAudio to achieve in microseconds (default 15000) The members of AudiodevPerDirectionOptions Since 4.0 AudiodevPaOptions (Object) Options of the PulseAudio audio backend. Members in: AudiodevPaPerDirectionOptions (optional) options of the capture stream out: AudiodevPaPerDirectionOptions (optional) options of the playback stream server: string (optional) PulseAudio server address (default: let PulseAudio choose) Since 4.0 AudiodevSdlPerDirectionOptions (Object) Options of the SDL audio backend that are used for both playback and recording. Members buffer-count: int (optional) number of buffers (default 4) The members of AudiodevPerDirectionOptions Since 6.0 AudiodevSdlOptions (Object) Options of the SDL audio backend. Members in: AudiodevSdlPerDirectionOptions (optional) options of the recording stream out: AudiodevSdlPerDirectionOptions (optional) options of the playback stream Since 6.0 AudiodevWavOptions (Object) Options of the wav audio backend. Members in: AudiodevPerDirectionOptions (optional) options of the capture stream out: AudiodevPerDirectionOptions (optional) options of the playback stream path: string (optional) name of the wav file to record (default 'qemu.wav') Since 4.0 AudioFormat (Enum) An enumeration of possible audio formats. Values u8 unsigned 8 bit integer s8 signed 8 bit integer u16 unsigned 16 bit integer s16 signed 16 bit integer u32 unsigned 32 bit integer s32 signed 32 bit integer f32 single precision floating-point (since 5.0) Since 4.0 AudiodevDriver (Enum) An enumeration of possible audio backend drivers. Values jack JACK audio backend (since 5.1) none Not documented alsa Not documented coreaudio Not documented dsound Not documented oss Not documented pa Not documented sdl Not documented spice Not documented wav Not documented Since 4.0 Audiodev (Object) Options of an audio backend. Members id: string identifier of the backend driver: AudiodevDriver the backend driver to use timer-period: int (optional) timer period (in microseconds, 0: use lowest possible) The members of AudiodevGenericOptions when driver is "none" The members of AudiodevAlsaOptions when driver is "alsa" The members of AudiodevCoreaudioOptions when driver is "coreaudio" The members of AudiodevDsoundOptions when driver is "dsound" The members of AudiodevJackOptions when driver is "jack" The members of AudiodevOssOptions when driver is "oss" The members of AudiodevPaOptions when driver is "pa" The members of AudiodevSdlOptions when driver is "sdl" The members of AudiodevGenericOptions when driver is "spice" The members of AudiodevWavOptions when driver is "wav" Since 4.0
ACPI
AcpiTableOptions (Object) Specify an ACPI table on the command line to load. At most one of file and data can be specified. The list of files specified by any one of them is loaded and concatenated in order. If both are omitted, data is implied. Other fields / optargs can be used to override fields of the generic ACPI table header; refer to the ACPI specification 5.0, section 5.2.6 System Description Table Header. If a header field is not overridden, then the corresponding value from the concatenated blob is used (in case of file), or it is filled in with a hard-coded value (in case of data). String fields are copied into the matching ACPI member from lowest address upwards, and silently truncated / NUL-padded to length. Members sig: string (optional) table signature / identifier (4 bytes) rev: int (optional) table revision number (dependent on signature, 1 byte) oem_id: string (optional) OEM identifier (6 bytes) oem_table_id: string (optional) OEM table identifier (8 bytes) oem_rev: int (optional) OEM-supplied revision number (4 bytes) asl_compiler_id: string (optional) identifier of the utility that created the table (4 bytes) asl_compiler_rev: int (optional) revision number of the utility that created the table (4 bytes) file: string (optional) colon (:) separated list of pathnames to load and concatenate as table data. The resultant binary blob is expected to have an ACPI table header. At least one file is required. This field excludes data. data: string (optional) colon (:) separated list of pathnames to load and concatenate as table data. The resultant binary blob must not have an ACPI table header. At least one file is required. This field excludes file. Since 1.5 ACPISlotType (Enum) Values DIMM memory slot CPU logical CPU slot (since 2.7) ACPIOSTInfo (Object) OSPM Status Indication for a device For description of possible values of source and status fields see "_OST (OSPM Status Indication)" chapter of ACPI5.0 spec. Members device: string (optional) device ID associated with slot slot: string slot ID, unique per slot of a given slot-type slot-type: ACPISlotType type of the slot source: int an integer containing the source event status: int an integer containing the status code Since 2.1 query-acpi-ospm-status (Command) Return a list of ACPIOSTInfo for devices that support status reporting via ACPI _OST method. Since 2.1 Example -> { "execute": "query-acpi-ospm-status" } <- { "return": [ { "device": "d1", "slot": "0", "slot-type": "DIMM", "source": 1, "status": 0}, { "slot": "1", "slot-type": "DIMM", "source": 0, "status": 0}, { "slot": "2", "slot-type": "DIMM", "source": 0, "status": 0}, { "slot": "3", "slot-type": "DIMM", "source": 0, "status": 0} ]} ACPI_DEVICE_OST (Event) Emitted when guest executes ACPI _OST method. Arguments info: ACPIOSTInfo OSPM Status Indication Since 2.1 Example <- { "event": "ACPI_DEVICE_OST", "data": { "device": "d1", "slot": "0", "slot-type": "DIMM", "source": 1, "status": 0 } }
PCI
PciMemoryRange (Object) A PCI device memory region Members base: int the starting address (guest physical) limit: int the ending address (guest physical) Since 0.14 PciMemoryRegion (Object) Information about a PCI device I/O region. Members bar: int the index of the Base Address Register for this region type: string • 'io' if the region is a PIO region • 'memory' if the region is a MMIO region size: int memory size prefetch: boolean (optional) if type is 'memory', true if the memory is prefetchable mem_type_64: boolean (optional) if type is 'memory', true if the BAR is 64-bit address: int Not documented Since 0.14 PciBusInfo (Object) Information about a bus of a PCI Bridge device Members number: int primary bus interface number. This should be the number of the bus the device resides on. secondary: int secondary bus interface number. This is the number of the main bus for the bridge subordinate: int This is the highest number bus that resides below the bridge. io_range: PciMemoryRange The PIO range for all devices on this bridge memory_range: PciMemoryRange The MMIO range for all devices on this bridge prefetchable_range: PciMemoryRange The range of prefetchable MMIO for all devices on this bridge Since 2.4 PciBridgeInfo (Object) Information about a PCI Bridge device Members bus: PciBusInfo information about the bus the device resides on devices: array of PciDeviceInfo (optional) a list of PciDeviceInfo for each device on this bridge Since 0.14 PciDeviceClass (Object) Information about the Class of a PCI device Members desc: string (optional) a string description of the device's class class: int the class code of the device Since 2.4 PciDeviceId (Object) Information about the Id of a PCI device Members device: int the PCI device id vendor: int the PCI vendor id subsystem: int (optional) the PCI subsystem id (since 3.1) subsystem-vendor: int (optional) the PCI subsystem vendor id (since 3.1) Since 2.4 PciDeviceInfo (Object) Information about a PCI device Members bus: int the bus number of the device slot: int the slot the device is located in function: int the function of the slot used by the device class_info: PciDeviceClass the class of the device id: PciDeviceId the PCI device id irq: int (optional) if an IRQ is assigned to the device, the IRQ number irq_pin: int the IRQ pin, zero means no IRQ (since 5.1) qdev_id: string the device name of the PCI device pci_bridge: PciBridgeInfo (optional) if the device is a PCI bridge, the bridge information regions: array of PciMemoryRegion a list of the PCI I/O regions associated with the device Notes the contents of class_info.desc are not stable and should only be treated as informational. Since 0.14 PciInfo (Object) Information about a PCI bus Members bus: int the bus index devices: array of PciDeviceInfo a list of devices on this bus Since 0.14 query-pci (Command) Return information about the PCI bus topology of the guest. Returns a list of PciInfo for each PCI bus. Each bus is represented by a json-object, which has a key with a json-array of all PCI devices attached to it. Each device is represented by a json-object. Since 0.14 Example -> { "execute": "query-pci" } <- { "return": [ { "bus": 0, "devices": [ { "bus": 0, "qdev_id": "", "slot": 0, "class_info": { "class": 1536, "desc": "Host bridge" }, "id": { "device": 32902, "vendor": 4663 }, "function": 0, "regions": [ ] }, { "bus": 0, "qdev_id": "", "slot": 1, "class_info": { "class": 1537, "desc": "ISA bridge" }, "id": { "device": 32902, "vendor": 28672 }, "function": 0, "regions": [ ] }, { "bus": 0, "qdev_id": "", "slot": 1, "class_info": { "class": 257, "desc": "IDE controller" }, "id": { "device": 32902, "vendor": 28688 }, "function": 1, "regions": [ { "bar": 4, "size": 16, "address": 49152, "type": "io" } ] }, { "bus": 0, "qdev_id": "", "slot": 2, "class_info": { "class": 768, "desc": "VGA controller" }, "id": { "device": 4115, "vendor": 184 }, "function": 0, "regions": [ { "prefetch": true, "mem_type_64": false, "bar": 0, "size": 33554432, "address": 4026531840, "type": "memory" }, { "prefetch": false, "mem_type_64": false, "bar": 1, "size": 4096, "address": 4060086272, "type": "memory" }, { "prefetch": false, "mem_type_64": false, "bar": 6, "size": 65536, "address": -1, "type": "memory" } ] }, { "bus": 0, "qdev_id": "", "irq": 11, "slot": 4, "class_info": { "class": 1280, "desc": "RAM controller" }, "id": { "device": 6900, "vendor": 4098 }, "function": 0, "regions": [ { "bar": 0, "size": 32, "address": 49280, "type": "io" } ] } ] } ] } Note This example has been shortened as the real response is too long.
COPYRIGHT
2024, The QEMU Project Developers